Form 10-K
Table of Contents

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

Form 10-K

(Mark One)

  þ ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011

or

 

  ¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 or 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from                  to                 

Commission file numbers 001-13251

 

 

SLM Corporation

(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)

 

Delaware   52-2013874

(State of Other Jurisdiction of

Incorporation or Organization)

 

(I.R.S. Employer

Identification No.)

300 Continental Drive, Newark, Delaware   19713
(Address of Principal Executive Offices)   (Zip Code)

(302) 283-8000

(Registrant’s Telephone Number, Including Area Code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act

Common Stock, par value $.20 per share.

Name of Exchange on which Listed:

The NASDAQ Global Select Market

6.97% Cumulative Redeemable Preferred Stock, Series A, par value $.20 per share

Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series B, par value $.20 per share

Name of Exchange on which Listed:

The NASDAQ Global Select Market

Medium Term Notes, Series A, CPI-Linked Notes due 2017

Medium Term Notes, Series A, CPI-Linked Notes due 2018

6% Senior Notes due December 15, 2043

Name of Exchange on which Listed:

The NASDAQ Global Select Market

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:

None.

 

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.    Yes  þ        No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act.    Yes  ¨        No  þ

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes  þ        No  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes  þ        No  ¨

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer  þ      

Accelerated filer  ¨

Non-accelerated filer  ¨       Smaller reporting company  ¨

(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

   

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes  ¨        No  þ

The aggregate market value of voting stock held by non-affiliates of the registrant as of June 30, 2011 was $8.7 billion (based on closing sale price of $16.81 per share as reported for the New York Stock Exchange).

As of January 31, 2012, there were 509,322,190 shares of common stock outstanding.

 

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

Portions of the Proxy Statement relating to the registrant’s Annual Meeting of Shareholders scheduled to be held on May 24, 2012 are incorporated by reference into Part III of this Report.

 

 

 


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

           

Page
Number

Forward-Looking and Cautionary Statements; Available Information

   1

PART I

  

Item 1.

     Business    2

Item 1A.

     Risk Factors    11

Item 1B.

     Unresolved Staff Comments    18

Item 2.

     Properties    19

Item 3.

     Legal Proceedings    19

Item 4.

     Mine Safety Disclosures    21

PART II

  

Item 5.

     Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities    22

Item 6.

     Selected Financial Data    24

Item 7.

     Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations    25

Item 7A.

     Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk    92

Item 8.

     Financial Statements and Supplementary Data    97

Item 9.

     Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure    97

Item 9A.

     Controls and Procedures    97

Item 9B.

     Other Information    98

PART III

       

Item 10.

     Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance    99

Item 11.

     Executive Compensation    99

Item 12.

     Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters    99

Item 13.

     Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence    99

Item 14.

     Principal Accounting Fees and Services    99

PART IV

       

Item 15.

     Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules    100

Appendix A – Federal Family Education Loan Program

   A-1

Glossary

   G-1


Table of Contents

FORWARD-LOOKING AND CAUTIONARY STATEMENTS

This report contains “forward-looking” statements and information based on management’s current expectations as of the date of this document. Statements that are not historical facts, including statements about our beliefs, opinions, or expectations and statements that assume or are dependent upon future events, are forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements are subject to risks, uncertainties, assumptions and other factors that may cause actual results to be materially different from those reflected in such forward-looking statements. These factors include, among others, the risks and uncertainties set forth in Item 1A “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K and subsequent filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”); increases in financing costs; limits on liquidity; increases in costs associated with compliance with laws and regulations; changes in accounting standards and the impact of related changes in significant accounting estimates; any adverse outcomes in any significant litigation to which we are a party; credit risk associated with our exposure to third parties, including counterparties to our derivative transactions; and changes in the terms of student loans and the educational credit marketplace (including changes resulting from new laws and the implementation of existing laws). We could also be affected by, among other things: changes in our funding costs and availability; reductions to our credit ratings or the credit ratings of the United States of America; failures of our operating systems or infrastructure, including those of third-party vendors; damage to our reputation; failures to successfully implement cost-cutting and restructuring initiatives and adverse effects of such initiatives on our business; changes in the demand for educational financing or in financing preferences of lenders, educational institutions, students and their families; changes in law and regulations with respect to the student lending business and financial institutions generally; increased competition from banks and other consumer lenders; the creditworthiness of our customers; changes in the general interest rate environment, including the rate relationships among relevant money-market instruments and those of our earning assets versus our funding arrangements; changes in general economic conditions; and changes in the demand for debt management services. The preparation of our consolidated financial statements also requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions including estimates and assumptions about future events. These estimates or assumptions may prove to be incorrect. All forward-looking statements contained in this report are qualified by these cautionary statements and are made only as of the date of this document. We do not undertake any obligation to update or revise these forward-looking statements to conform the statement to actual results or changes in our expectations.

Definitions for certain capitalized terms used in this document can be found in the “Glossary” at the end of this document.

References in this Annual Report to “we,” “us,” “our” “Sallie Mae” and the “Company,” refer to SLM Corporation and its subsidiaries, except as otherwise indicated or unless the context otherwise requires.

AVAILABLE INFORMATION

Our website address is www.SallieMae.com. Copies of our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K, as well as any amendments to those reports, are available free of charge through our website as soon as reasonably practicable after they are electronically filed with or furnished to the SEC. In addition, copies of our Board Governance Guidelines, Code of Business Conduct (which includes the code of ethics applicable to our chief executive officer, principal financial officer and principal accounting officer) and the governing charters for each committee of our board of directors are available free of charge on our website, as well as in print to any shareholder upon request. We intend to disclose any amendments to or waivers from our Code of Business Conduct (to the extent applicable to our Chief Executive Officer or Chief Financial Officer) by posting such information on our website. Information contained or referenced on our website is not incorporated by reference into and does not form a part of this report.


Table of Contents

PART I.

 

Item 1. Business

SLM Corporation, more commonly known as Sallie Mae, is the nation’s leading saving, planning and paying for education company. As we have for nearly 40 years, Sallie Mae makes investing in the college graduate its top priority. We help students and their families save, plan, and pay for college — helping them to responsibly achieve their dreams.

Our primary business is to originate, service and collect loans we make to students and/or their parents to finance the cost of their education. The core of our marketing strategy is to generate student loan originations by promoting our products on campus through the financial aid office and through direct marketing to students and their families. We also provide servicing, loan default aversion and defaulted loan collection services for loans owned by other institutions, including the Department of Education (“ED”). We also provide processing capabilities to educational institutions, 529 college-savings plan program management services and a consumer savings network.

In addition, we are the largest holder, servicer and collector of loans made under the discontinued Federal Family Education Loan Program (“FFELP”). In fact, the majority of our income continues to be derived, directly or indirectly, from our portfolio of FFELP loans. In 2010, President Obama signed into law the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010 (“HCERA”). The FFELP, through which we historically generated most of our net income, was eliminated by HCERA though it did not alter or affect the terms and conditions of existing FFELP Loans. Our FFELP Loan portfolio will amortize over approximately 20 years. The fee income we derive from providing servicing and contingent collections services on such loans will similarly decline over time. For a full description of FFELP, see Appendix A “Federal Family Education Loan Program.”

At December 31, 2011, we had approximately 6,600 employees.

Private Education Loan Market

Key Drivers of Private Education Loan Market Growth

The size of the Private Education Loan market is based on three primary factors: college enrollment levels, the costs of attending college and the availability of funds from the federal government to pay for a college education. If the cost of education continues to increase at a pace that exceeds income and savings growth and the availability of federal funds does not significantly increase, we expect more students and families to borrow from private loan programs. We believe the credit market dislocation of 2008 and 2009 and the elimination of FFELP were largely responsible for lenders exiting the Private Education Loan business. For Academic Year (“AY”) 2010-2011, Private Education Loans were primarily originated by seven of the country’s largest banks, Sallie Mae and numerous credit unions.

 

2


Table of Contents

College Enrollment Levels

College enrollment increased by approximately 14 percent from 2007 through 2011 and predicts that college-enrollment will increase 11 percent from 2011 to 2020.

Historical and Projected Enrollment

(in millions)

LOGO

 

Source: National Center for Education Statistics U.S. Department of Education, National Center for Education Statistics, 1990 through 2009 Integrated Postsecondary Education Data System, “Fall Enrollment Survey” (IPEDS-EF:90–99), Spring 2001 through Spring 2010; and Enrollment in Degree-Granting Institutions Model, 1980–2009.

Note: Total enrollment in all degree-granting institutions; middle alternative projections for 2010 onward.

Costs of Attending College

Tuition and fees at four-year public institutions and four-year private institutions have increased at a compound annual growth rate of 8.1 percent and 5.1 percent, respectively, since AY 2001-2002. The consumer price index experienced 1.9 percent compound annual growth rate for the same period.

Cost of Attendance(1)

Cumulative % Increase from AY 2001-2002

LOGO

 

 

Source: The College Board — Trends in College Pricing 2011. © 2011 The College Board. www.collegeboard.org

  (1)

Cost of attendance is in current dollars and includes tuition, fees and on-campus room and board.

 

3


Table of Contents

Availability of Federal Funds

There has been a substantial increase in borrowing from federal loan programs in recent years. In the AY ended June 30, 2011, according to the College Board, borrowing from federal loan programs totaled $104 billion, an increase of nearly 70 percent since AY ending June 30, 2007. The College Board also reported that federal grants increased 17 percent to $49.1 billion from $41.9 billion in the most recent AY and have increased more than 150 percent since AY 2006-2007. Over the same period of time, borrowing from Private Education Loan programs decreased nearly 70 percent, dropping to an estimated $6 billion, down significantly from the peak of $21.1 billion in the AY 2007-2008 and down $800 million as compared to AY 2009-2010. We believe the drop in borrowing from Private Education Loan programs has been caused in large measure by these increases in federal loan limits and the increasing availability of federal funds and the strengthening of Private Education Loan underwriting standards.

Students and their families can borrow money directly from the federal government to pay for all or part of college education costs under the Direct Student Loan Program (“DSLP”). The loans can be used to cover the cost of tuition, and room and board. Currently, a dependent undergraduate student can borrow from $5,500 to $7,500 annually, depending on their class level. An independent undergraduate student can borrow from $9,500 to $12,500 annually, depending on their class level. A graduate student can borrow up to the full cost of attendance. Rising enrollment and college costs and increases in borrowing limits have caused federal student loan programs to grow at a 10-year annual growth rate of 12 percent. The number of borrowers using DSLP is expected to increase five percent per year over the next three years.

Our Approach to Advising Students and Their Families

Students and their families use multiple sources of funding to pay for their college education, including savings, current income, grants, scholarships, federal government loans and private education loans.

We advise students and their families to follow the “1-2-3 approach” to paying for college. In recent years, we have increased our focus on business-to-consumer and business-to-business activities that align with each of these three steps and our future plans revolve largely around continuing to develop these types of activities.

Step 1: Use scholarships, grants, savings and income.

Sallie Mae makes available to consumers at no charge an extensive online database of scholarships which includes information about more than 2 million scholarships with an aggregate value in excess of $16 billion.

Our Upromise consumer savings network helps families jumpstart their save-for-college plan by providing financial rewards on everyday purchases. Traditional savings products, like High Yield Savings Accounts, Money Market Accounts and CDs, are available through the Sallie Mae Bank (the “Bank”). In addition, our Upromise Investments Inc. subsidiary is the largest administrator of direct-to-consumer 529 college-savings plans.

We also provide services to families who prefer to pay some or all of their college expenses using current income. Sallie Mae’s Campus Solutions business administers interest-free tuition payment plans on behalf of higher education institutions. In addition, we process tuition refunds on behalf of colleges and universities that may be disbursed to students a number of ways, including through the Bank’s No-Fee-Student Checking with Debit product.

Step 2: Pursue federal government loan options.

Sallie Mae encourages consumers to explore federal government loan options. Our free online tool, the Education Investment Planner, helps families estimate the full cost of a college degree and build a customized plan to pay for college. The Education Investment Planner takes families through a series of questions, prompting users to model various funding sources — including 529 college savings plans, parent and student savings and income, scholarships, federal and state grants, institutional aid, and if necessary, federal and private student loans. For those who include student loans in their pay-for-college plan, the Education Investment Planner estimates what their monthly payments could be after graduation and helps users project how much a graduate would need to earn to keep payments manageable.

 

4


Table of Contents

Step 3: Consider affordable Private Education Loans to fill the gap.

We offer Private Education Loan products to bridge the gap between family resources, federal loans, grants, student aid and scholarships, and the cost of a college education. While we actively maintain our presence in school marketing channels, we also continue to develop and evolve our marketing efforts through various other direct and indirect marketing channels, such as direct mailings, internet channels and marketing alliances with various banks and financial institutions.

We regularly review the terms of our Private Education Loan products to explore ways to minimize finance charges and incorporate additional consumer protections. Today, the Smart Option Student Loan offers a choice of payment options: 1) interest-only payments while the student is in school; 2) fixed monthly payments of $25 while the student is in school; and 3) no payment required while the student is in school. We believe these repayment options encourage payments while in school and, when combined with shorter repayment terms customized for each borrower, can result in far lower costs to borrowers over the life of their loans. Our Private Education Loans are certified to us by higher education institutions to ensure borrowing does not exceed the cost of attendance, and can include important protections for the family, including tuition insurance, and death and disability loan forgiveness.

The Higher Education Opportunity Act of 2008 established a series of new disclosures that provide private education loan customers clear, consistent, and easy-to-compare information about Private Education Loans offered by different lenders. These disclosures inform borrowers of the potential life-of-loan costs and provide multiple reminders of the availability of federal loans. When a customer is approved for the loan, we send a disclosure that provides very specific information about the loan’s terms and that gives instructions on how to accept the terms of the loan. When a customer accepts the terms of the loan, we send a disclosure that confirms the loan information and also notifies the customer of a right-to-cancel period.

Additionally, we provide information to customers during the application process to allow them to compare the full cost of different repayment plans. We also provide a 60-day loan cancellation period within which borrowers have the ability to repay their loans after disbursement with no interest or fees should a borrower change his or her mind.

Business Segments

We have three primary operating business segments — the Consumer Lending segment, the Business Services segment and FFELP Loans segment. A fourth segment — Other, primarily consists of the financial results of our holding company, including activities related to the repurchase of debt, the corporate liquidity portfolio, all overhead and results from smaller wind-down and discontinued operations within this segment.

A summary of financial information for each of our business segments for each of the last three fiscal years is included in “Note 16—Segment Reporting” to the consolidated financial statements.

Consumer Lending Segment

In this segment, we originate, acquire, finance and service Private Education Loans. The Private Education Loans we make are largely to bridge the gap between the cost of higher education and the amount funded through financial aid, federal loans or borrowers’ resources.

Private Education Loans bear the full credit risk of the borrower. We manage this risk by underwriting and pricing according to credit risk based upon customized credit scoring criteria and the addition of qualified cosigners. For the year ended December 31, 2011, our annual charge-off rate for Private Education Loans (as a percentage of loans in repayment) was 3.7 percent, as compared with 5.0 percent for the prior year.

In 2011 we originated $2.7 billion of Private Education Loans, an increase of 19 percent from the prior year even as borrowings under Private Education Loan programs contracted by approximately 12 percent. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, we had $36.3 billion and $35.7 billion of Private Education Loans outstanding, respectively. See Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of

 

5


Table of Contents

Operations — Business Segment Earnings Summary — ‘Core Earnings’ Basis — Consumer Lending Segment” for a full discussion of our Consumer Lending business and related loan portfolio. At December 31, 2011, 56 percent of our Private Education Loans were funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 51 percent of our Private Education Loans being funded to term by securitization trusts.

In this segment, we earn net interest income on the Private Education Loan portfolio (after provision for loan losses) as well as servicing fees, primarily late payment fees. Operating expenses for this segment include costs incurred to acquire and to service our loans.

Since the beginning of 2006, all of our Private Education Loans have been originated and funded by the Bank, a Utah industrial bank subsidiary regulated by the Utah Department of Financial Institutions and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”). At December 31, 2011, the Bank had total assets of $7.6 billion including $5.0 billion in Private Education Loans. As of the same date, the Bank had total deposits of $6.3 billion. The Bank relies on both retail and brokered deposits to fund its assets. The Bank is also a key component of our Campus Solutions and college savings product businesses. Deposits and refunds from our Campus Solutions business are held at the Bank. In addition, Upromise rewards earned by members are held at the Bank.

We face competition for Private Education Loans from a group of the nation’s larger banks and local credit unions.

Business Services Segment

Our Business Services segment generates the vast majority of its revenue from servicing our FFELP Loan portfolio and from performing servicing, default aversion and contingency collections work on behalf of ED, Guarantors of FFELP Loans, and other institutions. The elimination of FFELP in July 2010 will cause these FFELP-related revenue sources to continue to decline.

 

   

Servicing revenues from the FFELP Loans we own and manage represent intercompany charges to the FFELP Loans segment at rates paid to us by the trusts which own the loans. These fees are legally the first payment priority of the trusts and exceed the actual cost of servicing the loans. Intercompany loan servicing revenues grew to $739 million in 2011 from $648 million in 2010. The increase in loan servicing revenues was the result of the acquisition of a large portfolio of loans on December 31, 2010. Intercompany loan servicing revenues will decline as the FFELP portfolio amortizes.

 

   

In 2011, we earned account maintenance fees on FFELP Loans serviced for Guarantors of $46 million, down from $56 million in 2010. These fees will continue to decline as the portfolio amortizes.

 

   

In 2011, contingency collection revenue from Guarantor clients totaled $246 million, unchanged compared with the prior year. We anticipate these revenues will begin to steadily decline in 2013.

The scale, diversification and performance of our Business Services segment have been, and we expect them to remain, a competitive advantage for us. As FFELP-related service revenue streams decline, we will strive to replace them over the coming years by exploring both complementary and diversified strategies to expand demand for our services in and beyond the student loan market. For example, in 2011 we launched Sallie Mae Insurance Services to offer tuition, renters’ and student health insurance to college students and higher education institutions. We also acquired SC Services & Associates to enhance our ability to provide collections services to local governments and courts.

Our primary Business Services activities that are not directly related to the FFELP include:

Upromise

Upromise generates revenue by providing program management services for 529 college-savings plans with assets of $37.5 billion in 31 college-savings plans in 16 states. We also generate transaction fees through our Upromise consumer savings network, through which members have earned $660 million in rewards by

 

6


Table of Contents

purchasing products at hundreds of online retailers, booking travel, purchasing a home, dining out, buying gas and groceries, using the Upromise World MasterCard, or completing other qualified transactions. We earn a fee for the marketing and administrative services we provide to companies that participate in the Upromise savings network. We compete for 529 college-savings plan business with a large array of banks, financial services and other processing companies. We also compete with other loyalty shopping services and companies.

ED Servicing and Collection Contracts

In the second quarter of 2009, ED named Sallie Mae as one of four servicers awarded a servicing contract (the “ED Servicing Contract”) to service all newly disbursed federal loans owned by ED. The contract spans five years with one, five-year renewal at the option of ED. We compete for Direct Loan servicing volume from ED with the three other servicing companies with whom we share the contract. Account allocations are awarded annually based on each company’s performance on five different metrics: defaulted borrower count, defaulted borrower dollar amount, a survey of borrowers, a survey of schools and a survey of ED personnel. Pursuant to the contract terms related to annual volume allocation of new loans, the maximum any servicer could be awarded is 40 percent of net new borrowers in that contract year. We are focused on our performance to increase our allocation of new accounts under the ED Servicing Contract. Our share of new loans serviced for ED under the ED Servicing Contract increased to 26 percent in 2012 from 22 percent in the prior contract year as a result of an improvement of our performance on the ED scorecard.

Since 1997, we have provided collection services on defaulted student loans to ED customers. The current contract runs through December 31, 2012, with two one-year renewal options by ED. There are 21 other collection providers, of which we compete with 16 providers for account allocation based on quarterly performance metrics. As a consistent top performer, our share of allocated accounts has ranged from six percent to eight percent for this contract period.

Other

Our Campus Solutions business offers a suite of solutions designed to help campus business offices increase their services to students and families. The product suite includes electronic billing, collection, payment and refund services plus full tuition payment plan administration. In 2011, we generated servicing revenue from over 1,100 schools.

FFELP Loans Segment

Our FFELP Loans segment consists of our FFELP Loan portfolio and the underlying debt, related derivatives and capital funding the loans. FFELP Loans are insured or guaranteed by state or not-for-profit agencies and are also protected by contractual rights to recovery from the United States pursuant to guaranty agreements among ED and these agencies. These guarantees generally cover at least 97 percent of a FFELP Loan’s principal and accrued interest for loans disbursed before and after July 1, 2006, respectively. In the case of death, disability or bankruptcy of the borrower, these guarantees cover 100 percent of the loan’s principal and accrued interest. See Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Business Segment Earnings Summary — ‘Core Earnings’ Basis — FFELP Loans Segment” for a full discussion of our FFELP business and related loan portfolio.

At December 31, 2011, we held $138 billion of FFELP Loans, of which 94 percent were funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 76 percent of our FFELP Loans being funded to term by securitization trusts, 15 percent funded through the ED Conduit Program which terminates on January 19, 2014, and 3 percent funded through our multi-year asset-backed commercial paper (“ABCP”) facility. As a result of the long-term funding used in the FFELP Loan portfolio and the insurance and guarantees provided on these loans, the net interest margin recorded in the FFELP Loans segment is relatively stable and the capital requirements with respect to the segment are

 

7


Table of Contents

modest. In addition to the net interest margin, we earn fee income largely from late fees on the loans. For a more detailed description of these various funding facilities, see Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources.”

Our FFELP Loan portfolio will amortize over approximately 20 years. Our goal is to maximize the cash flow generated by the portfolio. We will seek to acquire other third-party FFELP Loan portfolios to add net interest income and servicing revenue.

The Higher Education Act (the “HEA”) regulates every aspect of the FFELP, including communications with borrowers and default aversion requirements. Failure to service a FFELP Loan properly could jeopardize the insurance and guarantees and federal support on these loans. The insurance and guarantees on our existing loans were not affected by HCERA.

For a more fulsome discussion of the FFELP and various credit support mechanisms, see “Appendix A – Federal Family Education Loan Program.”

Other Segment

The Other segment consists primarily of the financial results related to activities of our holding company, including the repurchase of debt, the corporate liquidity portfolio and all overhead. We also include results from smaller wind-down and discontinued operations within this segment. Overhead expenses include costs related to executive management, the board of directors, accounting, finance, legal, human resources, stock-based compensation expense and certain information technology costs related to infrastructure and operations.

Recent Legislation

Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010.

The 2010 Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) was intended to reform and strengthen supervision of the U.S. financial services industry. The Dodd-Frank Act contains comprehensive change to banking laws, imposing significant regulation on almost every aspect of the U.S. financial services industry, including increased capital and liquidity requirements, limits on leverage, and enhanced supervisory authority. A year after passage, most of the component parts of the Dodd-Frank Act remain subject to extensive rulemaking and public comment causing unpredictability of the ultimate effect of the Dodd-Frank Act or of required examinations of the Private Education Loan market. However, the outline of several key components of the law that could apply to some of our businesses are now clearer and we highlight the most significant of these below. Our operational expenses will likely increase to address new or additional compliance requirements as a result of the implementation of various provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act.

Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“CFPB”)

In July 2011, responsibility for many consumer financial protection functions formerly assigned to the federal banking and other agencies were transferred to the CFPB. The CFPB has broad authority with respect to some of the businesses in which we engage. It has authority to write regulations under federal consumer financial protection laws, and to directly or indirectly enforce those laws and examine financial institutions for compliance. It is authorized to collect fines and provide consumer restitution in the event of violations, engage in consumer financial education, track consumer complaints, request data and promote the availability of financial services to underserved consumers and communities. It has authority to prevent unfair, deceptive or abusive practices by issuing regulations that define the same or by using its enforcement authority without first issuing regulations.

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, the CFPB and ED are required to prepare a report on the private education loan industry by July 2012 that examines, among other things, the private education loan market; underwriting criteria

 

8


Table of Contents

used by lenders; loan terms, conditions and pricing; consumer protections available to borrowers; and fair lending considerations. The Dodd-Frank Act also created a “Private Education Ombudsman” within the CFPB to receive and attempt to informally resolve complaints about Private Education Loans, and the CFPB plans to receive such complaints through its online consumer complaint system. We are currently working with the CFPB and providing information relating to these two important initiatives.

The Dodd-Frank Act also authorizes state officials to enforce regulations issued by the CFPB and to enforce the Dodd-Frank Act’s general prohibition against unfair, deceptive or abusive practices, and makes it more difficult than in the past for federal financial regulators to declare state laws that differ from federal standards preempted.

Regulation of Systemically Important Non-Bank Financial Companies

As directed by the Dodd-Frank Act, the Financial Stability Oversight Council (“FSOC”) has proposed a process for designating non-bank financial companies as systemically important. The Dodd-Frank Act mandated the development of such a process through which the FSOC would identify and designate non-bank financial companies whose material financial distress could pose a threat to the financial stability of the United States. If designated as a systemically important financial institution (i.e., a “SIFI”), a non-bank financial company will be supervised by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “FRB”) and be subject to enhanced prudential supervision and regulatory standards to be developed by the FRB. For a further discussion of the risks and implications of SLM Corporation being designated a SIFI, see Item 1A “Risk Factors — Regulatory and Compliance.”

In October 2011, the FSOC published additional proposed rulemaking regarding the designation process. While not yet final, the proposed rules focus the process for determining if a non-bank financial company’s distress could pose a threat to the financial stability of the United States on three criteria: the size, substitutability and interconnectedness of the particular company. The proposed rules also stipulate the criteria the FSOC will utilize to focus on the likelihood of material distress within a non-bank financial company: leverage, liquidity risk and maturity mismatch, and existing regulatory scrutiny. Presumably, if the FSOC determines a non-bank financial company does not pose a threat to the financial stability of the United States, no further analysis would be required. However, the proposed rules shed little light on how the FSOC will conduct its evaluation, only the criteria it might utilize.

While we have no way of knowing the qualitative judgments the FSOC will use to determine if SLM Corporation merits SIFI designation, we believe SLM Corporation poses no threat to the financial stability of the United States. While SLM Corporation would meet certain criteria in Stage 1 of the FSOC’s second proposed rulemaking, those criteria focus mainly on size and give little or no attention to the nature of the majority of financial assets on our balance sheet, the minimal interconnectivity between our businesses and the financial economy of the United States or the numerous sophisticated competitors who can provide substitute services to those we provide. We believe any review by FSOC should focus primarily on the following:

 

   

For AY 2010-2011, we provided approximately one percent of the $235 billion total funds used to finance post-secondary expenses.(1)

 

   

At December 31, 2011, $138 billion of our $174 billion student loan assets are related to FFELP Loans, of which at least 97 percent of their principal and interest payments are protected by contractual rights to recovery from the United States. As previously noted, FFELP was ended by Congress in 2010 and as a result, these amounts will continue to decline in future years.

 

   

Our annual charge-offs of FFELP Loans were 0.08 percent of loans in repayment in 2011. We have low charge-off rates on FFELP Loans given the previously noted federal backing of these loans.

 

(1)  Source: The College Board — Trends in Student Aid 2011.

 

9


Table of Contents
   

At December 31, 2011, 94 percent of our FFELP Loans were funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 76 percent of our FFELP Loans being funded to term by securitization trusts. Consequently, these arrangements greatly eliminate the risk of unexpected demands being made on our liquidity and minimize the risk that significant, unexpected defaults on these loans could trigger material financial distress within SLM Corporation.

 

   

At December 31, 2011, 56 percent of our Private Education Loans were funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 51 percent of our Private Education Loans being funded to term by securitization trusts.

 

   

At December 31, 2011, 86 percent of our total student loans were funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 71 percent of our total student loans being funded to term by securitization trusts.

 

   

SLM Corporation provides credit to individual students and their families, not other institutions or businesses. Our credit and market risk policies minimize the risk of credit counterparty concentrations. Our derivatives are for interest rate hedging, not speculation, and structured with collateral posting and netting features that protect counterparties from potential credit deterioration of SLM Corporation while also providing us the same protection in the event our counterparty’s credit deteriorates. At December 31, 2011, our payable position to derivative counterparties was only $89 million.

 

   

We are a large servicer and collector of student loans, both federal and private but, in today’s deep and sophisticated financial services industry, we compete with at least 21 private sector companies who provide those services.

Accordingly, we do not believe SLM Corporation poses a systemic threat to the financial stability of the United States.

Oversight of Derivatives

Finally, the Dodd-Frank Act creates a comprehensive new regulatory framework for oversight of derivatives transactions by the Commodity Futures Trading Commission (the “CFTC”) and the SEC. This new framework, among other things, subjects certain swap participants to new capital and margin requirements, recordkeeping and business conduct standards and imposes registration and regulation of swap dealers and major swap participants. The scope of potential exemptions remains to be further defined through agency rulemakings. Moreover, while we may or may not qualify for exemptions, many of our derivatives counterparties are likely to be subject to the new capital, margin and business conduct requirements.

Other Significant Sources of Regulation

Many aspects of our businesses are subject to regulation by federal and state regulation and administrative oversight. The most significant of these are described below.

We are subject to the HEA and, from time to time, our student loan operations are reviewed by ED and Guarantors. As a servicer of federal student loans, we are subject to certain ED regulations regarding financial responsibility and administrative capability that govern all third-party servicers of insured student loans. In connection with our Guarantor servicing operations, we must comply with, on behalf of our Guarantor clients, certain ED regulations that govern Guarantor activities as well as agreements for reimbursement between ED and our Guarantor clients.

As a third-party service provider to financial institutions, we are also subject to examination by the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council (“FFIEC”). The Bank is subject to Utah banking regulations as well as regulations issued by the FDIC, and undergoes periodic regulatory examinations by the FDIC and the Utah Department of Financial Institutions. SLM Corporation is also subject to regulation and periodic examination by these entities as to the nature and extent of services and financial strength it provides to the Bank.

 

10


Table of Contents

Our originating or servicing of federal and Private Education Loans also subjects us to federal and state consumer protection, privacy and related laws and regulations. Some of the more significant federal laws and regulations that are applicable to our business include:

 

   

the Truth-In-Lending Act;

 

   

the Fair Credit Reporting Act;

 

   

the Equal Credit Opportunity Act;

 

   

the Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act; and

 

   

the U.S. Bankruptcy Code.

Our Business Services segment’s debt collection and receivables management activities are subject to federal and state consumer protection, privacy and related laws and regulations. Some of the more significant federal statutes are the Fair Debt Collection Practices Act and additional provisions of the acts listed above, as well as the HEA and under the various laws and regulations that govern government contractors.

These activities are also subject to state laws and regulations similar to the federal laws and regulations listed above.

Our Upromise 529 college-savings activities are subject to regulation by the Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (“FINRA”) and the SEC, as well as various state regulatory authorities.

Company History

We were formed in 1972 as the Student Loan Marketing Association, a federally chartered government sponsored enterprise (“GSE”), with the goal of furthering access to higher education by providing liquidity to the student loan marketplace. On December 29, 2004, we terminated the federal charter, incorporated SLM Corporation as a business corporation in the State of Delaware, and dissolved the GSE. SLM Corporation is now a publicly-traded holding company operating through its various subsidiaries. Our principal executive offices are located at 300 Continental Drive, Newark, Delaware 19713, and our telephone number is (302) 283-8000.

We established the Bank in 2005 as an industrial bank chartered under the laws of the State of Utah. It is located in Murray, Utah. Under its banking charter, the Bank may make consumer loans and may accept Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) insured deposits, including NOW accounts. It is a depository institution subject to regulatory oversight and examination by both the FDIC and the Utah Department of Financial Institutions. Applicable federal and state regulations relate to a broad range of banking activities and practices, including minimum capital standards, maintenance of reserves and the terms on which a bank may engage in transactions with its affiliates. In addition, the FDIC has regulatory authority under the Financial Institutions Supervisory Act (“FISA”) to prohibit the Bank from engaging in any unsafe or unsound practice in conducting its business.

On August 22, 2006, the Company acquired Upromise Inc. and its subsidiaries, Upromise Investments, Inc. (“UII”) and Upromise Investment Advisors, LLC (“UIA”). UII is registered under the Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as a broker dealer with the SEC, is a member of FINRA and the Municipal Securities Rulemaking Board (“MSRB”). UIA is registered under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, as amended, with the SEC as an investment adviser.

 

Item 1A. Risk Factors

Our business activities involve a variety of risks. Below we describe the significant risk factors affecting our business. The risks described below are not the only risks facing us — other risks also could impact our business.

 

11


Table of Contents

Funding and Liquidity.

Our business can be affected by the cost and availability of funding in the capital markets. The interest rate characteristics of our earning assets do not always match the interest rate characteristics of our funding arrangements. These factors may increase the price of or decrease our ability to obtain liquidity necessary to maintain and grow our business.

The capital markets continue to experience periods of significant volatility. This volatility can dramatically and adversely affect our financing costs when compared to historical norms. Additional factors that could make financing more expensive or unavailable include, but are not limited to, financial losses, events that have an adverse impact on our reputation, changes in the activities of our business partners, events that have an adverse impact on the financial services industry, counterparty availability, changes affecting our assets, corporate and regulatory actions, absolute and comparative interest rate changes, ratings agencies’ actions, general economic conditions and the legal, regulatory, accounting and tax environments governing our funding transactions. If financing becomes more difficult, expensive or unavailable, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be materially and adversely affected.

During 2011, we funded Private Education Loan originations through term-brokered and retail deposits raised by the Bank. Assets funded in this manner result in re-financing risk because the average term of the deposits is shorter than the expected term of some of the assets. There is no assurance that this or other sources of funding, such as the term asset-backed securities market, will be available at a level and a cost that makes new Private Education Loan originations possible or profitable, nor is there any assurance that the loans can be re-financed at profitable margins. For additional discussion on regulatory and compliance risks relating to the Bank, see below at Item 1A “Risk Factors — Regulatory and Compliance.” If we were unable to obtain funds from which to make new Private Education Loans, our business, financial condition and results of operations would be materially and adversely affected.

The interest rate characteristics of our earning assets do not always match the interest rate characteristics of our funding arrangements. This mismatch exposes us to risk in the form of basis risk and repricing risk. Moreover, it may not always be possible to hedge all of our exposure to such basis risks. While the asset and hedge indices are short-term with rate movements that are typically highly correlated, there can be no assurance that the historically high correlation will not be disrupted by capital market dislocations or other factors not within our control. In such circumstances, our earnings could be adversely affected, possibly to a material extent.

Further deterioration in the economy could result in a decrease in demand for consumer credit and credit quality could adversely be affected. Higher credit-related losses and weaker credit quality could negatively affect our business, financial condition and results of operations and limit funding options, including capital markets activity, which could also adversely impact our liquidity position.

Downgrades of the credit rating of the United States of America may materially adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

In August 2011, Standard and Poor’s Ratings Services (“S&P”) lowered the long-term sovereign credit rating of the United States to AA+ from AAA with negative outlook, stating that its action was based on S&P’s view on the rising public debt burden and perception of greater policymaking uncertainty.

If the U.S.’s credit rating were to be further downgraded: (i) our cost of funds on new asset-backed securities (“ABS”), as well as certain existing ABS and conduit facilities collateralized with FFELP Loans (“FFELP ABS”) could increase; (ii) we could be required to increase the amount of over-collateralization associated with newly issued ABS and existing conduit facilities particularly to maintain the AAA credit ratings traditionally associated with FFELP ABS offerings and facilities; and (iii) our ability to access and/or maintain existing conduit facilities and to efficiently sell or refinance loans previously funded through these vehicles could be adversely affected.

 

12


Table of Contents

Operations.

Given the highly competitive markets in which we operate, a failure of our operating systems or infrastructure, or those of our third-party vendors, could disrupt our business, result in disclosure of confidential customer information, damage our reputation, cause significant losses and provide our competitors an opportunity to enhance their position at our expense.

A failure of our operating systems or infrastructure, or those of our third-party vendors, could disrupt our business. Our business is dependent on our ability to process and monitor large numbers of daily transactions in compliance with legal and regulatory standards and our product specifications, which we change to reflect our business needs. As processing demands change and our loan portfolios grow in both volume and differing terms and conditions, developing and maintaining our operating systems and infrastructure becomes increasingly challenging and there is no assurance that we can adequately or efficiently develop and maintain such systems.

Our loan originations and conversions and the servicing, financial, accounting, data processing or other operating systems and facilities that support them may fail to operate properly or become disabled as a result of events that are beyond our control, adversely affecting our ability to process these transactions. Any such failure could adversely affect our ability to service our clients, result in financial loss or liability to our clients, disrupt our business, result in regulatory action or cause reputational damage. Despite the plans and facilities we have in place, our ability to conduct business may be adversely affected by a disruption in the infrastructure that supports our businesses. This may include a disruption involving electrical, communications, internet, transportation or other services used by us or third parties with which we conduct business. Notwithstanding our efforts to maintain business continuity, a disruptive event impacting our processing locations could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our operations rely on the secure processing, storage and transmission of personal, confidential and other information in our computer systems and networks. Although we take protective measures, our computer systems, software and networks may be vulnerable to unauthorized access, computer viruses, malicious attacks and other events that could have a security impact beyond our control. If one or more of such events occur, personal, confidential and other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our computer systems and networks, could be jeopardized or could cause interruptions or malfunctions in our operations that could result in significant losses or reputational damage. We also routinely transmit and receive personal, confidential and proprietary information, some through third parties. We have put in place secure transmission capability, and work to ensure third parties follow similar procedures. An interception, misuse or mishandling of personal, confidential or proprietary information being sent to or received from a customer or third party could result in legal liability, regulatory action and reputational harm. In the event personal, confidential or other information is jeopardized, intercepted, misused or mishandled, we may be required to expend significant additional resources to modify our protective measures or to investigate and remediate vulnerabilities or other exposures, and we may be subject to fines, penalties, litigation costs and settlements and financial losses that are either not insured against or not fully covered through any insurance maintained by us. If one or more of such events occur, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be significantly and adversely affected.

We continue to undertake numerous cost-cutting initiatives to realign and restructure our business in light of significant legislative changes in the past several years. Our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected if we do not effectively align our cost structure with our current business operations and future business prospects.

In response to significant legislative changes in the past several years, we have undertaken and continue to undertake cost-cutting initiatives, including workforce reductions, servicing center closures, restructuring and transfers of business functions to new locations, enhancements to our web-based customer services, adoption of new procurement strategies and investments in operational efficiencies. Our business and financial condition could be adversely affected by these cost-cutting initiatives if cost reductions taken are so dramatic as to cause

 

13


Table of Contents

disruptions in our business or reductions in the quality of the services we provide. We may be unable to successfully execute on certain growth and other business strategies or achieve certain business goals or objectives if cost reductions are too dramatic. Alternatively, we may not be able to achieve our desired cost savings, and if that is the case our results of operations could be adversely affected.

Incorrect estimates and assumptions by management in connection with the preparation of our consolidated financial statements could adversely affect the reported assets, liabilities, income and expenses.

Incorrect estimates and assumptions by management in connection with the preparation of our consolidated financial statements could adversely affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the reported amounts of income and expenses. The preparation of our consolidated financial statements requires management to make certain critical accounting estimates and assumptions that could affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the reported amounts of income and expense during the reporting periods. A description of our critical accounting estimates and assumptions may be found in Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates” and in “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies.” If we make incorrect assumptions or estimates, we may under- or overstate reported financial results, which could materially and adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Political and Reputational.

The scope and profitability of our lending businesses remain subject to risks arising from legislative and administrative actions.

Through the HCERA, the U.S. Congress mandated that all future federal student loans be made through the DSLP, eliminating the FFELP. Further legislative action by Congress could adversely affect our business, financial condition and results of operations. For instance, during the fourth-quarter 2011, the Administration announced a Special Direct Consolidation Loan Initiative that provides a temporary incentive to borrowers who have at least one student loan owned by ED and at least one held by a FFELP lender to consolidate the FFELP lender’s loans into the DSLP program by providing a 0.25 percentage point interest rate reduction on the FFELP loans that are eligible for consolidation. We currently do not foresee the initiative having a significant impact on our FFELP Loans segment. However, the initiative is an example of how the Administration and Congress could detrimentally affect future estimated cash flows and profitability from our FFELP Loan portfolios through their actions. Likewise, additional restrictions or requirements imposed on Private Education lending could increase our costs, affect our ability to service and collect loans and materially and adversely impact our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Our ability to continue to grow our businesses related to contracting with state and federal governments is partly reliant on our ability to remain compliant with the laws and regulations applicable to those contracts.

We are subject to a variety of laws and regulations related to our government contracting businesses, including our contracts with ED. In addition, these government contracts are subject to termination rights, audits and investigations. If we were found in noncompliance with the contract provisions or applicable laws or regulations, or the government exercised its termination or other rights for that or other reasons, our reputation could be negatively affected, and our ability to compete for new contracts could be diminished. If this were to occur, the future prospects, revenues and results of operations of this portion of our business could be negatively affected.

 

14


Table of Contents

Competition.

We operate in a competitive environment, and our product offerings are primarily concentrated in loan and savings products for higher education.

We compete in the private credit lending business with banks and other consumer lending institutions, many with strong consumer brand name recognition. We compete based on our products, origination capability and customer service. To the extent our competitors compete aggressively or more effectively, we could lose market share to them or subject our existing loans to refinancing risk. In addition, there is a risk that any new education or loan products that we introduce will not be accepted in the marketplace. Our product offerings may not prove to be profitable and may fail to offset the loss of business in the education credit market.

We are a leading provider of saving- and paying-for-college products and programs. This concentration gives us a competitive advantage in the marketplace. This concentration also creates risks in our business, particularly in light of our concentration as a private credit lender and servicer for the FFELP and DSLP. If population demographics result in a decrease in college-age individuals, if demand for higher education decreases, if the cost of attendance of higher education decreases, if public resistance to higher education costs increases, or if the demand for higher education loans decreases, our private credit lending business could be negatively affected. In addition, the federal government, through the DSLP, poses significant competition to our private credit loan products. If loan limits under the DSLP increase, DSLP loans could be more widely available to students and their families and DSLP loans could increase, resulting in a further decrease in the size of the private credit education loan market and reduced demand for our private credit education loan products.

Credit and Counterparty.

Unexpected and sharp changes in the overall economic environment may negatively impact the performance of our loan and credit portfolios.

Unexpected changes in the overall economic environment, including unemployment, may result in the credit performance of our loan portfolio being materially different from what we expect. Our earnings are critically dependent on the evolving creditworthiness of our student loan customers. We maintain a reserve for credit losses based on expected future charge-offs which considers many factors, including levels of past due loans and forbearances and expected economic conditions. However, management’s determination of the appropriate reserve level may under- or over-estimate future losses. If the credit quality of our customer base materially decreases, if a market risk changes significantly, or if our reserves for credit losses are not adequate, our business, financial condition and results of operations could suffer.

In addition to the credit risk associated with our education loan customers, we are also subject to the creditworthiness of other third parties, including counterparties to our derivative transactions. For example, we have exposure to the financial condition of various lending, investment and derivative counterparties. If any of our counterparties is unable to perform its obligations, we could, depending on the type of counterparty arrangement, experience a loss of liquidity or an economic loss. In addition, we might not be able to cost effectively replace the derivative position depending on the type of derivative and the current economic environment, and thus be exposed to a greater level of interest rate and/or foreign currency exchange rate risk which could lead to additional losses. Our counterparty exposure is more fully discussed in Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Counterparty Exposure.” If our counterparties are unable to perform their obligations, our business, financial condition and results of operations could suffer.

 

15


Table of Contents

Regulatory and Compliance.

Delays and continuing uncertainties surrounding the ultimate scope and implementation of various provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act cause us to continue to be unable to fully assess the risks and implications the law could have on our profitability, results of operations, financial condition, cash flows or future business prospects.

The Dodd-Frank Act contains comprehensive change to banking laws, imposing significant regulation on almost every aspect of the U.S. financial services industry, including increased capital and liquidity requirements, limits on leverage, and enhanced supervisory authority. A year after passage, most of the component parts of the Dodd-Frank Act remain subject to intensive rulemaking and public comment causing continuing uncertainty in our ability to predict the ultimate effect the Dodd-Frank Act or required examinations of the private education loan market could have on our operations or those of our subsidiaries. Our operational expenses will likely increase to address new or additional compliance requirements that could be imposed on our operations as a result of the implementation of various provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act as the risk of penalties and fines on all businesses may increase and our profitability, results of operations, financial condition, cash flows or future business prospects could be affected as a result.

The Consumer Financial Protection Bureau (“CFPB”) is now authorized to exercise the full authority provided to it by the Dodd-Frank Act though much uncertainty remains about how this authority will be implemented or utilized. A number of our businesses will likely be subject to new rules and regulations not yet proposed or finalized and we may face complaints and challenges to our practices from the CFPB or state regulatory counterparts.

In July 2011, responsibility for many consumer financial protection functions formerly assigned to the federal banking and other agencies were transferred to the CFPB. The CFPB has broad authority with respect to some of the businesses in which we engage. It has authority to write regulations under federal consumer financial protection laws, and to directly or indirectly enforce those laws and examine financial institutions for compliance. It is authorized to collect fines and provide consumer restitution in the event of violations, engage in consumer financial education, track consumer complaints, request data and promote the availability of financial services to underserved consumers and communities. It has authority to prevent unfair, deceptive or abusive practices by issuing regulations that define the same or by using its enforcement authority without first issuing regulations.

Under the Dodd-Frank Act, the CFPB and ED are required to prepare a report on the Private Education Loan industry by July 2012 that examines, among other things, the private education loan market; underwriting criteria used by lenders; loan terms, conditions and pricing; consumer protections available to borrowers; and fair lending considerations. The Dodd-Frank Act also created a “Private Education Ombudsman” within the CFPB to receive and attempt to informally resolve complaints about Private Education Loans, and the CFPB plans to receive such complaints through its online consumer complaint system.

The Dodd-Frank Act authorizes state officials to enforce regulations issued by the CFPB and to enforce the Dodd-Frank Act’s general prohibition against unfair, deceptive or abusive practices, and makes it more difficult than in the past for federal financial regulators to declare state laws that differ from federal standards preempted. To the extent states enact requirements that differ from federal standards or state officials and courts adopt interpretations of federal consumer laws that differ from those adopted by the CFPB, our compliance costs could increase and reduce our ability to offer the same products and services to consumers nationwide and we may be subject to a higher risk of state enforcement actions.

 

16


Table of Contents

The Financial Stability Oversight Council (“FSOC”) could designate SLM Corporation as a systemically important non-bank financial company to be supervised by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “FRB”). Designation of SLM Corporation as a so-called “SIFI” would impose significant additional statutorily–defined monitoring and compliance regimes on our business and could significantly increase the levels of risk-based capital and highly liquid assets we are required to hold. Required implementation of some or all of the measures currently proposed by the FRB to be applicable to SIFIs would have a material impact on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

On October 11, 2011, FSOC published a second notice of proposed rulemaking and related interpretive guidance under the Dodd-Frank Act regarding the designation of non-bank systemically important financial institutions (“SIFIs”). If designated as a SIFI, a non-bank financial company will be supervised by the FRB and be subject to enhanced prudential supervision and regulatory standards to be developed by the FRB. The new proposal sets forth a three-stage determination process for designating non-bank SIFIs. In Stage 1, FSOC would apply a set of uniform quantitative thresholds to identify the non-bank financial companies that will be subject to further evaluation. Based on its financial condition as of December 31, 2011, SLM Corporation would meet the criteria in Stage 1 and would be subject to further evaluation by FSOC in the SIFI determination process. Because Stages 2 and 3 as proposed would involve qualitative judgment by FSOC, we cannot predict whether SLM Corporation will be designated as a SIFI under the rule as currently proposed. For a further discussion of our belief as to the limited risk SLM Corporation poses to the financial stability of the United States, see Item 1 “Business—Recent Legislation—Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act of 2010.”

On December 20, 2011 the FRB issued proposed rules to implement the enhanced prudential supervisory and regulatory standards required of bank holding companies with $50 billion or more in consolidated assets, as well as SIFIs. As currently proposed, the rules would require, among other things, that SIFIs:

 

   

Be subject to a minimum Tier 1 common risk-based capital ratio of 5 percent and generally be required to comply with bank regulatory capital and leverage requirements, subject to any case-by-case exceptions as the FRB might approve;

 

   

Comply with formal regulatory liquidity standards and hold highly liquid assets on hand sufficient to survive a projected 30-day liquidity crisis;

 

   

Be subject to new liquidity risk management and governance requirements, approval of liquidity risk models, and implementation of liquidity monitoring and compliance regimes;

 

   

Employ a chief risk officer to report directly to the chief executive officer and a required risk committee of the Board of Directors;

 

   

Be subject to periodic company and FRB-run supervisory stress tests; and

 

   

Periodically report to the FDIC and FRB on plans for rapid and orderly resolution of company affairs in the event of a material financial distress or failure.

We currently maintain significantly more than 5 percent capital against our Private Education Loans and significantly less than 5 percent capital against our FFELP Loans. We are not currently subject to consolidated capital requirements. Unless an exception were made to recognize the unique, federally insured nature of FFELP Loans, if we were designated as a SIFI, our risk-based capital requirements would likely increase. While we maintain our own contingency funding plans and conduct our own internal periodic stress tests, we have never been subject to an FRB supervised stress test nor have we developed a plan for orderly resolution of the scope and magnitude currently being demanded of large bank holding companies. Complying with these measures and implementing any or all of these as yet undefined, formalized statutory monitoring and compliance regimes could significantly increase our cost of doing business and the levels of capital and liquidity we are required to hold and, consequently, have a material impact on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

17


Table of Contents

Our businesses are regulated by various state and federal laws and regulations, and our failure to comply with these laws and regulations may result in significant costs, sanctions, litigation or the loss of insurance and guarantees on affected FFELP Loans.

Our businesses are subject to numerous state and federal laws and regulations and our failure to comply with these laws and regulations may result in significant costs, including litigation costs, and/or business sanctions. In addition, changes to such laws and regulations could adversely impact our business and results of operations if we are not able to adequately mitigate the impact of such changes.

Our private credit lending and debt collection businesses are subject to regulation and oversight by various state and federal agencies, particularly in the area of consumer protection. Some state attorneys general have been active in this area of consumer protection regulation. We are subject, and may be subject in the future, to inquiries and audits from state and federal regulators as well as frequent litigation from private plaintiffs.

The Bank is subject to state and FDIC regulation, oversight and regular examination. The FDIC and state regulators have the authority to impose fines, penalties or other limitations on the Bank’s operations should they conclude that its operations are not compliant with applicable laws and regulations. At the time of this filing, the Bank was the subject of a cease and desist order for weaknesses in its compliance function. While the issues addressed in the order have largely been remediated, the order has not yet been lifted. Our failure to comply with various laws and regulations or with the terms of the cease and desist order or to have issues raised during an examination could result in litigation expenses, fines, business sanctions, and limitations on our ability to fund our Private Education Loans, which are currently funded by deposits raised by the Bank, or restrictions on the operations of the Bank. The imposition of fines, penalties or other limitations on the Bank’s business could negatively impact our business, financial condition and results of operations.

Loans serviced under the FFELP are subject to the HEA and related regulations. Our servicing operations are designed and monitored to comply with the HEA, related regulations and program guidance; however ED could determine that we are not in compliance for a variety of reasons, including that we misinterpreted ED guidance or incorrectly applied the HEA and its related regulations or policies. Failure to comply could result in fines, the loss of the insurance and related federal guarantees on affected FFELP Loans, expenses required to cure servicing deficiencies, suspension or termination of our right to participate as a servicer, negative publicity and potential legal claims. A summary of the FFELP may be found in Appendix A “Federal Family Education Loan Program.” The imposition of significant fines, the loss of the insurance and related federal guarantees on a material number of FFELP Loans, the incurrence of additional expenses and/or the loss of our ability to participate as a FFELP servicer could individually or in the aggregate have a material, negative impact on our business, financial condition or results of operations.

Item 1B.    Unresolved Staff Comments

None.

 

18


Table of Contents
Item 2. Properties

The following table lists the principal facilities owned by us as of December 31, 2011:

 

Location

 

Function

 

Business Segment(s)

  Approximate
Square Feet
 

Fishers, IN

  Loan Servicing and Data Center   Consumer Lending; Business Services; FFELP Loans     450,000   

Newark, DE

  Headquarters   Consumer Lending; Business Services; FFELP Loans; Other     160,000   

Wilkes-Barre, PA

  Loan Servicing Center   Consumer Lending; Business Services; FFELP Loans     133,000   

Indianapolis, IN

  Loan Servicing Center   Business Services     100,000   

Big Flats, NY

  GRC — Collections Center   Business Services     60,000   

Arcade, NY(1)

  Pioneer Credit Recovery — Collections Center   Business Services     46,000   

Perry, NY(1)

  Pioneer Credit Recovery — Collections Center   Business Services     45,000   

 

  (1)

In the first quarter of 2003, we entered into a ten year lease with the Wyoming County Industrial Development Authority with a right of reversion to us for the Arcade and Perry, New York facilities.

The following table lists the principal facilities leased by us as of December 31, 2011:

 

Location

 

Function

 

Business Segment(s)

  Approximate
Square Feet
 

Reston, VA

  Administrative Offices   Consumer Lending; Business Services; FFELP Loans; Other     90,000   

Newark, DE

  Sallie Mae —Operations Center   Consumer Lending; Business Services; Other     86,000   

Niles, IL

  Collections Center   Other     84,000   

Newton, MA

  Upromise   Business Services     78,000   

Cincinnati, OH

  GRC Headquarters and Collections Center   Business Services     59,000   

Muncie, IN

  Collections Center   Consumer Lending; Business Services     54,000   

Moorestown, NJ

  Pioneer Credit Recovery — Collections Center   Business Services     30,000   

White Plains, NY(1)

  N/A   N/A     26,000   

Kansas City, MO

  Upromise and Campus Payment Solutions   Business Services     21,000   

Whitewater, WI(2)

  N/A   N/A     16,000   

Murray, UT

  Sallie Mae Bank   Consumer Lending; Business Services     10,000   

 

  (1)

Space vacated in December 2009 and lease terminated in February 2012.

 

  (2)

Space vacated in September 2010; we are actively searching for subtenants or tenants.

None of the facilities that we own is encumbered by a mortgage. We believe that our headquarters, loan servicing centers, data center, back-up facility and data management and collections centers are generally adequate to meet our long-term student loan and business goals. Our headquarters are currently in owned space at 300 Continental Drive, Newark, Delaware, 19713. We relocated our headquarters to Newark, Delaware from Reston, Virginia on March 31, 2011.

 

Item 3. Legal Proceedings

Investor Litigation

In Re SLM Corporation Securities Litigation. On January 31, 2008, a putative class action lawsuit was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging that the Company and certain officers violated federal securities laws by, among other things, issuing a series of materially false and misleading statements with respect to our financial results for year-end 2006 and the first quarter of 2007. This case and other actions arising out of the same circumstances and alleged acts have been consolidated and are now identified as In Re SLM Corporation Securities Litigation. The case purports to be brought on behalf of those who acquired our common stock between January 18, 2007 and January 23, 2008. On January 24, 2012, the court certified a class, appointed class counsel and appointed a class representative. On February 10, 2012, the parties entered into a settlement term sheet under which we agreed to pay $35 million, which amount includes all

 

19


Table of Contents

attorneys’ fees, administration costs, expenses, class member benefits, and costs of any kind associated with the resolution of this matter. We have denied vigorously all claims asserted against us, but agreed to settle to avoid the burden, expense, risk and uncertainty of continued litigation. The entire settlement amount will be paid by our insurers and the settlement is subject to us entering into a formal settlement agreement and Court approval.

In Re SLM Corporation ERISA Litigation. A similar case is pending against the Company, certain current and former officers, retirement plan fiduciaries, and the Board of Directors of the Company, formerly in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York and now before the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit, alleging breaches of fiduciary duties and prohibited transactions in violation of the Employee Retirement Income Security Act arising out of alleged false and misleading public statements regarding our business made during the 401K Class Period and investments in our common stock by plan participants in the 401K Plans. The case was originally filed on May 8, 2008 and the purported class consists of participants in or beneficiaries of the Sallie Mae 401(K) Retirement Savings Plan and Sallie Mae 401(k) Savings Plan (together, the “401K Plans”) between January 18, 2007 and “the present” whose accounts included investments in our common stock (“401K Class Period”). On September 24, 2010, this case was dismissed; however, the Plaintiffs appealed. The appeal is pending. In addition, the Plaintiffs filed a motion to hold the appeal in abeyance pending the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit’s decision in In re: Citigroup ERISA Litigation and Garren v. McGraw-Hill Cos., Inc., two cases with related issues of law. On October 11, 2011, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit held, among other things, that the Citigroup defendants’ decision not to divest the plan of Citigroup stock or impose restrictions on participants’ investment in that stock was entitled to a “presumption of prudence” and subject to “abuse of discretion” standard. The Plaintiffs in both those cases are seeking en banc review. The Plaintiffs/Appellants seek unspecified damages, attorneys’ fees, costs, and equitable and injunctive relief.

Lending and Collection Litigation and Investigations

U.S. ex rel. Batiste v. SLM Corporation, et al. On July 15, 2009, the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia unsealed the qui tam False Claims Act complaint of relator Sheldon Batiste, a former employee of SLM Financial Corporation, which alleged that we violated the False Claims Act by our “systemic failure to service loans and abide by forbearance regulations” and our “receipt of U.S. subsidies to which it was not entitled” through FFELP. On November 4, 2011, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the District of Columbia Circuit affirmed the U.S. District Court’s previous dismissal of the complaint in the fall of 2010.

Mark A. Arthur et al. v. Sallie Mae, Inc. On February 2, 2010, a putative class action suit was filed by a borrower in U.S. District Court for the Western District of Washington alleging that we contacted consumers on their cellular telephones via autodialer without their consent in violation of the Telephone Consumer Protection Act, 47 U.S.C. § 227 et seq. (“TCPA”). Each violation under the TCPA provides for $500 in statutory damages ($1,500 if a willful violation is shown). Plaintiffs were seeking statutory damages, damages for willful violations, attorneys’ fees, costs, and injunctive relief. On October 7, 2011, we entered into an amended settlement agreement under which the Company agreed to a settlement fund of $24.15 million. We have denied vigorously all claims asserted against us, but agreed to settle to avoid the burden, expense, risk and uncertainty of continued litigation. On January 10, 2012, the Court denied, without prejudice, the Motion for Preliminary Approval of the amended settlement agreement noting, however, that although the proposed settlement satisfies the Court’s requirement of overall fairness, the Court expressed concern regarding the proposed form of notice and other forms to be provided in connection with the settlement. On February 9, 2012, the Plaintiffs filed a Renewed Motion for Preliminary Approval addressing the Court’s concerns.

Rodriguez v. SLM Corporation et al. On December 17, 2007, plaintiffs filed a complaint against us in the U.S. District Court for the District of Connecticut alleging that we engaged in underwriting practices which, among other things, resulted in certain applicants for student loans being directed into substandard and expensive loans on the basis of race. On June 20, 2011, we agreed to settle the case and denied all allegations of wrongdoing and liability. We entered into the settlement to avoid the burden, expense, risk and uncertainty of

 

20


Table of Contents

continued litigation. On October 17, 2011, the court provided final approval of the settlement. We do not expect the settlement to have a material impact on our financial position or our business.

The Company and its subsidiaries and affiliates also are subject to various claims, lawsuits and other actions that arise in the normal course of business. Most of these matters are claims by borrowers disputing the manner in which their loans have been processed or the accuracy of our reports to credit bureaus. In addition, our collections subsidiaries are routinely named in individual plaintiff or class action lawsuits in which the plaintiffs allege that those subsidiaries have violated a federal or state law in the process of collecting their accounts. We believe that these claims, lawsuits and other actions will not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. Finally, from time to time, the Company receives information and document requests from state attorneys general and Congressional committees concerning certain business practices. Our practice has been and continues to be to cooperate with the state attorneys general and Congressional committees and to be responsive to any such requests.

 

Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures

N/A

 

21


Table of Contents

PART II.

 

Item 5. Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

Our common stock is listed and traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol SLM since December 12, 2011. Previously, our common stock was listed and traded on the New York Stock Exchange. As of January 31, 2012, there were 509,322,190 shares of our common stock outstanding and 504 holders of record. The following table sets forth the high and low sales prices for our common stock for each full quarterly period within the two most recent fiscal years.

Common Stock Prices

 

            1st Quarter      2nd Quarter      3rd Quarter      4th Quarter  

2011

     High       $ 15.60       $ 17.11       $ 17.11       $ 14.53   
     Low         12.61         14.40         11.60         10.91   

2010

     High       $ 13.32       $ 13.96       $ 12.40       $ 13.14   
     Low         10.01         9.85         10.05         10.92   

We paid quarterly cash dividends on our common stock of $.10 per share for the last three quarters of 2011.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

The following table provides information relating to our purchase of shares of our common stock in the three months ended December 31, 2011.

 

     Total Number
of Shares
Purchased(1)
     Average Price
Paid per
Share
     Total Number of
Shares  Purchased
as Part of Publicly
Announced Plans
or Programs(2)
     Maximum Number
of Shares that
May Yet Be
Purchased Under
the Plans or
Programs(2)
 

(Common shares in millions)

                           

Period:

           

October 1 – October 31, 2011

     —         $ —           —           —     

November 1 –November 30, 2011

     .1         13.49         —           —     

December 1 –December 31, 2011

     —              —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Total fourth quarter

     .1       $ 13.49         —        
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

  (1)

The total number of shares purchased includes: (i) shares purchased under the stock repurchase program discussed below and (ii) shares of our common stock tendered to us to satisfy the exercise price in connection with cashless exercise of stock options, and tax withholding obligations in connection with exercise of stock options and vesting of restricted stock and restricted stock units.

 

  (2) 

In April 2011, our board of directors authorized us to purchase up to $300 million of shares of our common stock in open market transactions, and terminated all previous authorizations. As of September 30, 2011, we had fully utilized this authorization and purchased 19.1 million shares of our common stock.

 

22


Table of Contents

Stock Performance

The following graph compares the yearly change in our cumulative total shareholder return on our common stock to that of Standard & Poor’s 500 Stock Index and Standard & Poor’s Financials Index. The graph assumes a base investment of $100 at December 31, 2006 and reinvestment of dividends through December 31, 2011.

Five Year Cumulative Total Shareholder Return

 

LOGO

 

Company/Index

   12/31/06      12/31/07      12/31/08      12/31/09      12/31/10      12/31/11  

SLM Corporation

   $ 100.0       $ 41.5       $ 18.4       $ 23.2       $ 26.0       $ 28.2   

S&P 500 Financials.

     100.0         81.9         37.5         43.7         49.0         40.7   

S&P Index

     100.0         105.5         66.9         84.3         96.8         98.8   

 

Source: Bloomberg Total Return Analysis

 

23


Table of Contents
Item 6. Selected Financial Data

Selected Financial Data 2007-2011

(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

The following table sets forth our selected financial and other operating information prepared in accordance with GAAP. The selected financial data in the table is derived from our consolidated financial statements. The data should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, related notes, and Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.”

 

     2011     2010     2009     2008     2007  

Operating Data:

          

Net interest income

   $ 3,529      $ 3,479      $ 1,723      $ 1,365      $ 1,588   

Net income (loss) attributable to SLM Corporation:

          

Continuing operations, net of tax

   $ 600      $ 597      $ 544      $ 2      $ (938

Discontinued operations, net of tax

     33        (67     (220     (215     42   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to SLM Corporation

   $ 633      $ 530      $ 324      $ (213   $ (896
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

          

Continuing operations

   $ 1.13      $ 1.08      $ .85      $ (.23   $ (2.36

Discontinued operations

     .06        (.14     (.47     (.46     .10   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.19      $ .94      $ .38      $ (.69   $ (2.26
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

          

Continuing operations

   $ 1.12      $ 1.08      $ .85      $ (.23   $ (2.36

Discontinued operations

     .06        (.14     (.47     (.46     .10   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.18      $ .94      $ .38      $ (.69   $ (2.26
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends per common share attributable to SLM Corporation common shareholders

   $ .30      $ —        $ —        $ —        $ .25   

Return on common stockholders’ equity

     14     13     5     (9 )%      (22 )% 

Net interest margin

     1.85        1.82        1.05        .93        1.26   

Return on assets

     .33        .28        .20        (.14     (.71

Dividend payout ratio

     25        —          —          —          (11

Average equity/average assets

     2.54        2.47        2.96        3.45        3.51   

Balance Sheet Data:

          

Student loans, net

   $ 174,420      $ 184,305      $ 143,807      $ 144,802      $ 124,153   

Total assets

     193,345        205,307        169,985        168,768        155,565   

Total borrowings

     183,966        197,159        161,443        160,158        147,046   

Total SLM Corporation stockholders’ equity

     5,243        5,012        5,279        4,999        5,224   

Book value per common share

     9.20        8.44        8.05        7.03        7.84   

Other Data:

          

Off-balance sheet securitized student loans, net

   $ —        $ —        $ 32,638      $ 35,591      $ 39,423   

 

24


Table of Contents
Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

The following discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with our Consolidated Financial Statements and related Notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. This discussion and analysis also contains forward-looking statements and should also be read in conjunction with the disclosures and information contained in “Forward-Looking and Cautionary Statements” and Item 1A “Risk Factors” in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Through this discussion and analysis, we intend to provide the reader with some narrative context for how our management views our consolidated financial statements, additional context within which to assess our operating results, and information on the quality and variability of our earnings, liquidity and cash flows.

Overview

Our primary business is to originate, service and collect loans we make to students and/or their parents to finance the cost of their education. The core of our marketing strategy is to generate student loan originations by promoting our products on campus through the financial aid office and through direct marketing to students and their families. We also provide servicing, loan default aversion and defaulted loan collection services for loans owned by other institutions, including ED. We also provide processing capabilities to educational institutions, 529 college-savings plan program management services and a consumer savings network.

In addition we are the largest holder, servicer and collector of loans made under FFELP, a program that was discontinued in 2010.

We monitor and assess our ongoing operations and results based on the following four reportable segments:

(1) Consumer Lending, (2) Business Services, (3) FFELP Loans and (4) Other.

Consumer Lending Segment

In this segment, we originate, acquire, finance and service Private Education Loans. The Private Education Loans we make are largely to bridge the gap between the cost of higher education and the amount funded through financial aid, federal loans or borrowers’ resources. In this segment, we earn net interest income on the Private Education Loan portfolio (after provision for loan losses) as well as servicing fees, primarily late fees. As of December 31, 2011, we had $36.3 billion of Private Education Loans outstanding. In 2011, we originated $2.7 billion of Private Education Loans, up 19 percent from $2.3 billion in the prior year.

Business Services Segment

In our Business Services segment we provide loan servicing to our FFELP Loans segment, ED and other third parties. We provide servicing, default aversion and contingency collections work on behalf of ED, Guarantors of FFELP Loans, and other institutions. Our Campus Solutions business provides comprehensive transaction processing solutions and associated technology to college financial aid offices and students to streamline the financial aid process. We provide 529 college-savings plan account asset servicing and other transaction processing activities. We offer, tuition, renters’ and student health insurance to college students and higher education institutions.

FFELP Loans Segment

Our FFELP Loans segment consists of our $138 billion FFELP Loan portfolio and underlying debt and capital funding these loans. Because we no longer originate FFELP Loans the portfolio is in runoff and is expected to amortize over approximately the next 20 years with a weighted average remaining life of 7.6 years.

 

25


Table of Contents

We actively seek to acquire FFELP Loan portfolios to leverage our servicing scale and expertise to generate incremental earnings and cash flow. Of our total FFELP Loan portfolio, 94 percent was funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 76 percent of our FFELP Loan portfolio being funded to term by securitization trusts, 15 percent funded through the ED Conduit Program which terminates on January 19, 2014, and 3 percent funded in our multi-year ABCP facility. This segment is expected to generate a stable net interest margin and significant amounts of cash as the FFELP portfolio amortizes.

Other

Our Other segment primarily consists of the financial results related to activities of our holding company, including the repurchase of debt, the corporate liquidity portfolio and all overhead. We also include results from smaller wind-down and discontinued operations within this segment.

Key Financial Measures

Our operating results are primarily driven by net interest income from our student loan portfolios (which includes financing costs), provision for loan losses, the revenues and expenses generated by our service businesses, and gains and losses on loan sales and debt repurchases. We manage and assess the performance of each business segment separately as each is focused on different customers and each derives its revenue from different activities and services. A brief summary of our key financial measures are listed below.

Net Interest Income

The most significant portion of our earnings is generated by the spread earned between the interest income we receive on assets in our student loan portfolios and the interest expense of funding these loans. We report these earnings as net interest income. Net interest income in our Consumer Lending and FFELP Loans segments are driven by significantly different factors.

Consumer Lending Segment

Net interest income in this segment is determined by the Private Education Loan asset yields, which are determined by interest rates established by us based upon the credit of the borrower and any co-borrower and the level of price competition in the Private Education Loan market less our cost of funds. Our Private Education Loans earn variable rate interest and are funded primarily with variable rate liabilities. The Consumer Lending segment’s “Core Earnings” net interest margin was 4.1 percent in 2011 compared with 3.9 percent in 2010. Our cost of funds can be influenced by a number of factors including the quality of the loans in our portfolio, our corporate credit rating, general economic conditions, investor demand for Private Education Loan ABS and corporate unsecured debt and competition in the deposit market. At December 31, 2011, 56 percent of our Private Education Loan portfolio was funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 51 percent of our Private Education Loans being funded to term by securitization trusts.

FFELP Loans Segment

Net interest income will be the primary source of cash flow generated by this segment over the next 20 years as this portfolio runs off. Historically, interest earned on our FFELP Loans was primarily indexed to commercial paper rates and our cost of funds was indexed to three-month LIBOR, creating the possibility of significant basis and repricing risk related to these assets. Recent changes to the applicable law will allow us, beginning in the second quarter of 2012, to index interest earned to one-month LIBOR rather than commercial paper rates, significantly reducing basis and repricing risk on $130 billion of our FFELP Loans. The FFELP Loans segment’s “Core Earnings” net interest margin was 0.98 percent in 2011 compared with 0.93 percent in 2010.

The major source of variability in net interest income is expected to be Floor Income. Pursuant to the terms of the FFELP, certain FFELP Loans, in certain situations, continue to earn interest at the stated fixed rate of

 

26


Table of Contents

interest even if underlying debt costs decrease. We refer to this additional spread income as “Floor Income”. This Floor Income can be volatile as rates on underlying debt move up and down. We generally hedge this risk by selling Floor Income Contracts which lock in the value of the Floor Income over the term of the contract.

Additional cash flow should be generated within this segment as many of our secured financing vehicles are over-collateralized, creating the potential for additional cash flow to be distributed to us over time as the loans amortize.

Provisions for Loan Losses

Management estimates and maintains an allowance for loan losses generally at a level sufficient to cover charge-offs expected over the next two years, plus additional allowance to cover life-of-loan expected losses for loans classified as a troubled debt restructuring. The provision is an income statement item that reduces segment revenues. Generally the allowance rises when charge-offs are expected to increase and falls when charge-offs are expected to decline. Our loss exposure and resulting provision for losses is smaller for FFELP Loans than for Private Education Loans because we bear a maximum of 3 percent loss exposure on our FFELP Loans whereas we bear the full credit exposure on our Private Education Loans. Our provision for losses in our FFELP Loans segment was $86 million in 2011 compared with $98 million in 2010. Losses in our Consumer Lending segment are primarily driven by risk characteristics such as school type, loan status (in-school, grace, forbearance, repayment and delinquency), loan seasoning (number of months in active repayment for which a scheduled payment was due), underwriting criteria (e.g., credit scores), existence or absence of a cosigner and the current economic environment. Our provision for loan losses in our Consumer Lending segment was $1.2 billion in 2011 compared with $1.3 billion in 2010.

Charge-Offs and Delinquencies

When we conclude a loan is uncollectable, the unrecoverable portion of the loan is charged against the allowance for loan losses in the applicable lending segment. Information regarding charge-offs provides relevant information over time with respect to the actual performance of our loan portfolios as compared against the provisions for loan losses on those portfolios. Management focuses on the overall level of delinquencies as well as the progression of loans from early to late stage delinquency. The FFELP segment charge-off rate was 0.08 percent of loans in repayment in 2011 compared with 0.11 percent in 2010. The Consumer Lending segment’s charge-off rate was 3.7 percent of loans in repayment in 2011 compared with 5.0 percent of loans in repayment in 2010. Delinquencies are a very important indicator of the potential future credit performance. Private Education Loan delinquencies as a percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment decreased from 10.6 percent at December 31, 2010 to 10.1 percent at December 31, 2011.

Servicing and Contingency Revenues

We earn servicing revenues from servicing student loans, Campus Solutions, and from account asset servicing related to 529 college-savings plans. We earn contingency revenue related to default aversion and contingency collections work we perform primarily on federal loans. The fees we recognize are primarily driven by our success in collecting or rehabilitating defaulted loans, the number of transactions processed and the underlying volume of loans we are servicing on behalf of others.

Other Income / (Loss)

In managing our loan portfolios and funding sources we periodically engage in sales of loans and the repurchase of our outstanding debt. In each case, depending on market conditions, we may incur gains or losses from these transactions that affect our results from operations.

 

27


Table of Contents

Operating Expenses

The operating expenses reported for our Consumer Lending and Business Services segments are those that are directly attributable to the generation of revenues by those segments. The operating expenses for the FFELP Loans segment primarily represent an intercompany servicing charge from the Business Services segment and do not reflect our actual underlying costs incurred to service the loans. We have included corporate overhead expenses and certain information technology costs (together referred to as “Overhead”) in our Other segment rather than allocate those expenses by segment. These overhead expenses include costs related to executive management, the board of directors, accounting, finance, legal, human resources, stock-based compensation expense and certain information technology costs related to infrastructure and operations.

Core Earnings

We report financial results on a GAAP basis and also present certain “Core Earnings” performance measures. Our management, equity investors, credit rating agencies and debt capital providers use these “Core Earnings” measures to monitor our business performance. “Core Earnings” is the basis in which we prepare our segment disclosures as required by GAAP under ASC 280 “Segment Reporting” (see “Note 16—Segment Reporting”). For a full explanation of the contents and limitations of “Core Earnings,” see “‘Core Earnings’—Definition and Limitations” of this Item 7.

2011 Summary of Results

We continue to operate in a challenging macroeconomic environment marked by high unemployment and uncertainty which contributes added uncertainty to Private Education Loan repayment and default patterns. On July 1, 2010, the HCERA eliminated FFELP Loan originations, a major source of our net income. All federal loans to students are now made through the DSLP and as discussed above, we no longer originate FFELP Loans. In addition, on July 21, 2010, President Obama signed into law the Dodd-Frank Act that represents a comprehensive change to banking laws, imposing significant new regulation on almost every aspect of the U.S. financial services industry. A discussion of HCERA and the Dodd-Frank Act can be found in Item 1 “Business” and in Item 1A “Risk Factors” in our 2011 Form 10-K.

Despite this environment, we were able to achieve significant accomplishments during 2011 as discussed below.

GAAP 2011 net income was $633 million ($1.18 diluted earnings per share), versus net income of $530 million ($.94 diluted earnings per share) in the prior year. The changes in GAAP net income are driven by the same “Core Earnings” items discussed below as well as changes in “mark-to-market” unrealized gains and losses on derivative contracts and impairment of goodwill and intangible assets that are recognized in GAAP but not in core earnings results. In 2011, we had a $623 million increase in unrealized mark-to-market losses on derivative contracts and $660 million less goodwill and intangible asset impairment compared with 2010.

“Core Earnings” for the year were $977 million ($1.83 diluted earnings per share) compared to $1.03 billion ($1.92 diluted earnings per share) in 2010. “Core Earnings” were down due to a decrease in gains on loan sales and debt repurchases from the prior year ($574 million or $.69 per diluted share in 2010). Excluding these gains on loan sales and debt repurchases in 2010, “Core Earnings” were up $521 million year-over-year due to improvements in net interest income, loan loss provision, expenses and discontinued operations.

During 2011, we raised $2 billion of unsecured debt and issued $2.4 billion of FFELP ABS and $2.1 billion of Private Education Loan ABS. We also repurchased $894 million of debt and realized “Core Earnings” gains of $64 million in 2011, compared with $4.9 billion and $317 million in 2010.

 

28


Table of Contents

In the fourth-quarter 2011, we also closed a $3.4 billion Private Education Loan asset-backed commercial paper facility that matures in January 2014. This facility was used to finance the call of Private Education Loan asset-backed securities at significant discounts to the par value.

We also achieved a key management objective of again being able to return capital to our shareholders. During the second and third quarters of 2011, we repurchased 19.1 million common shares on the open market as part of our previously announced $300 million share repurchase program authorization. We have fully utilized this authorization. We declared and paid a $.10 per share dividend during the second, third and fourth quarters of 2011.

2011 Management Objectives

In 2011 we set out five major goals to create shareholder value. They were: (1) reduce our operating expenses; (2) prudently grow Consumer Lending segment assets and revenue; (3) increase Business Services segment revenue; (4) maximize cash flows from FFELP Loans; and (5) reinstate dividends and/or share repurchases. We believe we achieved each of these objectives in 2011. The following describes our performance relative to each of our 2011 goals.

Reduce Operating Expenses

The elimination of FFELP by HCERA greatly reduced our revenue generating capabilities. In 2010 we originated $14 billion of loans, 84 percent of them FFELP Loans; in 2011 we originated $2.7 billion of new loans, all of them Private Education Loans. As a result of the decline in our FFELP related revenue, we determined we must effectively match our cost structure to our ongoing business. As such, we set a goal of having a quarterly operating expense of $250 million in the fourth quarter of 2011 (by comparison, our 2010 fourth-quarter operating expenses were $308 million). We achieved this goal as our fourth-quarter 2011 operating expenses were $243 million.

Prudently Grow Consumer Lending Segment Assets and Revenue

Successfully growing Private Education Loan lending is the key component of our long-term plan to grow shareholder value. We achieved this goal by originating increasing numbers of high quality Private Education Loans, with higher net interest margins and lower charge-offs and provision for loan losses. Originations were 19 percent higher in 2011 compared with 2010 with average FICO and cosigner rates higher compared with the prior year. “Core Earnings” net interest margin increased from 3.9 percent to 4.1 percent. Charge-offs decreased to 3.7 percent of loans in repayment from 5.0 percent in 2010. Provision for loan loss decreased to $1.18 billion from $1.3 billion in 2010.

Increase Business Services Segment Revenue

Our Business Services segment comprises several businesses with customers related to FFELP that will experience revenue declines and several businesses with customers that provide growth opportunities. Our growth businesses are ED servicing, ED collections, other school-based asset type servicing and collections, Campus Solutions, Sallie Mae Insurance Services, transaction processing and 529 college-savings plan account asset servicing. We achieved this goal as our Business Services segment revenue increased from $1.3 billion in 2010 to $1.4 billion in 2011.

 

   

Our allocation of new customer loans awarded for servicing under our ED Servicing Contract increased from 22 percent to 26 percent for the current contract year ending August 15, 2012. The increase was driven primarily by our top ranking for default prevention performance results. We are servicing approximately 3.6 million accounts under the ED Servicing Contract as of December 31, 2011.

 

   

Campus Solutions added 44 new refund disbursement clients in 2011. We also announced a Sallie Mae Bank No-Fee Student Checking Account with Debit as an enhanced refund disbursement choice for schools and students. This new option complements existing Campus Solutions refund disbursement choices that include electronic deposit to the bank account of the student’s choice, debit card or a check.

 

29


Table of Contents
   

Assets under management in 529 college-savings plans total $37.5 billion and grew 9 percent year-over-year. We recently were selected to continue as the program manager for New York’s 529 College Savings Program under a seven-year contract, which is currently being negotiated. New York has the largest direct 529 plan in the country.

 

   

We launched Sallie Mae Insurance Services in 2011, offering college students and higher education institutions tuition, renters’ and student health insurance.

 

   

We acquired SC Services & Associates, Inc., a provider of collections services to local governments and courts to enhance and complement our other contingency collection businesses.

Maximize Cash Flows from FFELP Loans

We have a $138 billion portfolio of FFELP Loans that is expected to generate significant amounts of cash flow and earnings in the coming years. We planned to improve our net interest margin, further minimize income volatility and opportunistically purchase additional FFELP Loan portfolios such as the portfolio we purchased at the end of 2010. We achieved this goal in 2011 by acquiring $1.6 billion of FFELP loans and improving our net interest margin from 93 basis points in 2010 to 98 basis points in 2011.

Reinstate Dividends and/or Share Repurchases

We achieved our objective of either paying dividends or repurchasing shares, or both by the second half of 2011. Beginning in June, we began to pay quarterly dividends of $.10 per share on our common stock, the first since 2007. In April 2011, we authorized the repurchase of up to $300 million of outstanding common stock in open-market transactions and terminated all previous authorizations. During the second and third quarters of 2011, we paid $300 million to repurchase 19.1 million common shares on the open market.

2012 Outlook

We expect the operating strength we demonstrated in 2011 to continue in 2012. We plan to increase “Core Earnings” primarily through improving Private Education Loan portfolio performance and lower operating expenses. Loan originations are also expected to increase in 2012.

We expect to remain an active participant in the capital markets in 2012. Our term ABS activity will feature multiple transactions backed by both FFELP collateral, primarily reducing the ED Conduit Facility, as well as Private Education Loan collateral. We will remain an opportunistic issuer in the unsecured debt markets primarily to facilitate asset liability management activities. Recent transactions in all of the above mentioned categories have been met with strong demand and provide term financing which is a key component of our business model.

Recognizing the strong financial position we are in, the Board of Directors approved a 25 percent increase in our quarterly dividend and a $500 million share repurchase program in January 2012. Despite this significant return of capital to our shareholders from earnings, we expect to end 2012 with a stronger balance sheet and better capital ratios.

Credit losses within our Private Education Loan portfolio are primarily driven by the quality of loans entering repayment, improving underlying portfolio quality, the quality of new originations and the general economic environment. The fourth-quarter 2011 repayment cohort, at $1.5 billion, was the smallest in the last five years, and had better FICO scores and higher cosigner rates than in previous years which should result in lower future losses. The underlying portfolio has continued to improve with 62 percent of the loans cosigned, less than 10 percent non-traditional and over 72 percent of our customers currently in repayment having made more than 12 payments. In addition, the loans originated in 2011 had an average FICO score of 748 and were 91 percent cosigned; these statistics are our highest ever for a loan origination cohort. As a result, we believe that charge-offs and provision for loan losses will continue their downward trend.

 

30


Table of Contents

2012 Management Objectives

In 2012 we have set out five major goals to create shareholder value. They are: (1) prudently grow Consumer Lending segment assets and revenue; (2) sustain Business Services segment revenue; (3) maximize cash flows from FFELP Loans; (4) reduce our operating expenses; and (5) improve our financial strength. Here is how we plan to achieve these objectives:

Prudently Grow Consumer Lending Segment Assets and Revenues

We will continue to pursue managed growth in our Private Education Loan portfolio in 2012, currently targeting $3.2 billion in new originations for the year compared to $2.7 billion in 2011. We will also be increasing our efforts to improve our return on these assets projecting even lower charge-off rates and provision for loan losses, continuing to build on the improvements we have been demonstrating in these measures since 2009.

Sustain Business Services Segment Revenue

Our Business Services segment generates the vast majority of its revenue from servicing and collecting on our FFELP Loan portfolio and FFELP Loans for others. As a result of the elimination of FFELP in 2010, servicing and collection revenues derived from FFELP-related sources are in decline. In 2012 we will work to offset these declines through two primary means—pursuing additional growth and expansion of our non-FFELP - related servicing and collection businesses and seeking to increase the FFELP-related loan servicing and collection work we do for third parties. In 2012 we are targeting significant growth in the number of customers we service for ED under our ED servicing and collection contracts, as well as in the total assets under management in our 529 college-savings plans. We will explore both complementary and diversified strategies to expand demand for our services in and beyond the student loan market. We will also more aggressively seek to leverage our existing FFELP servicing platforms to be able to provide lower cost FFELP servicing to others while increasing segment revenues from these sources.

Maximize Cash Flows from FFELP Loans

In 2012 we will continue to focus on opportunistically purchasing additional FFELP Loan portfolios from other lenders. As cash flows from our existing FFELP Loans decline over coming years, it also becomes increasingly important that we actively manage and continue to reduce operating and overhead costs attributable to the maintenance and management of this segment. Continuing to reduce these operating and overhead costs will also increase net income for our Business Services segment.

Reduce Operating Expenses

We achieved our 2011 management objective of having a quarterly operating expense of $250 million or less in the fourth quarter of 2011. In 2012 we will strive to sustain or improve on this quarterly run rate for the full fiscal year.

Improve Our Financial Strength

In January 2012 we announced an increase in our quarterly dividend to $0.125 per share and a new $500 million common share repurchase program. Of equal note, it is management’s objective for 2012 to provide these increased shareholder distributions while at the same time ending 2012 with a balance sheet and capital positions as strong or stronger than those with which we ended in 2011.

 

31


Table of Contents

Results of Operations

We present the results of operations first on a consolidated basis in accordance with GAAP. As discussed earlier, we have four business segments, Consumer Lending, Business Services, FFELP Loans and Other. Since these segments operate in distinct business environments, the discussion following the Consolidated Earnings Summary is presented on a segment basis and is shown on a “Core Earnings” basis. See Item 1 “Business — Business Segments” for further discussion on the components of each segment.

 

32


Table of Contents

GAAP Statements of Income

 

           Increase (Decrease)  
     Years Ended December 31,     2011 vs. 2010     2010 vs. 2009  

(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

   2011     2010     2009     $     %     $     %  

Interest income

              

FFELP Loans

   $ 3,461      $ 3,345      $ 3,094      $ 116        3   $ 251        8

Private Education Loans

     2,429        2,353        1,582        76        3        771        49   

Other loans

     21        30        56        (9     (30     (26     (46

Cash and investments

     19        26        26        (7     (27     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     5,930        5,754        4,758        176        3        996        21   

Total interest expense

     2,401        2,275        3,035        126        6        (760     (25
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     3,529        3,479        1,723        50        1        1,756        102   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     1,295        1,419        1,119        (124     (9     300        27   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

     2,234        2,060        604        174        8        1,456        241   

Other income (loss):

              

Securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue

     —          —          295        —          —          (295     (100

Gains (losses) on loans and investments, net

     (35     325        284        (360     (111     41        14   

Losses on derivative and hedging activities, net

     (959     (361     (604     (598     166        243        (40

Servicing revenue

     381        405        440        (24     (6     (35     (8

Contingency revenue

     333        330        294        3        1        36        12   

Gains on debt repurchases

     38        317        536        (279     (88     (219     (41

Other income

     68        6        88        62        1,033        (82     (93
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income (loss)

     (174     1,022        1,333        (1,196     (117     (311     (23

Expenses:

              

Operating expenses

     1,100        1,208        1,043        (108     (9     165        16   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization expense

     24        699        76        (675     (97     623        820   

Restructuring expenses

     9        85        10        (76     (89     75        750   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     1,133        1,992        1,129        (859     (43     863        76   

Income from continuing operations, before income tax expense

     927        1,090        808        (163     (15     282        35   

Income tax expense

     328        493        264        (165     (33     229        87   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income from continuing operations

     599        597        544        2        —          53        10   

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

     33        (67     (220     100        149        153        (70
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

     632        530        324        102        19        206        64   

Less: net loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

     (1     —          —          (1     (100     —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to SLM Corporation

     633        530        324        103        19        206        64   

Preferred stock dividends

     18        72        146        (54     (75     (74     (51
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to SLM Corporation common stock

   $ 615      $ 458      $ 178      $ 157        34   $ 280        157
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

              

Continuing operations

   $ 1.13      $ 1.08      $ .85      $ .05        5   $ .23        27

Discontinued operations

     .06        (.14     (.47     .20        143        .33        (70
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.19      $ .94      $ .38      $ .25        27   $ .56        147
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

              

Continuing operations

   $ 1.12      $ 1.08      $ .85      $ .04        4   $ .23        27

Discontinued operations

     .06        (.14     (.47     .20        143        .33        (70
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.18      $ .94      $ .38      $ .24        26   $ .56        147
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends per common share

   $ .30      $ —        $ —        $ .30        100   $ —          —  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

33


Table of Contents

Consolidated Earnings Summary — GAAP-basis

Year Ended December 31, 2011 Compared with Year Ended December 31, 2010

For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, net income was $633 million, or $1.18 diluted earnings per common share, and $530 million, or $.94 diluted earnings per common share, respectively. The increase in net income for the year ended December 31, 2011 as compared with the prior year period was primarily due to $660 million of goodwill and intangible asset impairment charges, which were partially non-tax deductible, recorded in the year-ago period, a $124 million decrease in the provisions for loan losses, a $100 million increase in income from discontinued operations and $108 million of lower operating expenses. These improvements were partially offset by a $598 million increase in net losses on derivative and hedging activities, a $279 million decrease in gains on debt repurchases and a $360 million decrease in net gains on loans and investments.

The primary contributors to each component of net income for the current year compared with the year-ago period are as follows:

 

   

Net interest income increased by $50 million primarily from incremental net interest income earned on $25 billion of securitized FFELP loans acquired on December 31, 2010.

 

   

Provisions for loan losses decreased by $124 million, as the $124 million of additional provision related to the implementation of new accounting guidance for troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”) in the third quarter of 2011 (see “Consumer Lending Segment — Private Education Loans Provision for Loan Losses and Charge-offs” for further discussion), was more than offset by overall improvements in credit quality and delinquency and charge-off trends.

 

   

Gains on loans and investments, net, declined $360 million as a result of a $321 million gain recognized in the fourth quarter of 2010 from the sale of FFELP Loans to ED as part of the ED’s Loan Purchase Commitment Program (the “Purchase Program”) which ended in 2010. Also, in 2011 we recorded $26 million of impairment on certain aircraft leases which were primarily related to leveraged lease investments with American Airlines, which filed for bankruptcy in the fourth quarter of 2011. 2011 also has a $9 million mark-to-market loss related to classifying our entire $12 million portfolio of non-U.S. dollar-denominated student loans as held-for-sale.

 

   

Net losses on derivatives and hedging activities increased by $598 million primarily due to interest rate and foreign currency fluctuations, affecting the valuations of our Floor Income Contracts, basis swaps and foreign currency hedges during the period. Valuations of derivative instruments vary based upon many factors including changes in interest rates, credit risk, foreign currency fluctuations and other market factors. As a result, net gains and losses on derivatives and hedging activities may vary significantly in future periods.

 

   

Servicing revenue decreased by $24 million primarily due to the end of FFELP in 2010, thereby eliminating Guarantor issuance fees we earn on new FFELP Loans. Outstanding FFELP Loans on which we earn additional fees also declined.

 

   

Gains on debt repurchases decreased $279 million as we repurchased less debt in the current period. Debt repurchase activity will fluctuate based on market fundamentals and our liability management strategy.

 

   

Other income increased by $62 million primarily as a result of a $25 million gain from the termination and replacement of a credit card affiliation contract and $27 million from an increase in foreign currency translation gains. The foreign currency translation gains relate to a portion of our foreign currency denominated debt that does not receive hedge accounting treatment. These gains were partially offset by “losses on derivative and hedging activities, net” line item in the consolidated statements of income related to the derivatives used to economically hedge these debt investments.

 

   

Operating expenses decreased $108 million primarily as a result of our on-going cost savings initiative.

 

34


Table of Contents
   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization expense declined $675 million compared with the prior year primarily due to the $660 million impairment recognized in the third quarter of 2010 in response to the passage of the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010 (“HCERA”), which resulted in the elimination of the FFELP and significantly reduced the future earnings for several of our reporting units.

 

   

Restructuring expenses decreased $76 million primarily as a result of the substantial completion of our plan for restructuring initiated in response to legislation ending FFELP in 2010.

 

   

The effective tax rates for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 were 35 percent and 45 percent, respectively. The improvement in the effective tax rate was primarily driven by the impact of non-tax deductible goodwill impairments recorded in 2010.

 

   

Net income from discontinued operations for the year ended December 31, 2011 was $33 million compared with a net loss from discontinued operations of $67 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. The change was primarily driven by a $23 million after-tax gain realized from the sale of our Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage portfolio in the third quarter of 2011 compared to $52 million of after-tax impairments recognized in 2010.

Year Ended December 31, 2010 Compared with Year Ended December 31, 2009

For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, net income was $530 million, or $.94 diluted earnings per common share, and $324 million, or $.38 diluted earnings per common share, respectively. The increase in net income for the year ended December 31, 2010, compared with the prior year was primarily due to a $1.5 billion increase in net interest income after provisions for loan losses and a $243 million decrease in net losses on derivative and hedging activities. These improvements were partially offset by a $660 million goodwill and intangible asset impairment charge in 2010, a $165 million increase in operating expenses, a $219 million decrease in gains on debt repurchases and a decrease in securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue of $295 million.

The primary contributors to each of the identified drivers of changes in income from continuing operations before income tax expense for the year-over-year period are as follows:

 

   

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses increased by $1.5 billion in the year ended December 31, 2010 from the year ended December 31, 2009. The increase in net interest income and provisions for loan losses was partially due to the adoption as of January 1, 2010 of the new consolidation accounting guidance which resulted in the consolidation of $35.0 billion of assets and $34.4 billion of liabilities in certain securitizations trusts. (See “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies” for a further discussion of the effect of adopting the new consolidation accounting guidance). The consolidation of these securitization trusts as of January 1, 2010 resulted in $998 million of additional net interest income and $355 million of additional provisions for loan losses for the year ended December 31, 2010. Excluding the effect of the trusts being consolidated as of January 1, 2010, net interest income increased $758 million from the year ended 2009 and provisions for loan losses decreased $55 million from the year ended 2009. The increase in net interest income, excluding the effect of the new consolidation accounting guidance, was primarily the result of an increase in the FFELP Loans net interest margin primarily due to an improvement in our funding costs, a 24 basis point tightening of the CP/LIBOR spread and the effect of not receiving hedge accounting treatment for derivatives used to economically hedge risk affecting net interest income. The decrease in the provisions for loan losses relates to the Private Education Loan loss provision, which decreased as a result of the improving performance of the portfolio.

 

   

Securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue was no longer recorded in fiscal year 2010 due to the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance; however, we recognized $295 million in the prior year.

 

35


Table of Contents
   

Gains on loans and investments, net, increased $41 million from the prior year primarily related to the gains on sales of additional FFELP Loans to ED as part of ED’s Loan Purchase Commitment Program (the “Purchase Program”). These gains will not occur in the future as the Purchase Program ended in 2010.

 

   

Losses on derivatives and hedging activities, net, declined by $243 million in 2010 compared with 2009, primarily due to interest rate and foreign currency fluctuations, which primarily affected the valuations of our Floor Income Contracts, basis swaps and foreign currency hedges during the period. Valuations of derivative instruments vary based upon many factors including changes in interest rates, credit risk, foreign currency fluctuations and other market factors. As a result, net gains and losses on derivatives and hedging activities may vary significantly in future periods.

 

   

Servicing revenue decreased by $35 million primarily due to HCERA becoming effective as of July 1, 2010, thereby eliminating our ability to earn additional Guarantor issuance fees on new FFELP Loans, as well as to a decline in outstanding FFELP Loans for which we were earning additional fees.

 

   

Contingency revenue increased $36 million primarily from increased collections on defaulted FFELP Loans.

 

   

Gains on debt repurchases decreased $219 million year-over-year while the principal amount of debt repurchased increased to $4.9 billion, as compared with the $3.4 billion repurchased in fiscal year 2009. Debt repurchase activity will fluctuate based on market fundamentals and our liability management strategy.

 

   

Other income declined by $82 million primarily due to a $71 million decrease in foreign currency translation gains. The foreign currency translation gains relate to a portion of our foreign currency denominated debt that does not receive hedge accounting treatment. These gains were partially offset by the “losses on derivative and hedging activities, net” line item on the income statement related to the derivatives used to economically hedge these debt instruments.

 

   

Operating expenses, excluding restructuring-related asset impairments of $19 million in 2010, increased $146 million year-over-year primarily due to an increase in legal contingency expense, costs related to the ED Servicing Contract, higher collection and servicing costs from a higher number of loans in repayment and in delinquent status, and higher marketing and technology enhancement costs related to Private Education Loans.

 

   

Goodwill and intangible asset impairment and amortization increased $623 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, primarily due to the $660 million of impairment recognized as a result of the passage of HCERA and its negative effects on the anticipated cash flows for certain of our reporting units and the reduced market values of these units. The amortization of acquired intangibles for continuing operations and for discontinued operations each remained relatively unchanged for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. For additional discussion regarding the impairment of goodwill and intangible assets see “Note 5 — Goodwill and Acquired Intangible Assets.”

 

   

Restructuring expenses increased $69 million in the year ended December 31, 2010, which is a result of a $75 million increase in restructuring expenses in continuing operations partially offset by a $6 million decrease in restructuring expenses attributable to discontinued operations. The following details our ongoing restructuring efforts:

 

   

On March 30, 2010, President Obama signed into law H.R. 4872, HCERA, which included the SAFRA Act. Effective July 1, 2010, this legislation eliminated FFELP and requires all new federal loans to be made through the DSLP. The new law did not alter or affect the terms and conditions of existing FFELP Loans. We have and will continue to restructure our operations in response to this change in law which has and will continue to result in a significant reduction of operating costs due to the elimination of positions and facilities associated with the origination of FFELP Loans. Restructuring expenses associated with continuing operations under this restructuring plan were $83 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. We expect to incur an estimated $10 million of additional restructuring expenses.

 

36


Table of Contents
   

In response to the College Cost Reduction and Access Act of 2007 (“CCRAA”) and challenges in the capital markets, we also initiated a restructuring plan in the fourth quarter of 2007. Under this ongoing plan, restructuring expenses associated with continuing operations of $2 million and $10 million were recognized in the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively. This restructuring plan was essentially completed in the fourth quarter of 2009.

 

   

Income tax expense from continuing operations increased $229 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 as compared with the prior year. The effective tax rates for fiscal years 2010 and 2009 were 45 percent and 33 percent, respectively. The change in the effective tax rate was primarily driven by the impact of non-deductible goodwill impairments recorded in 2010 and state tax rate changes recorded in both periods.

 

   

Net loss from discontinued operations in the year ended December 31, 2010 was $67 million compared with a net loss from discontinued operations of $220 million for the year ended December 31, 2009. In the fourth quarter of 2009, we sold our Purchased Paper — Mortgage/Properties business for $280 million which resulted in an after-tax loss of $95 million. As a result of this sale, the results of operations of this business were presented in discontinued operations in the fourth quarter of 2009. In the fourth quarter of 2010, we began actively marketing our Purchased Paper — Non Mortgage business for sale and began presenting its results in discontinued operations. We recorded an after-tax loss of $52 million from discontinued operations in the fourth quarter of 2010, primarily due to adjusting the value of this business to its estimated fair value. We sold our Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business in the third quarter of 2011. Our Purchased Paper businesses are presented in discontinued operations for the current and prior periods. The additional losses for both years that are more than the losses discussed above relate to ongoing impairment recorded as a result of the weakened economy’s effect on our ability to collect the receivables.

“Core Earnings” — Definition and Limitations

We prepare financial statements in accordance with GAAP. However, we also evaluate our business segments on a basis that differs from GAAP. We refer to this different basis of presentation as “Core Earnings”. We provide this “Core Earnings” basis of presentation on a consolidated basis for each business segment because this is what we internally review when making management decisions regarding our performance and how we allocate resources. We also refer to this information in our presentations with credit rating agencies, lenders and investors. Because our “Core Earnings” basis of presentation corresponds to our segment financial presentations, we are required by GAAP to provide “Core Earnings” disclosure in the notes to our consolidated financial statements for our business segments. For additional information, see “Note 16 — Segment Reporting.”

“Core Earnings” are not a substitute for reported results under GAAP. We use “Core Earnings” to manage each business segment because “Core Earnings” reflect adjustments to GAAP financial results for three items, discussed below, that create significant volatility mostly due to timing factors generally beyond the control of management. Accordingly, we believe that “Core Earnings” provide management with a useful basis from which to better evaluate results from ongoing operations against the business plan or against results from prior periods. Consequently, we disclose this information as we believe it provides investors with additional information regarding the operational and performance indicators that are most closely assessed by management. The three items adjusted for in our “Core Earnings” presentations are (1) our use of derivatives instruments to hedge our economic risks that do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment or do qualify for hedge accounting treatment but result in ineffectiveness (2) the accounting for goodwill and acquired intangible assets and (3) the off-balance sheet treatment of certain securitization transactions.

 

37


Table of Contents

While GAAP provides a uniform, comprehensive basis of accounting, for the reasons described above, our “Core Earnings” basis of presentation does not. “Core Earnings” are subject to certain general and specific limitations that investors should carefully consider. For example, there is no comprehensive, authoritative guidance for management reporting. Our “Core Earnings” are not defined terms within GAAP and may not be comparable to similarly titled measures reported by other companies. Accordingly, our “Core Earnings” presentation does not represent a comprehensive basis of accounting. Investors, therefore, may not be able to compare our performance with that of other financial services companies based upon “Core Earnings.” “Core Earnings” results are only meant to supplement GAAP results by providing additional information regarding the operational and performance indicators that are most closely used by management, our board of directors, rating agencies, lenders and investors to assess performance.

Specific adjustments that management makes to GAAP results to derive our “Core Earnings” basis of presentation are described in detail in the section entitled “‘Core Earnings’ — Definition and Limitations — Differences between ‘Core Earnings’ and GAAP” of this Item 7.

The following tables show “Core Earnings” for each business segment and our business as a whole along with the adjustments made to the income/expense items to reconcile the amounts to our reported GAAP results as required by GAAP and reported in “Note 16 — Segment Reporting.”

 

38


Table of Contents

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

   Consumer
Lending
    Business
Services
     FFELP
Loans
    Other     Eliminations(1)     Total  “Core
Earnings”
    Adjustments(2)     Total
GAAP
 

Interest income:

                 

Student loans

   $ 2,429      $ —         $ 2,914      $ —        $ —        $ 5,343      $ 547      $ 5,890   

Other loans

     —          —           —          21        —          21        —          21   

Cash and investments

     9        11         5        5        (11     19        —          19   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     2,438        11         2,919        26        (11     5,383        547        5,930   

Total interest expense

     804        —           1,472        54        (11     2,319        82        2,401   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     1,634        11         1,447        (28     —          3,064        465        3,529   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     1,179        —           86        30        —          1,295        —          1,295   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after
provisions for loan losses

     455        11         1,361        (58     —          1,769        465        2,234   

Servicing revenue

     64        970         85        1        (739     381        —          381   

Contingency revenue

     —          333         —          —          —          333        —          333   

Gains on debt repurchases

     —          —           —          64        —          64        (26     38   

Other income (loss)

     (9     70         1        (9     —          53        (979     (926
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income (loss)

     55        1,373         86        56        (739     831        (1,005     (174

Expenses:

                 

Direct operating expenses

     304        482         760        12        (739     819        —          819   

Overhead expenses

     —          —           —          281        —          281        —          281   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

     304        482         760        293        (739     1,100        —          1,100   

Goodwill and acquired intangible

assets impairment and amortization

     —          —           —          —          —          —          24        24   

Restructuring expenses

     3        3         1        2        —          9        —          9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     307        485         761        295        (739     1,109        24        1,133   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations, before income tax expense (benefit)

     203        899         686        (297     —          1,491        (564     927   

Income tax expense (benefit)(3)

     75        330         252        (109     —          548        (220     328   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

     128        569         434        (188     —          943        (344     599   

Income from discontinued operations, net of taxes

     —          —           —          33        —          33        —          33   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     128        569         434        (155     —          976        (344     632   

Less: loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

     —          (1      —          —          —          (1     —          (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to SLM Corporation

   $ 128      $ 570       $ 434      $ (155   $ —        $ 977      $ (344   $ 633   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The eliminations in servicing revenue and direct operating expense represent the elimination of intercompany servicing revenue where the Business Services segment performs the loan servicing function for the FFELP Loans segment.

 

(2)

“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

   Net Impact
of
Derivative
Accounting
     Net Impact of
Goodwill and
Acquired
Intangibles
     Total  

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

   $ 465       $ —         $ 465   

Total other loss

     (1,005      —           (1,005

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment
and amortization

     —           24         24   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

   $ (540    $ (24      (564
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Income tax benefit

           (220
        

 

 

 

Net loss

         $ (344
        

 

 

 
(3) 

Income taxes are based on a percentage of net income before tax for the individual reportable segment.

 

39


Table of Contents
     Year Ended December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Consumer
Lending
    Business
Services
     FFELP
Loans
    Other     Eliminations(1)     Total  “Core
Earnings”
    Adjustments(2)     Total
GAAP
 

Interest income:

                 

Student loans

   $ 2,353      $ —         $ 2,766      $ —        $ —        $ 5,119      $ 579      $ 5,698   

Other loans

     —          —           —          30        —          30        —          30   

Cash and investments

     14        17         9        3        (17     26        —          26   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     2,367        17         2,775        33        (17     5,175        579        5,754   

Total interest expense

     758        —           1,407        45        (17     2,193        82        2,275   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss)

     1,609        17         1,368        (12     —          2,982        497        3,479   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     1,298        —           98        23        —          1,419        —          1,419   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss) after provisions for loan losses

     311        17         1,270        (35     —          1,563        497        2,060   

Servicing revenue

     72        912         68        1        (648     405        —          405   

Contingency revenue

     —          330         —          —          —          330        —          330   

Gains on debt repurchases

     —          —           —          317        —          317        —          317   

Other income (loss)

     —          51         320        13        —          384        (414     (30
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income

     72        1,293         388        331        (648     1,436        (414     1,022   

Expenses:

                 

Direct operating expenses

     350        500         736        12        (648     950        —          950   

Overhead expenses

     —          —           —          258        —          258        —          258   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

     350        500         736        270        (648     1,208        —          1,208   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

     —          —           —          —          —          —          699        699   

Restructuring expenses

     12        7         54        12        —          85        —          85   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     362        507         790        282        (648     1,293        699        1,992   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from continuing operations, before income tax expense

     21        803         868        14        —          1,706        (616     1,090   

Income tax expense(3)

     8        288         311        4        —          611        (118     493   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income from continuing operations

     13        515         557        10        —          1,095        (498     597   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of taxes

     —          —           —          (67     —          (67     —          (67
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ 13      $ 515       $ 557      $ (57   $ —        $ 1,028      $ (498   $ 530   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The eliminations in servicing revenue and direct operating expense represent the elimination of intercompany servicing revenue where the Business Services segment performs the loan servicing function for the FFELP Loans segment.

 

(2) 

“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Net Impact
of
Derivative
Accounting
     Net Impact of
Goodwill and
Acquired
Intangibles
     Total  

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

   $ 497       $ —         $ 497   

Total other loss

     (414      —           (414)   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment
and amortization

     —           699         699   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

   $ 83       $ (699      (616)   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Income tax benefit

           (118)   
        

 

 

 

Net loss

         $ (498)   
        

 

 

 
(3)

Income taxes are based on a percentage of net income before tax for the individual reportable segment.

 

40


Table of Contents

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Consumer
Lending
    Business
Services
     FFELP
Loans
    Other     Eliminations(1)     Total  “Core
Earnings”
    Adjustments(2)     Total
GAAP
 

Interest income:

                 

Student loans

   $ 2,254      $ —         $ 3,252      $ —        $ —        $ 5,506      $ (830   $ 4,676   

Other loans

     —          —           —          56        —          56        —          56   

Cash and investments

     13        20         26        (10     (20     29        (3     26   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     2,267        20         3,278        46        (20     5,591        (833  

 

4,758

  

Total interest expense

     721        —           2,238        66        (20     3,005        30        3,035   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss)

     1,546        20         1,040        (20     —          2,586        (863     1,723   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     1,399        —           119        46        —          1,564        (445     1,119   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss) after provisions for loan losses

     147        20         921        (66     —          1,022        (418     604   

Servicing revenue

     70        954         75        —          (659     440        —          440   

Contingency revenue

     —          294         —          —          —          294        —          294   

Gains on debt repurchases

     —          —           —          536        —          536        —          536   

Other income

     —          55         292        1        —          348        (285     63   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income

     70        1,303         367        537        (659     1,618        (285     1,333   

Expenses:

                 

Direct operating expenses

     265        440         754        6        (659     806        —          806   

Overhead expenses

     —          —           —          237        —          237        —          237   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

     265        440         754        243        (659     1,043        —          1,043   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

     —          —           —          —          —          —          76        76   

Restructuring expenses

     2        2         8        (2     —          10        —          10   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     267        442         762        241        (659     1, 053        76     

 

1,129

  

  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations, before income tax expense (benefit)

     (50     881         526        230        —          1,587        (779     808   

Income tax expense (benefit)(3)

     (18     311         186        81        —          560        (296     264   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

     (32     570         340        149        —          1,027        (483     544   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of taxes

     —          —           —          (220     —          (220     —          (220
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

   $ (32   $ 570       $ 340      $ (71   $ —        $ 807      $ (483   $ 324   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

The eliminations in servicing revenue and direct operating expense represent the elimination of intercompany servicing revenue where the Business Services segment performs the loan servicing function for the FFELP Loans segment.

 

(2) 

“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

  Net Impact  of
Derivative
Accounting
    Net Impact of
Goodwill and
Acquired
Intangibles
    Net Impact  of
Securitization
Accounting
    Total  

Net interest income (loss)

  $ 78      $ —        $ (941   $ (863

Less: provisions for loan losses

    —          —          (445     (445
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss) after provisions for loan losses

    78        —          (496     (418

Total other income (loss)

    (580     —          295        (285
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

    —          76        —          76   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

  $ (502   $ (76   $ (201     (779
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Income tax benefit

          (296
       

 

 

 

Net loss

        $ (483
       

 

 

 
(3)

Income taxes are based on a percentage of net income before tax for the individual reportable segment.

 

41


Table of Contents

Differences between “Core Earnings” and GAAP

The three adjustments required to reconcile from our “Core Earnings” results to our GAAP results of operations relate to differing treatments for: (1) our use of derivatives instruments to hedge our economic risks that do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment or do qualify for hedge accounting treatment but result in ineffectiveness (2) the accounting for goodwill and acquired intangible assets and (3) the off-balance sheet treatment of certain securitization transactions. The following table reflects aggregate adjustments associated with these areas.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  
“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:                   

Net impact of derivative accounting

   $ (540   $ 83      $ (502

Net impact of goodwill and acquired intangibles

     (24     (699     (76

Net impact of securitization accounting

     —          —          (201

Net income tax effect

     220        118        296   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

   $ (344   $ (498   $ (483
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

1) Derivative Accounting: “Core Earnings” exclude periodic unrealized gains and losses that are caused primarily by the mark-to-market valuations on derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment under GAAP. To a lesser extent, these periodic unrealized gains and losses are also a result of ineffectiveness recognized related to effective hedges. These unrealized gains and losses occur in our Consumer Lending, FFELP Loans and Other business segments. Under GAAP, for our derivatives that are held to maturity, the cumulative net unrealized gain or loss over the life of the contract will equal $0 except for Floor Income Contracts where the cumulative unrealized gain will equal the amount for which we sold the contract. In our “Core Earnings” presentation, we recognize the economic effect of these hedges, which generally results in any net settlement cash paid or received being recognized ratably as an interest expense or revenue over the hedged item’s life.

The accounting for derivatives requires that changes in the fair value of derivative instruments be recognized currently in earnings, with no fair value adjustment of the hedged item, unless specific hedge accounting criteria are met. We believe that our derivatives are effective economic hedges, and as such, are a critical element of our interest rate and foreign currency risk management strategy. However, some of our derivatives, primarily Floor Income Contracts and certain basis swaps, do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment and the stand-alone derivative must be marked-to-market in the income statement with no consideration for the corresponding change in fair value of the hedged item. These gains and losses recorded in “Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net” are primarily caused by interest rate and foreign currency exchange rate volatility and changing credit spreads during the period as well as the volume and term of derivatives not receiving hedge accounting treatment.

Our Floor Income Contracts are written options that must meet more stringent requirements than other hedging relationships to achieve hedge effectiveness. Specifically, our Floor Income Contracts do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment because the pay down of principal of the student loans underlying the Floor Income embedded in those student loans does not exactly match the change in the notional amount of our written Floor Income Contracts. Additionally, the term and the interest rate index of the Floor Income Contract is different than that of the student loans. Under derivatives accounting treatment, the upfront payment is deemed a liability and changes in fair value are recorded through income throughout the life of the contract. The change in the value of Floor Income Contracts is primarily caused by changing interest rates that cause the amount of Floor Income earned on the underlying student loans and paid to the counterparties to vary. This is economically offset by the change in value of the student loan portfolio earning Floor Income but that offsetting change in value is not recognized. We believe the Floor Income Contracts are economic hedges because they effectively fix the amount of Floor Income earned over the contract period, thus eliminating the timing and uncertainty that changes

 

42


Table of Contents

in interest rates can have on Floor Income for that period. Therefore, for purposes of “Core Earnings”, we have removed the unrealized gains and losses related to these contracts and added back the amortization of the net premiums received on the Floor Income Contracts. The amortization of the net premiums received on the Floor Income Contracts for “Core Earnings” is reflected in student loan interest income. Under GAAP accounting, the premium received on the Floor Income Contracts is recorded as revenue in the “gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities, net” line item by the end of the contracts’ life.

Basis swaps are used to convert floating rate debt from one floating interest rate index to another to better match the interest rate characteristics of the assets financed by that debt. We primarily use basis swaps to hedge our student loan assets that are primarily indexed to a commercial paper, Prime or Treasury bill index. In addition, we use basis swaps to convert debt indexed to the Consumer Price Index to three-month LIBOR debt. The accounting for derivatives requires that when using basis swaps, the change in the cash flows of the hedge effectively offset both the change in the cash flows of the asset and the change in the cash flows of the liability. Our basis swaps hedge variable interest rate risk; however, they generally do not meet this effectiveness test because the index of the swap does not exactly match the index of the hedged assets as required for hedge accounting treatment. Additionally, some of our FFELP Loans can earn at either a variable or a fixed interest rate depending on market interest rates and therefore swaps economically hedging these FFELP Loans do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting treatment. As a result, under GAAP, these swaps are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value reflected currently in the income statement.

The table below quantifies the adjustments for derivative accounting on our net income.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

“Core Earnings” derivative adjustments:

      

Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net, included in other income(1)

   $ (959   $ (361   $ (604

Plus: Realized losses on derivative and hedging activities, net(1)

     806        815        322   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net

     (153     454        (282

Amortization of net premiums on Floor Income Contracts in net interest income for “Core Earnings”

     (355     (317     (197

Other pre-change in derivatives accounting adjustments

     (32     (54     (23
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net impact derivative accounting(2)

   $ (540   $ 83      $ (502
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

See “Reclassification of Realized Gains (Losses) on Derivative and Hedging Activities” below for a detailed breakdown of the components of realized losses on derivative and hedging activities.

 

  (2) 

Negative amounts are subtracted from “Core Earnings” to arrive at GAAP net income and positive amounts are added to “Core Earnings” to arrive at GAAP net income.

 

43


Table of Contents

Reclassification of Realized Gains (Losses) on Derivative and Hedging Activities

Derivative accounting requires net settlement income/expense on derivatives and realized gains/losses related to derivative dispositions (collectively referred to as “realized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities”) that do not qualify as hedges to be recorded in a separate income statement line item below net interest income. Under our “Core Earnings” presentation, these gains and losses are reclassified to the income statement line item of the economically hedged item. For our “Core Earnings” net interest margin, this would primarily include: (a) reclassifying the net settlement amounts related to our Floor Income Contracts to student loan interest income and (b) reclassifying the net settlement amounts related to certain of our basis swaps to debt interest expense. The table below summarizes the realized losses on derivative and hedging activities and the associated reclassification on a “Core Earnings” basis.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

Reclassification of realized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities:

      

Net settlement expense on Floor Income Contracts reclassified to net interest income

   $ (902   $ (888   $ (717

Net settlement income (expense) on interest rate swaps reclassified to net interest income

     71        69        412   

Foreign exchange derivatives gains/(losses) reclassified to other income

     —          —          (15

Net realized gains (losses) on terminated derivative contracts reclassified to other income

     25        4        (2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total reclassifications of realized (gains) losses on derivative and hedging activities

     (806     (815     (322

Add: Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net(1)

     (153     454        (282
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net

   $ (959   $ (361   $ (604
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

“Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net” comprises the following unrealized mark-to-market gains (losses):

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

Floor Income Contracts

   $ (267   $ 156      $ 483   

Basis swaps

     104        341        (413

Foreign currency hedges

     (32     (83     (255

Other

     42        40        (97
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
Total unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and
hedging activities, net
   $(153)     $454     $(282)  
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

44


Table of Contents

Cumulative Impact of Derivative Accounting under GAAP compared to “Core Earnings”

As of December 31, 2011, derivative accounting has reduced GAAP equity by approximately $1.0 billion as a result of approximately $1.0 billion (after-tax) of cumulative net unrealized net losses recognized for GAAP, but not in “Core Earnings.” The following table rolls forward the cumulative impact to GAAP equity due to these unrealized net losses related to derivative accounting.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

Beginning impact of derivative accounting on GAAP equity

   $ (676   $ (737   $ (452

Net impact of net unrealized gains/(losses) under derivative accounting

     (301     61        (285
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending impact of derivative accounting on GAAP equity

   $ (977   $ (676   $ (737
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

In addition, net Floor premiums received on Floor Income Contracts that have not been amortized into “Core Earnings” as of the respective year-ends are presented in the table below. These net premiums will be recognized in “Core Earnings” in future periods and are presented below net of tax. As of December 31, 2011, the remaining amortization term of the net floor premiums was approximately 4.5 years.

 

(Dollars in millions)

   December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
    December 31,
2009
 

Unamortized net Floor premiums (net of tax)

   $ (772   $ (363   $ (421
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2) Goodwill and Acquired Intangibles: Our “Core Earnings” exclude goodwill and intangible impairment and the amortization of acquired intangibles. The following table summarizes the goodwill and acquired intangible adjustments.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

“Core Earnings” goodwill and acquired intangibles adjustments:

      

Goodwill and intangible impairment of acquired intangibles from continuing operations

   $ —        $ (660   $ (36

Goodwill and intangible impairment of acquired intangibles from discontinued operations, net of tax

     —          —          (1

Amortization of acquired intangibles from continuing operations

     (24     (39     (38

Amortization of acquired intangibles from discontinued operations, net of tax

     —          —          (1
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” goodwill and acquired intangibles adjustments(1)

   $ (24   $ (699   $ (76
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

Negative amounts are subtracted from “Core Earnings” to arrive at GAAP net income and positive amounts are added to “Core Earnings” to arrive at GAAP net income.

 

45


Table of Contents

3) Securitization Accounting: On January 1, 2010, we adopted the new consolidation accounting guidance which consolidated our off-balance sheet securitization trusts. As a result, from 2010 forward, there is no longer a difference between our GAAP and “Core Earnings” presentation for securitization accounting. (See “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies” for further detail). Prior to the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, certain securitization transactions in our FFELP Loans and Consumer Lending business segments were accounted for as sales of assets. Under “Core Earnings” for the FFELP Loans and Consumer Lending business segments, we present all securitization transactions as long-term non-recourse financings. The upfront “gains” on sale from securitization transactions, as well as ongoing “securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue (loss)” presented in accordance with GAAP, were excluded from “Core Earnings” and were replaced by interest income, provisions for loan losses, and interest expense as earned or incurred on the securitization loans. The additional net interest margin included in “Core Earnings” contained any related fees or costs such as Consolidation Loan Rebate Fees, premium and discount amortization as well as any Repayment Borrower Benefit yield adjustments. We also excluded transactions with our off-balance sheet trusts from “Core Earnings” as they were considered intercompany transactions on a “Core Earnings” basis. While we believe that our “Core Earnings” presentation presents the economic substance of results from our loan portfolios, when compared to GAAP results, it understates earnings volatility from securitization gains, securitization servicing income and Residual Interest income.

The following table summarizes “Core Earnings” securitization adjustments for the Consumer Lending and FFELP Loans business segments for the year ended December 31, 2009.

 

    

Year Ended

December 31,

 

(Dollars in millions)

   2009  

“Core Earnings” securitization adjustments:

  

Net interest income on securitized loans, before provisions for loan losses and before intercompany transactions

   $ (942

Provisions for loan losses

     445   
  

 

 

 

Net interest income on securitized loans, after provisions for loan losses, before intercompany transactions

     (497

Intercompany transactions with off-balance sheet trusts

     1   
  

 

 

 

Net interest income on securitized loans, after provisions for loan losses

     (496

Securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue

     295   
  

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” securitization adjustments(1)

   $ (201
  

 

 

 

 

(1)

Negative amounts are subtracted from “Core Earnings” to arrive at GAAP net income and positive amounts are added to “Core Earnings” to arrive at GAAP net income.

 

46


Table of Contents

Business Segment Earnings Summary — “Core Earnings” Basis

Consumer Lending Segment

The following table includes “Core Earnings” results for our Consumer Lending segment.

 

     Years Ended December 31,     % Increase (Decrease)  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010      2009     2011 vs. 2010     2010 vs. 2009  

“Core Earnings” interest income:

           

Private Education Loans

   $ 2,429      $ 2,353       $ 2,254        3     4

Cash and investments

     9        14         13        (36     8   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” interest income

     2,438        2,367         2,267        3        4   

Total “Core Earnings” interest expense

     804        758         721        6        5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net “Core Earnings” interest income

     1,634        1,609         1,546        2        4   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     1,179        1,298         1,399        (9     (7
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net “Core Earnings” interest income after provisions for loan losses

     455        311         147        46        112   

Servicing revenue

     64        72         70        (11     3   

Other income (loss)

     (9     —           —          (100     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income

     55        72         70        (24     3   

Direct operating expenses

     304        350         265        (13     32   

Restructuring expenses

     3        12         2        (75     500   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     307        362         267        (15     36   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit)

     203        21         (50     867        142   

Income tax expense (benefit)

     75        8         (18     838        144   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” (loss)

   $ 128      $ 13       $ (32     885     (141 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” were $128 million in 2011, compared with “Core Earnings” of $13 million in 2010. This increase was primarily the result of lower provision for loan losses and operating expenses.

Highlights compared to 2010 included:

 

   

Loan originations increased to $2.7 billion, up 19 percent from $2.3 billion.

 

   

The portfolio, net of loan loss allowance, totaled $36.3 billion at December 31, 2011, compared with $35.7 billion at December 31, 2010.

 

   

Net interest margin, before loan loss provision, improved to 4.1 percent, up from 3.9 percent.

 

   

Delinquencies of 90 days or more (as a percentage of loans in repayment) improved to 4.9 percent, compared with 5.3 percent.

 

   

The annual charge-off rate (as a percentage of loans in repayment) improved to 3.7 percent, compared with 5.0 percent.

 

47


Table of Contents

Consumer Lending Net Interest Margin

The following table shows the Consumer Lending “Core Earnings” net interest margin along with reconciliation to the GAAP-basis Consumer Lending net interest margin before provision for loan losses.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

“Core Earnings” basis Private Education student loan yield

     6.34     6.15     5.99

Discount amortization

     .23        .29        .26   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loan net yield

     6.57        6.44        6.25   

“Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loan cost of funds

     (1.99     (1.79     (1.78
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loan spread

     4.58        4.65        4.47   

“Core Earnings” basis other asset spread impact

     (.49     (.80     (.62
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” basis Consumer Lending net interest margin(1)

     4.09     3.85     3.85
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
                          

“Core Earnings” basis Consumer Lending net interest margin(1)

     4.09     3.85     3.85

Adjustment for GAAP accounting treatment

     (.08     .02        (.16
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

GAAP-basis Consumer Lending net interest margin(1)

     4.01     3.87     3.69
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

The average balances of our Consumer Lending “Core Earnings” basis interest-earning assets for the respective periods are:

(Dollars in millions)

                    

Private Education Loans

   $ 36,955       $ 36,534       $ 36,046   

Other interest-earning assets

     3,015         5,204         4,072   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total Consumer Lending “Core Earnings” basis interest-earning assets

   $ 39,970       $ 41,738       $ 40,118   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The increase in the “Core Earnings” basis Consumer Lending net interest margin for 2011 over the prior year was primarily due to the decline in the average balance of our other asset portfolio. The size of the other asset portfolio, which is primarily securitization trust restricted cash and cash held at the Bank, has decreased significantly. This other asset portfolio earns a negative yield and as a result, when its relative weighting decreases compared to the Private Education Loan portfolio, the overall net interest margin increases.

Private Education Loans Provision for Loan Losses and Charge-Offs

The following table summarizes the total Private Education Loans provisions for loan losses and charge-offs on both a GAAP-basis and a “Core Earnings” basis.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011(1)      2010      2009  

Private Education Loan provision for loan losses, GAAP

   $ 1,179       $ 1,298       $ 967   

Private Education Loan provision for loan losses, “Core Earnings” basis

   $ 1,179       $ 1,298       $ 1,399   

Private Education Loan charge-offs, GAAP

   $ 1,072       $ 1,291       $ 876   

Private Education Loan charge-offs, “Core Earnings” basis

   $ 1,072       $ 1,291       $ 1,299   

 

  (1) 

We recorded an additional $124 million of provision for Private Education Loan losses in the third quarter of 2011 in connection with adopting new accounting rules related to troubled debt restructurings (“TDRs”). For a complete discussion of the effect of these new rules on our provision for Private Education Loan losses, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates —Allowance for Loan Losses”.

 

48


Table of Contents

In establishing the allowance for Private Education Loan losses as of December 31, 2011, we considered several factors with respect to our Private Education Loan portfolio. In particular, we continue to see improving credit quality and continuing positive delinquency and charge-off trends in connection with this portfolio. Improving credit quality is seen in higher FICO scores and cosigner rates, as well as a more seasoned portfolio compared with the previous year. The delinquency rate has declined to 10.1 percent from 10.6 percent and the charge-off rate has declined to 3.7 percent from 5.0 percent compared with the previous year.

Apart from these overall improvements in credit quality, delinquency and charge-off trends, Private Education Loans which defaulted between 2008 and 2011 for which we have previously charged off estimated losses have, to varying degrees, not met our post-default recovery expectations to date and may continue not to do so. We have been charging off these periodic shortfalls in expected recoveries against our allowance for Private Education Loan losses and the related receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans and we will continue to do so. Differences in actual future recoveries on these defaulted loans could affect our receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans. In the third quarter of 2011, we increased our provision for Private Education Loan losses for the quarter in the amount of $143 million to reflect these uncertainties. Continuing historically high unemployment rates may negatively affect future Private Education Loan default and recovery expectations over our estimated two-year loss confirmation period. Consequently, we have also given consideration to these factors in projecting charge-offs for this period and establishing our allowance for Private Education Loan losses. We will continue to monitor defaults and recoveries in light of the continuing weak economy and high unemployment rates. For a more detailed discussion of our policy for determining the collectability of Private Education Loan and maintaining our allowance for Private Education Loan losses, see “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates—Allowance for Loan Losses.”

Servicing Revenue and Other Income — Consumer Lending Segment

Servicing revenue for our Consumer Lending segment primarily includes late fees and forbearance fees. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, servicing revenue for our Consumer Lending segment totaled $64 million, $72 million and $70 million, respectively. Included in other income for the year ended December 31, 2011 was a $9 million mark-to-market loss related to classifying our entire $12 million portfolio of non-U.S. dollar-denominated student loans as held-for-sale.

Operating Expenses — Consumer Lending Segment

Operating expenses for our Consumer Lending segment include costs incurred to originate Private Education Loans and to service and collect on our Private Education Loan portfolio. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, operating expenses for our Consumer Lending segment totaled $304 million, $350 million and $265 million, respectively.

2011 versus 2010

The decrease in operating expenses in the year ended December 31, 2011 compared with the year-ago period was primarily the result of our cost cutting initiatives. Operating expenses, excluding restructuring-related asset impairments, were 82 basis points and 96 basis points of average Private Education Loans in the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

2010 versus 2009

Operating expenses increased $85 million from 2009, primarily as the result of a non-recurring $11 million benefit in 2009 related to reversing a contingency reserve, an increase in collection and servicing costs from a higher number of loans in repayment and delinquency status and higher marketing and technology enhancement costs related to Private Education Loans in 2010. Operating expenses, excluding restructuring-related asset impairments, were 96 basis points and 74 basis points, respectively, of average “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loans in the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009.

 

49


Table of Contents

Business Services Segment

The following tables include “Core Earnings” results for our Business Services segment.

 

     Years Ended December 31,      % Increase (Decrease)  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010      2009      2011 vs. 2010     2010 vs. 2009  

Net interest income after provision

   $ 11      $ 17       $ 20         (35 )%      (15 )% 

Servicing revenue:

            

Intercompany loan servicing

     739        648         659         14        (2

Third-party loan servicing

     82        77         53         6        45   

Guarantor servicing

     52        93         152         (44     (39

Other servicing

     97        94         90         3        4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total servicing revenue

     970        912         954         6        (4

Contingency revenue

     333        330         294         1        12   

Other Business Services revenue

     70        51         55         37        (7
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income

     1,373        1,293         1,303         6        (1

Direct operating expenses

     482        500         440         (4     14   

Restructuring expenses

     3        7         2         (57     250   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     485        507         442         (4     15   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from continuing operations, before income tax expense

     899        803         881         12        (9

Income tax expense

     330        288         311         15        (7
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings”

     569        515         570         10        (10

Less: net loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

     (1     —           —           (100     —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” attributable to SLM Corporation

   $ 570      $ 515       $ 570         11     (10 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” were $570 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared to $515 million in the year-ago period. The improvement was primarily driven by the acquisition of existing FFELP Loans from other lenders, including $25 billion acquired in the fourth quarter of 2010.

Our Business Services segment earns intercompany loan servicing fees from servicing the FFELP Loans in our FFELP Loans segment. The average balance of this portfolio was $141 billion, $128 billion and $135 billion for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The increase in intercompany loan servicing revenue from the year-ago periods is primarily the result of the acquisition of an existing $25 billion FFELP Loan portfolio on December 31, 2010 partially offset by amortization of the underlying portfolio and FFELP Loans sold to ED as part of ED’s Purchase Program in 2010.

We are servicing approximately 3.6 million accounts under the ED Servicing Contract as of December 31, 2011. Third-party loan servicing fees in the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 included $63 million and $44 million, respectively, of servicing revenue related to the ED Servicing Contract. Our allocation of loans awarded for servicing under the ED contract increased from 22 percent to 26 percent for the contract year ending August 2012. The increase was driven primarily by our top ranking for default prevention performance results.

The decrease in Guarantor servicing revenue compared with the year-ago periods was primarily due to the elimination of FFELP in 2010, thereby eliminating any new Guarantor issuance fees we could earn. Outstanding FFELP Loans on which we earn additional fees also declined.

Other servicing revenue includes account asset servicing revenue and Campus Solutions revenue. Account asset servicing revenue represents fees earned on program management, transfer and servicing agent services and

 

50


Table of Contents

administration services for our various 529 college-savings plans. Assets under administration in our 529 college savings plans totaled $37.5 billion as of December 31, 2011, a 9 percent increase from 2010. Campus Solutions revenue is earned from our Campus Solutions business whose services include comprehensive transaction processing solutions and associated technology that we provide to college financial aid offices and students to streamline the financial aid process.

The following table presents the outstanding inventory of contingent collections receivables that our Business Services segment will collect on behalf of others. We expect the inventory of contingent collections receivables to decline over time as a result of the elimination of FFELP.

 

     December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010      2009  

Contingency:

        

Student loans

   $ 11,553       $ 10,362       $ 8,762   

Other

     2,017         1,730         1,262   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 13,570       $ 12,092       $ 10,024   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Other Business Services revenue is primarily transaction fees that are earned in conjunction with our rewards program from participating companies based on member purchase activity, either online or in stores, depending on the contractual arrangement with the participating company. Typically, a percentage of the purchase price of the consumer members’ eligible purchases with participating companies is set aside in an account maintained by us on behalf of our members. In fourth quarter 2011, we terminated our credit card affiliation program with a third-party bank and concurrently entered into an affiliation program with a new bank. In terminating the old program we recognized a $25 million gain which primarily represented prior cash advances we received that were previously recorded as deferred revenue.

Revenues related to services performed on FFELP Loans accounted for 76 percent, 78 percent and 79 percent of total segment revenues for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

In 2011, we launched Sallie Mae Insurance Services, which offers directly to college students and higher education institutions tuition, renters’ and student health insurance. We also include a Tuition Insurance Benefit with our Smart Option Student Loan.

On September 1, 2011, we acquired SC Services & Associates, Inc., a provider of collections services to local governments and courts. This acquisition enhances and complements our other contingency collection businesses.

Operating Expenses — Business Services Segment

For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, operating expenses for the Business Services segment totaled $482 million, $500 million and $440 million, respectively.

2011 versus 2010

Operating expenses for 2011 decreased from 2010, primarily as a result of our cost cutting initiatives. Included in operating expenses for the year ended December 31, 2011 is approximately $33 million in third-party servicing costs associated with our acquisition of $25 billion of existing FFELP Loans at the end of 2010. During third-quarter 2011, we began transitioning these loans to our own servicing platform and completed the transfer in October 2011. With the portfolio fully transitioned, the servicing costs associated with these loans will be significantly less in 2012.

 

51


Table of Contents

2010 versus 2009

Operating expenses increased $60 million from 2009 to 2010 primarily due to higher technology and other expenses related to preparation for higher volumes for the ED Servicing Contract as well as an increase in legal contingency expenses.

FFELP Loans Segment

The following table includes “Core Earnings” results for our FFELP Loans segment.

 

     Years Ended December 31,      % Increase (Decrease)  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010      2009      2011 vs. 2010     2010 vs. 2009  

“Core Earnings” interest income:

             

FFELP Loans

   $ 2,914       $ 2,766       $ 3,252         5     (15 )% 

Cash and investments

     5         9         26         (44     (65
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” interest income

     2,919         2,775         3,278         5        (15

Total “Core Earnings” interest expense

     1,472         1,407         2,238         5        (37
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net “Core Earnings” interest income

     1,447         1,368         1,040         6        32   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     86         98         119         (12     (18
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net “Core Earnings” interest income after provisions for loan losses

     1,361         1,270         921         7        38   

Servicing revenue

     85         68         75         25        (9

Other income

     1         320         292         (100     10   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income

     86         388         367         (78     6   

Direct operating expenses

     760         736         754         3        (2

Restructuring expenses

     1         54         8         (98     575   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     761         790         762         (4     4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from continuing operations, before income tax expense

     686         868         526         (21     65   

Income tax expense

     252         311         186         (19     67   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings”

   $ 434       $ 557       $ 340         (22 )%      64
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” from the FFELP Loans segment were $434 million in fiscal year 2011, compared with $557 million in the year-ago period. The prior year had a $321 million gain from the sale of loans. Key financial measures include:

 

   

Net interest margin of .98 percent in the year ended December 31, 2011 compared with .93 percent in the year-ago period.

 

   

The provision for loan losses of $86 million in the year ended December 31, 2011 decreased from $98 million in the year-ago period.

 

52


Table of Contents

FFELP Loans Net Interest Margin

The following table shows the FFELP Loans “Core Earnings” net interest margin along with reconciliation to the GAAP-basis FFELP Loans net interest margin.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

“Core Earnings” basis FFELP student loan yield

     2.59     2.57     2.68

Hedged Floor Income

     .25        .23        .14   

Unhedged Floor Income

     .12        .02        .22   

Consolidation Loan Rebate Fees

     (.65     (.59     (.59

Repayment Borrower Benefits

     (.12     (.10     (.11

Premium amortization

     (.15     (.18     (.17
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” basis FFELP student loan net yield

     2.04        1.95        2.17   

“Core Earnings” basis FFELP student loan cost of funds

     (.98     (.93     (1.44
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” basis FFELP student loan spread

     1.06        1.02        .73   

“Core Earnings” basis FFELP other asset spread impact

     (.08     (.09     (.06
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” basis FFELP Loans net interest margin(1)

     .98     .93     .67
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
                          

“Core Earnings” basis FFELP Loans net interest margin(1)

     .98     .93     .67

Adjustment for GAAP accounting treatment

     .34        .33        (.08
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

GAAP-basis FFELP Loans net interest margin

     1.32     1.26     .59
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

      
  (1)

The average balances of our FFELP “Core Earnings” basis interest-earning assets for the respective periods are:

 

(Dollars in millions)

                    

FFELP Loans

   $ 143,109       $ 142,043       $ 150,059   

Other interest-earning assets

     5,194         5,562         5,126   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total FFELP “Core Earnings” basis interest-earning assets

   $ 148,303       $ 147,605       $ 155,185   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The increase in the “Core Earnings” basis FFELP Loans net interest margin of 5 basis points for 2011 compared with 2010 was primarily the result of an increase in Floor Income due to lower interest rates.

The “Core Earnings” basis FFELP Loans net interest margin for 2010 increased by 26 basis points from 2009. This was primarily the result of a significant reduction in the cost of our ABCP Facility, a 24 basis point improvement in the CP/LIBOR Spread and a significantly higher margin on the loans within the ED’s Loan Participation Purchase Program (the “Participation Program”) facility compared with the prior year.

As of December 31, 2011, our FFELP Loan portfolio totaled approximately $138.1 billion, comprised of $50.4 billion of FFELP Stafford and $87.7 billion of FFELP Consolidation Loans. The weighted-average life of these portfolios is 5.0 years and 9.2 years, respectively, assuming a Constant Prepayment Rate (“CPR”) of 5 percent and 3 percent, respectively.

On December 23, 2011, the President signed the Consolidated Appropriations Act of 2012 into law. This law includes changes that permit FFELP lenders or beneficial holders to change the index on which the Special Allowance Payments (“SAP”) are calculated for FFELP Loans first disbursed on or after January 1, 2000. The law allows holders to elect to move the index from the Commercial Paper (“CP”) Rate to the one-month LIBOR rate. Such elections must be made by April 1, 2012. As of December 31, 2011, we had $130 billion of loans where we intend to elect the change. This change will help us to better match lender payments with our financing costs. We currently expect the new formula to be developed and available for use in the second quarter of 2012.

 

53


Table of Contents

During the fourth-quarter 2011, the Administration announced a Special Direct Consolidation Loan Initiative. The initiative provides an incentive to borrowers who have at least one student loan owned by the Department of Education and at least one held by a FFELP lender to consolidate the FFELP lender’s loans into the Direct Loan program by providing a 0.25 percentage point interest rate reduction on the FFELP loans that are eligible for consolidation. The program is available from January 17, 2012 through June 30, 2012. We currently do not foresee the initiative having a significant impact on our FFELP segment.

On December 31, 2010, we closed on our agreement to purchase an interest in $26.1 billion of securitized federal student loans and related assets from the Student Loan Corporation (“SLC”), a subsidiary of Citibank, N.A. The purchase price was approximately $1.1 billion and included the residual interest in 13 of SLC’s 14 FFELP loan securitizations and its interest in SLC Funding Note Issuer. We service these assets and administer the securitization trusts. Because we have determined that we are the primary beneficiary of these trusts we have consolidated these trusts onto our balance sheet.

Floor Income

The following table analyzes the ability of the FFELP Loans in our portfolio to earn Floor Income after December 31, 2011 and 2010, based on interest rates as of those dates.

 

     December 31, 2011     December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in billions)

   Fixed
Borrower
Rate
    Variable
Borrower
Rate
    Total     Fixed
Borrower
Rate
    Variable
Borrower
Rate
    Total  

Student loans eligible to earn Floor Income

   $ 118.3      $ 17.7      $ 136.0      $ 124.5      $ 21.0      $ 145.5   

Less: post-March 31, 2006 disbursed loans required to rebate Floor Income

     (62.7     (1.2     (63.9     (66.1     (1.3     (67.4

Less: economically hedged Floor Income Contracts

     (41.5     —          (41.5     (39.2     —          (39.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Student loans eligible to earn Floor Income

   $ 14.1      $ 16.5      $ 30.6      $ 19.2      $ 19.7      $ 38.9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Student loans earning Floor Income

   $ 14.1      $ 2.3      $ 16.4      $ 19.2      $ 1.3      $ 20.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

We have sold the above referenced Floor Income contracts to economically hedge the potential Floor Income from specifically identified pools of FFELP Consolidation Loans that are eligible to earn Floor Income.

The following table presents a projection of the average balance of FFELP Consolidation Loans for which Fixed Rate Floor Income has been economically hedged through the sale of Floor Income Contracts for the period January 1, 2012 to June 30, 2016. The Floor Income Contracts related to these loans do not qualify as effective hedges under GAAP accounting.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in billions)

   2012      2013      2014      2015      2016  

Average balance of FFELP Consolidation Loans whose Floor Income is economically hedged

   $ 38.3       $ 32.6       $ 28.3       $ 27.2       $ 10.4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

54


Table of Contents

FFELP Loans Provision for Loan Losses and Charge-Offs

The following table summarizes the total FFELP Loan provision for loan losses and charge-offs on both a GAAP-basis and a “Core Earnings” basis.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010      2009  

FFELP Loan provision for loan losses, GAAP

   $ 86       $ 98       $ 106   

FFELP Loan provision for loan losses, “Core Earnings” basis

   $ 86       $ 98       $ 119   

FFELP Loan charge-offs, GAAP

   $ 78       $ 87       $ 79   

FFELP Loan charge-offs, “Core Earnings” basis

   $ 78       $ 87       $ 94   

Servicing Revenue and Other Income — FFELP Loans Segment

The following table summarizes the components of “Core Earnings” other income for our FFELP Loans segment.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010     2009  

Servicing revenue

   $ 85       $ 68      $ 75   

Gains on loans and investments, net

     —           325        284   

Other

     1         (5     8   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income, net

   $ 86       $ 388      $ 367   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Servicing revenue for our FFELP Loans segment primarily consists of borrower late fees.

The gains on loans and investments in 2010 and 2009 related primarily to the sale of $20.4 billion and $18.5 billion loans, respectively, of FFELP Loans to ED as part of the ED Purchase Program.

Operating Expenses — FFELP Loans Segment

Operating expenses for our FFELP Loans segment primarily include the contractual rates we pay to service loans in term asset-backed securitization trusts or a similar rate if a loan is not in a term financing facility (which is presented as an intercompany charge from the Business Services segment who services the loans), the fees we pay for third-party loan servicing and costs incurred to acquire loans. The intercompany revenue charged from the Business Services segment and included in those amounts was $739 million, $648 million and $659 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. These amounts exceed the actual cost of servicing the loans.

2011 versus 2010

The increase in operating expenses from the prior year was primarily the result of the increase in servicing costs related to the $25 billion loan portfolio acquisition on December 31, 2010. Operating expenses, excluding restructuring-related asset impairments, were 53 basis points and 51 basis points of average FFELP Loans in the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

2010 versus 2009

Operating expenses decreased $18 million from the prior year, primarily due to the effect of our cost cutting initiative in connection with the passage of HCERA. This was partially offset by a one-time fee paid to acquire

 

55


Table of Contents

the SLC portfolio, an increase in legal contingency expenses and costs related to closing and selling two loan originations centers in 2010. Operating expenses, excluding restructuring-related asset impairments, were 51 basis points and 50 basis points of average “Core Earnings” basis FFELP Loans in the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

Other Segment

The Other segment primarily consists of the financial results related to the repurchase of debt, the corporate liquidity portfolio and all overhead. We also include results from smaller wind-down and discontinued operations within this segment. These are the Purchased Paper businesses and mortgage and other loan businesses. The Other segment includes our remaining businesses that do not pertain directly to the primary segments identified above. Overhead expenses include costs related to executive management, the board of directors, accounting, finance, legal, human resources, stock-based compensation expense and certain information technology costs related to infrastructure and operations.

The following table includes “Core Earnings” results for our Other segment.

 

     Years Ended
December 31,
    % Increase (Decrease)  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009     2011 vs. 2010     2010 vs. 2009  

Net interest loss after provision

   $ (58   $ (35   $ (66     66     (47 )% 

Gains on debt repurchases

     64        317        536        (80     (41

Other

     (8     14        1        (157     1,300   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total income

     56        331        537        (83     (38

Direct operating expenses

     13        12        6        8        100   

Overhead expenses:

          

Corporate overhead

     163        128        138        27        (7

Unallocated information technology costs

     117        130        99        (10     31   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total overhead expenses

     280        258        237        9        9   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     293        270        243        9        11   

Restructuring expenses

     2        12        (2     (83     700   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     295        282        241        5        17   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations, before income tax expense (benefit)

     (297     14        230        (2,221     (94

Income tax expense (benefit)

     (109     4        81        (2,825     (95
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

     (188     10        149        (1,980     (93

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax

     33        (67     (220     149        (70
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

“Core Earnings” net loss

   $ (155   $ (57   $ (71     172     (20 )% 
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Purchased Paper Business

Our Purchased Paper businesses are presented as discontinued operations for the current and prior periods (see “Consolidated Earnings Summary — GAAP-basis” for a further discussion). We sold our Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business, resulting in a $23 million after-tax gain, in the third quarter of 2011.

Gains on Debt Repurchases

We began repurchasing our outstanding debt in the second quarter of 2008. We repurchased $894 million, $4.9 billion and $3.4 billion face amount of our senior unsecured notes in 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Since the second quarter of 2008, we repurchased $11.1 billion face amount of our senior unsecured notes in the aggregate, with maturity dates ranging from 2008 to 2016.

 

56


Table of Contents

Other Income

2011 had $26 million of impairment recorded related to our investments in leveraged leases. The impairment was primarily related to American Airlines filing for bankruptcy in the fourth quarter of 2011. As a result of their bankruptcy filing we fully impaired our related leveraged lease investments. We also have $13 million in operating leases at December 31, 2011 with American Airlines which we have determined are not impaired. As of December 31, 2011, our total remaining investment in airline leases is $40 million.

Overhead

Corporate overhead is comprised of costs related to executive management, the board of directors, accounting, finance, legal, human resources and stock-based compensation expense. Unallocated information technology costs are related to infrastructure and operations.

2011 versus 2010

The increase in overhead from 2010 to 2011 was primarily the result of a change in the terms of our stock-based compensation plans, additional expense related to the termination of our defined benefit pension plan, and restructuring-related consulting expenses incurred in the first half of 2011. In the first quarter of 2011, we changed our stock-based compensation plans so that retirement eligible employees would not forfeit unvested stock-based compensation upon their retirement. This change had the effect of accelerating the future stock-based compensation expenses associated with these unvested stock grants into the current period for those retirement-eligible employees. We also recognized $16 million of additional expense in 2011 related to the termination of our defined benefit pension plan due to changes in estimates related to the employee termination benefits as well as changes in interest rates.

2010 versus 2009

Operating expenses increased $27 million from 2009 to 2010. This increase in corporate overhead was primarily attributable to increased technology costs associated with disaster recovery modernization, enterprise architecture and information security upgrades.

Financial Condition

This section provides additional information regarding the changes related to our loan portfolio assets and related liabilities as well as credit performance indicators related to our loan portfolio. Many of these disclosures will show both GAAP-basis as well as “Core Earnings” basis disclosures. Because certain trusts were not consolidated prior to the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, these trusts were treated as off-balance sheet for GAAP purposes but we considered them on-balance sheet for “Core Earnings” purposes. Subsequent to the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, this difference no longer exists because all of our trusts are treated as on-balance sheet for GAAP purposes. Below and elsewhere in the document, “Core Earnings” basis disclosures include all historically (pre-January 1, 2010) off-balance sheet trusts as though they were on-balance sheet. We believe that providing “Core Earnings” basis disclosures is meaningful because when we evaluate the performance and risk characteristics of the Company we have always considered the effect of any off-balance sheet trusts as though they were on-balance sheet.

 

57


Table of Contents

Average Balance Sheets — GAAP

The following table reflects the rates earned on interest-earning assets and paid on interest-bearing liabilities and reflects our net interest margin on a consolidated basis.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance      Rate     Balance      Rate     Balance      Rate  

Average Assets

               

FFELP Loans

   $ 143,109         2.42   $ 142,043         2.36   $ 128,538         2.41

Private Education Loans

     36,955         6.57        36,534         6.44        23,154         6.83   

Other loans

     233         9.16        323         9.20        561         9.98   

Cash and investments

     10,636         .18        12,729         .20        11,046         .24   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-earning assets

     190,933         3.11     191,629         3.00     163,299         2.91
     

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Non-interest-earning assets

     5,308           5,931           8,693      
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total assets

   $ 196,241         $ 197,560         $ 171,992      
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Average Liabilities and Equity

               

Short-term borrowings

   $ 31,413         .89   $ 38,634         .86   $ 44,485         1.84

Long-term borrowings

     156,151         1.36        150,768         1.29        118,699         1.87   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     187,564         1.28     189,402         1.20     163,184         1.86
     

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Non-interest-bearing liabilities

     3,679           3,280           3,719      

Equity

     4,998           4,878           5,089      
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total liabilities and equity

   $ 196,241         $ 197,560         $ 171,992      
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Net interest margin

        1.85        1.82        1.05
     

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Rate/Volume Analysis — GAAP

The following rate/volume analysis shows the relative contribution of changes in interest rates and asset volumes.

 

     Increase
(Decrease)
    Change Due To(1)  

(Dollars in millions)

     Rate     Volume  

2011 vs. 2010

      

Interest income

   $ 176      $ 197      $ (21

Interest expense

     126        149        (23
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

   $ 50      $ 63      $ (13
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

2010 vs. 2009

      

Interest income

   $ 996      $ 149      $ 847   

Interest expense

     (760     (1,194     434   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

   $ 1,756      $ 1,416      $ 340   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

Changes in income and expense due to both rate and volume have been allocated in proportion to the relationship of the absolute dollar amounts of the change in each. The changes in income and expense are calculated independently for each line in the table. The totals for the rate and volume columns are not the sum of the individual lines.

 

58


Table of Contents

Summary of our Student Loan Portfolio

Ending Student Loan Balances, net

 

     December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
Loans
    Private
Education
Loans
    Total  

Total student loan portfolio:

          

In-school(1)

   $ 3,100      $ —        $ 3,100      $ 2,263      $ 5,363   

Grace, repayment and other(2)

     46,618        86,925        133,543        35,830        169,373   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total, gross

     49,718        86,925        136,643        38,093        174,736   

Unamortized premium/(discount)

     839        835        1,674        (873     801   

Receivable for partially charged-off loans

     —          —          —          1,241        1,241   

Allowance for losses

     (117     (70     (187     (2,171     (2,358
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total student loan portfolio

   $ 50,440      $ 87,690      $ 138,130      $ 36,290      $ 174,420   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

% of total FFELP

     37     63     100    

% of total

     29     50     79     21     100

 

     December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Private
Education
Loans
    Total  

Total student loan portfolio:

          

In-school(1)

   $ 6,333      $ —        $ 6,333      $ 3,752      $ 10,085   

Grace, repayment and other(2)

     49,068        91,537        140,605        33,780        174,385   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total, gross

     55,401        91,537        146,938        37,532        184,470   

Unamortized premium/(discount)

     971        929        1,900        (894     1,006   

Receivable for partially charged-off loans

     —          —          —          1,040        1,040   

Allowance for losses

     (120     (69     (189     (2,022     (2,211
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total student loan portfolio

   $ 56,252      $ 92,397      $ 148,649      $ 35,656      $ 184,305   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

% of FFELP

     38     62     100    

% of total

     31     50     81     19     100

 

(1) 

Loans for borrowers still attending school and are not yet required to make payments on the loan.

 

(2) 

Includes loans in deferment or forbearance.

 

59


Table of Contents

Average Student Loan Balances (net of unamortized premium/discount)

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Private
Education
Loans
    Total  

Total(1)

   $ 53,163      $ 89,946      $ 143,109      $ 36,955      $ 180,064   

% of FFELP

     37     63     100    

% of total

     29     50     79     21     100

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Private
Education
Loans
    Total  

Total(1)

   $ 61,034      $ 81,009      $ 142,043      $ 36,534      $ 178,577   

% of FFELP

     43     57     100    

% of total

     34     46     80     20     100
     Year Ended December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Private
Education
Loans
    Total  

GAAP-basis

   $ 58,492      $ 70,046      $ 128,538      $ 23,154      $ 151,692   

Off-balance sheet

     6,365        15,156        21,521        12,892        34,413   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” basis

   $ 64,857      $ 85,202      $ 150,059      $ 36,046      $ 186,105   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

% of GAAP-basis FFELP

     46     54     100    

% of “Core Earnings” basis FFELP

     43     57     100    

% of total

     35     46     81     19     100

 

(1) 

Upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, we consolidated all of our off-balance sheet securitization trusts.

 

60


Table of Contents

Student Loan Activity

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Total  Private
Education
Loans
    Total
Portfolio
 

Beginning balance

   $ 56,252      $ 92,397      $ 148,649      $ 35,656      $ 184,305   

Acquisitions and originations

     814        802        1,616        2,942        4,558   

Capitalized interest and premium/discount amortization

     1,506        1,535        3,041        1,269        4,310   

Consolidations to third parties

     (2,741     (1,058     (3,799     (69     (3,868

Sales

     (754     —          (754     —          (754

Repayments/defaults/other

     (4,637     (5,986     (10,623     (3,508     (14,131
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 50,440      $ 87,690      $ 138,130      $ 36,290      $ 174,420   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Total  Private
Education
Loans
    Total
Portfolio
 

Beginning balance — GAAP-basis

   $ 52,675      $ 68,379      $ 121,054      $ 22,753      $ 143,807   

Consolidation of off-balance sheet loans(1)

     5,500        14,797        20,297        12,341        32,638   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Beginning balance — total portfolio

     58,175        83,176        141,351        35,094        176,445   

Acquisitions and originations

     14,349        76        14,425        2,434        16,859   

Capitalized interest and premium/discount amortization

     1,324        1,357        2,681        1,462        4,143   

Consolidations to third parties

     (2,092     (793     (2,885     (46     (2,931

Loan acquisition on December 31, 2010

     11,237        13,652        24,889        —          24,889   

Sales

     (21,054     (71     (21,125     —          (21,125

Repayments/defaults/other

     (5,687     (5,000     (10,687     (3,288     (13,975
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 56,252      $ 92,397      $ 148,649      $ 35,656      $ 184,305   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

On January 1, 2010, upon adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance, all off-balance sheet loans are included in the GAAP-basis.

 

61


Table of Contents

 

     GAAP-Basis
Year Ended December 31, 2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Total  Private
Education
Loans
    Total On-
Balance Sheet
Portfolio
 

Beginning balance

   $ 52,476      $ 71,744      $ 124,220      $ 20,582      $ 144,802   

Consolidations to third parties

     (1,113     (518     (1,631     (8     (1,639

Acquisitions and originations(1)

     25,677        1,150        26,827        4,343        31,170   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net acquisitions and originations

     24,564        632        25,196        4,335        29,531   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securitization-related(2)

     645        —          645        —          645   

Sales

     (19,300     —          (19,300     —          (19,300

Repayments/defaults/resales/other

     (5,710     (3,997     (9,707     (2,164     (11,871
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 52,675      $ 68,379      $ 121,054      $ 22,753      $ 143,807   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     Off-Balance Sheet
Year Ended December 31, 2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Total  Private
Education
Loans
    Total Off-
Balance Sheet
Portfolio
 

Beginning balance

   $ 7,143      $ 15,531      $ 22,674      $ 12,917      $ 35,591   

Consolidations to third parties

     (413     (138     (551     (18     (569

Acquisitions and originations(1)

     135        208        343        498        841   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net acquisitions and originations

     (278     70        (208     480        272   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securitization-related(2)

     (645     —          (645     —          (645

Repayments/defaults/resales/other

     (720     (804     (1,524     (1,056     (2,580
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 5,500      $ 14,797      $ 20,297      $ 12,341      $ 32,638   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
     “Core Earnings” Basis Portfolio
Year Ended December 31, 2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
Other
    FFELP
Consolidation
Loans
    Total
FFELP
    Total  Private
Education
Loans
    Total “Core
Earnings” Basis
Portfolio
 

Beginning balance

   $ 59,619      $ 87,275      $ 146,894      $ 33,499      $ 180,393   

Consolidations to third parties

     (1,526     (656     (2,182     (26     (2,208

Acquisitions and originations(1)

     25,812        1,358        27,170        4,841        32,011   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net acquisitions and originations

     24,286        702        24,988        4,815        29,803   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Securitization-related(2)

     —          —          —          —          —     

Sales

     (19,300     —          (19,300     —          (19,300

Repayments/defaults/resales/other

     (6,430     (4,801     (11,231     (3,220     (14,451
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending balance

   $ 58,175      $ 83,176      $ 141,351      $ 35,094      $ 176,445   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Includes accrued interest receivable capitalized to principal during the period.

 

(2) 

Represents loans within securitization trusts that we are required to consolidate under GAAP once the trusts’ loan balances are below the clean-up call threshold.

 

62


Table of Contents

Private Education Loan Originations

Total Private Education Loan originations increased 19 percent from 2010 to $2.7 billion in the year ended December 31, 2011.

The following table summarizes our Private Education Loan originations.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010      2009  

Total Private Education Loan originations

   $ 2,737       $ 2,307       $ 3,176   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Consumer Lending Portfolio Performance

Private Education Loan Delinquencies and Forbearance

The tables below present our Private Education Loan delinquency trends.

 

     GAAP-Basis
Private Education Loan Delinquencies
 
     December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
    December 31,
2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance     %     Balance     %     Balance     %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 6,522        $ 8,340        $ 8,910     

Loans in forbearance(2)

     1,386          1,340          967     

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

            

Loans current

     27,122        89.9     24,888        89.4     12,421        86.4

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     1,076        3.6        1,011        3.6        647        4.5   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     520        1.6        471        1.7        340        2.4   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     1,467        4.9        1,482        5.3        971        6.7   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Private Education Loans in repayment

     30,185        100     27,852        100     14,379        100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Private Education Loans, gross

     38,093          37,532          24,256     

Private Education Loan unamortized discount

     (873       (894       (559  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total Private Education Loans

     37,220          36,638          23,697     

Private Education Loan receivable for partially charged-off loans

     1,241          1,040          499     

Private Education Loan allowance for losses

     (2,171       (2,022       (1,443  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Private Education Loans, net

   $ 36,290        $ 35,656        $ 22,753     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

       79.2       74.2       59.3
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

       10.1       10.6       13.6
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

       4.4       4.6       6.3
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loans in repayment greater than 12 months as a percentage of loans in repayment(4)

       72.4       64.3       55.4
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Deferment includes borrowers who have returned to school or are engaged in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation.

 

(2) 

Loans for borrowers who have requested extension of grace period generally during employment transition or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors, consistent with established loan program servicing policies and procedures.

 

(3) 

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

 

(4) 

Based on number of months in an active repayment status for which a scheduled monthly payment was due.

 

63


Table of Contents

 

     Off-Balance Sheet
Private  Education  Loan
Delinquencies(5)
 
     December 31,
2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance        %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 2,546        

Loans in forbearance(2)

     453        

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

       

Loans current

     8,987           90.0

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     332           3.3   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     151           1.5   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     517           5.2   
  

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total Private Education Loans in repayment

     9,987           100
  

 

 

      

 

 

 

Total Private Education Loans, gross

     12,986        

Private Education Loan unamortized discount

     (349     
  

 

 

      

Total Private Education Loans

     12,637        

Private Education Loan receivable for partially charged-off loans

     229        

Private Education Loan allowance for losses

     (524     
  

 

 

      

Private Education Loans, net

   $ 12,342        
  

 

 

      

Percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

          76.9
       

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

          10.0
       

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

          4.3
       

 

 

 

Loans in repayment greater than 12 months as a percentage of loans in repayment(4)

          56.3
       

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

Deferment includes borrowers who have returned to school or are engaged in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation.

 

 

  (2) 

Loans for borrowers who have requested extension of grace period generally during employment transition or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors, consistent with established loan program servicing policies and procedures.

 

 

  (3) 

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

 

 

  (4) 

Based on number of months in an active repayment status for which a scheduled monthly payment was due.

 

 

  (5) 

On January 1, 2010, upon adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance, all off-balance sheet loans are included in GAAP-basis.

 

 

64


Table of Contents

 

     “Core Earnings” Basis
Private Education Loan Delinquencies
 
     December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
    December 31,
2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance     %     Balance     %     Balance     %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 6,522        $ 8,340        $ 11,456     

Loans in forbearance(2)

     1,386          1,340          1,420     

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

            

Loans current

     27,122        89.9     24,888        89.4     21,408        87.9

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     1,076        3.6        1,011        3.6        979        4.0   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     520        1.6        471        1.7        491        2.0   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     1,467        4.9        1,482        5.3        1,488        6.1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Private Education Loans in repayment

     30,185        100     27,852        100     24,366        100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Private Education Loans, gross

     38,093          37,532          37,242     

Private Education Loan unamortized discount

     (873       (894       (908  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total Private Education Loans

     37,220          36,638          36,334     

Private Education Loan receivable for partially charged-off loans

     1,241          1,040          728     

Private Education Loan allowance for losses

     (2,171       (2,022       (1,967  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Private Education Loans, net

   $ 36,290        $ 35,656        $ 35,095     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

       79.2       74.2       65.4
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

       10.1       10.6       12.1
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

       4.4       4.6       5.5
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loans in repayment greater than 12 months as a percentage of loans in repayment(4)

       72.4       64.3       55.8
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Deferment includes borrowers who have returned to school or are engaged in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation.

 

(2) 

Loans for borrowers who have requested extension of grace period generally during employment transition or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors, consistent with established loan program servicing policies and procedures.

 

(3) 

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

 

(4) 

Based on number of months in an active repayment status for which a scheduled monthly payment was due.

 

65


Table of Contents

Allowance for Private Education Loan Losses

The following table summarizes changes in the allowance for Private Education Loan losses.

 

     Activity in Allowance for Private Education Loans  
     GAAP-Basis
Years Ended December 31,
    Off-Balance Sheet
Years Ended December 31,
    “Core Earnings” Basis
Years Ended December 31,
 

(Dollars in millions)

   2011(1)     2010     2009     2011     2010(2)     2009     2011(1)     2010     2009  

Allowance at beginning of period

   $ 2,022      $ 1,443      $ 1,308      $ —        $ 524      $ 505      $ 2,022      $ 1,967      $ 1,813   

Provision for Private Education Loan losses(1)

     1,179        1,298        967        —          —          432        1,179        1,298        1,399   

Charge-offs

     (1,072     (1,291     (876     —          —          (423     (1,072     (1,291     (1,299

Reclassification of interest reserve(3)

     42        48        44        —          —          10        42        48        54   

Consolidation of securitization trusts(2)

     —          524        —          —          (524     —          —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Allowance at end of period

   $ 2,171      $ 2,022      $ 1,443      $ —        $ —        $ 524      $ 2,171      $ 2,022      $ 1,967   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment

     3.7     5.0     7.2     —       —       4.4     3.7     5.0     6.0

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment and forbearance

     3.6     4.8     6.7     —       —       4.2     3.6     4.8     5.6

Allowance as a percentage of the ending total loan balance(4)

     5.5     5.2     5.8     —       —       4.0     5.5     5.2     5.2

Allowance as a percentage of ending loans in repayment

     7.2     7.3     10.0     —       —       5.2     7.2     7.3     8.1

Allowance coverage of charge-offs

     2.0        1.6        1.6        —          —          1.2        2.0        1.6        1.5   

Ending total loans(4)

   $ 39,334      $ 38,572      $ 24,755      $ —        $ —        $ 13,215      $ 39,334      $ 38,572      $ 37,970   

Average loans in repayment

   $ 28,790      $ 25,596      $ 12,137      $ —        $ —        $ 9,597      $ 28,790      $ 25,596      $ 21,734   

Ending loans in repayment

   $ 30,185      $ 27,852      $ 14,379      $ —        $ —        $ 9,987      $ 30,185      $ 27,852      $ 24,366   

 

(1) 

See “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates – Allowance for Loan Losses” for a discussion regarding the impact of adopting new accounting guidance related to TDRs in the third quarter of 2011, which increased provisions for loan losses by $124 million in the third quarter of 2011.

 

(2) 

On January 1, 2010, upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance, all off-balance sheet loans are included in the GAAP-basis.

 

(3) 

Represents the additional allowance related to the amount of uncollectible interest reserved within interest income that is transferred in the period to the allowance for loan losses when interest is capitalized to a loan’s principal balance.

 

(4) 

Ending total loans represents gross Private Education Loans, plus the receivable for partially charged-off loans.

 

66


Table of Contents

The following table provides the detail for our traditional and non-traditional “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loans.

 

    Years Ended  
    December 31, 2011     December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

  Traditional     Non-
Traditional
    Total     Traditional     Non-
Traditional
    Total     Traditional     Non-
Traditional
    Total  

Ending total loans(1)

  $ 35,233      $ 4,101      $ 39,334      $ 34,177      $ 4,395      $ 38,572      $ 33,223      $ 4,747      $ 37,970   

Ending loans in repayment

    27,467        2,718        30,185        25,043        2,809        27,852        21,453        2,913        24,366   

Private Education Loan allowance for losses

    1,542        629        2,171        1,231        791        2,022        1,056        911        1,967   

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment

    2.8     12.3     3.7     3.6     16.8     5.0     3.6     21.4     6.0

Allowance as a percentage of ending total loan balance(1)

    4.4     15.3     5.5     3.6     18.0     5.2     3.2     19.2     5.2

Allowance as a percentage of ending loans in repayment

    5.6     23.1     7.2     4.9     28.2     7.3     4.9     31.3     8.1

Allowance coverage of charge-offs

    2.1        1.9        2.0        1.5        1.7        1.6        1.6        1.5        1.5   

Delinquencies as a percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

    8.6     26.0     10.1     8.8     27.4     10.6     9.5     31.4     12.1

Delinquencies greater than 90 days as a percentage of Private Education Loans in repayment

    4.0     13.6     4.9     4.2     15.0     5.3     4.6     17.5     6.1

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

    4.2     6.6     4.4     4.4     6.1     4.6     5.3     7.1     5.5

Loans that entered repayment during the period(2)

  $ 1,514      $ 110      $ 1,624      $ 2,510      $ 187      $ 2,697      $ 2,966      $ 261      $ 3,227   

Percentage of Private Education Loans with a cosigner

    65     29     62     63     28     59     61     28     57

Average FICO at origination

    726        624        717        725        623        715        725        623        713   

 

(1) 

Ending total loans represents gross Private Education Loans, plus the receivable for partially charged-off loans.

 

(2) 

Includes loans that are required to make a payment for the first time.

As part of concluding on the adequacy of the allowance for loan loss, we review key allowance and loan metrics. The most significant of these metrics considered are the allowance coverage of charge-offs ratio; the allowance as a percentage of total loans and of loans in repayment; and delinquency and forbearance percentages.

 

67


Table of Contents

Receivable for Partially Charged-Off Private Education Loans

At the end of each month, for loans that are 212 days past due, we charge off the estimated loss of a defaulted loan balance. Actual recoveries are applied against the remaining loan balance that was not charged off. We refer to this remaining loan balance as the “receivable for partially charged-off loans.” If actual periodic recoveries are less than expected, the difference is immediately charged off through the allowance for loan losses with an offsetting reduction in the receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans. If actual periodic recoveries are greater than expected, they will be reflected as a recovery through the allowance for Private Education Loan losses once the cumulative recovery amount exceeds the cumulative amount originally expected to be recovered. There was $143 million in provision for Private Education Loan losses recorded in 2011 to reflect possible additional future charge-offs related to the receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans (see “Consumer Lending Segment — Private Education Loans Provision for Loan Losses and Charge-Offs” for a further discussion).

The following table summarizes the activity in the receivable for partially charged-off loans.

 

     Activity in Receivable for Partially Charged-Off Loans  
     GAAP-Basis     Off-Balance Sheet     “Core Earnings” Basis  
     Years Ended
December 31,
    Years Ended
December 31,
    Years Ended
December 31,
 

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009     2011      2010(4)     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Receivable at beginning of period

   $ 1,040      $ 499      $ 222      $ —         $ 229      $ 92      $ 1,040      $ 728      $ 314   

Expected future recoveries of current period defaults(1)

     391        459        324        —           —          156        391        459        480   

Recoveries(2)

     (155     (104     (43     —           —          (17     (155     (104     (60

Charge-offs(3)

     (35     (43     (4     —           —          (2     (35     (43     (6

Consolidation of securitization trusts(4)

     —          229        —          —           (229     —          —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Receivable at end of period

   $ 1,241      $ 1,040      $ 499      $ —         $ —        $ 229      $ 1,241      $ 1,040      $ 728   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Remaining loan balance expected to be collected from contractual loan balances partially charged-off during the period. This is the difference between the defaulted loan balance and the amount of the defaulted loan balance that was charged off.

 

(2) 

Current period cash collections.

 

(3) 

Represents the current period recovery shortfall – the difference between what was expected to be collected and what was actually collected.

 

(4) 

Upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, we consolidated all of our off-balance sheet securitization trusts.

Use of Forbearance as a Private Education Loan Collection Tool

Forbearance involves granting the borrower a temporary cessation of payments (or temporary acceptance of smaller than scheduled payments) for a specified period of time. Using forbearance extends the original term of the loan. Forbearance does not grant any reduction in the total repayment obligation (principal or interest). While in forbearance status, interest continues to accrue and is capitalized to principal when the loan re-enters repayment status. Our forbearance policies include limits on the number of forbearance months granted consecutively and the total number of forbearance months granted over the life of the loan. In some instances, we require good-faith payments before granting forbearance. Exceptions to forbearance policies are permitted when such exceptions are judged to increase the likelihood of collection of the loan. Forbearance as a collection tool is used most effectively when applied based on a borrower’s unique situation, including historical information and judgments. We leverage updated borrower information and other decision support tools to best determine who will be granted forbearance based on our expectations as to a borrower’s ability and willingness to repay their obligation. This strategy is aimed at mitigating the overall risk of the portfolio as well as encouraging cash resolution of delinquent loans.

Forbearance may be granted to borrowers who are exiting their grace period to provide additional time to obtain employment and income to support their obligations, or to current borrowers who are faced with a

 

68


Table of Contents

hardship and request forbearance time to provide temporary payment relief. In these circumstances, a borrower’s loan is placed into a forbearance status in limited monthly increments and is reflected in the forbearance status at month-end during this time. At the end of their granted forbearance period, the borrower will enter repayment status as current and is expected to begin making their scheduled monthly payments on a go-forward basis.

Forbearance may also be granted to borrowers who are delinquent in their payments. In these circumstances, the forbearance cures the delinquency and the borrower is returned to a current repayment status. In more limited instances, delinquent borrowers will also be granted additional forbearance time.

The table below reflects the historical effectiveness of using forbearance. Our experience has shown that three years after being granted forbearance for the first time, 66 percent of the loans are current, paid in full, or receiving an in-school grace or deferment, and 20 percent have defaulted. The default experience associated with loans which utilize forbearance is considered in our allowance for loan losses. The monthly average number of loans granted forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance remained steady at 5.3 percent in the fourth quarter of 2011 compared to the year-ago quarter. As of December 31, 2011, 2.6 percent of loans in current status were delinquent as of the end of the prior month, but were granted a forbearance that made them current as of December 31, 2011 (borrowers made payments on approximately 22 percent of these loans immediately prior to being granted forbearance).

 

Tracking by First Time in Forbearance Compared to All Loans Entering Repayment  
     Status distribution
36 months after
being granted
forbearance
for the first time
    Status distribution
36 months after
entering repayment
(all loans)
    Status distribution
36 months after
entering repayment for
loans never entering
forbearance
 

In-school/grace/deferment

     9.7     9.0     5.2

Current

     49.5        58.0        65.8   

Delinquent 31-60 days

     3.1        2.0        0.4   

Delinquent 61-90 days

     1.9        1.1        0.2   

Delinquent greater than 90 days

     4.8        2.7        0.3   

Forbearance

     4.3        3.3          

Defaulted

     19.7        10.8        6.0   

Paid

     7.0        13.1        22.1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

     100     100     100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The tables below show the composition and status of the “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loan portfolio aged by number of months in active repayment status (months for which a scheduled monthly payment was due). As indicated in the tables, the percentage of loans in forbearance status decreases the longer the loans have been in active repayment status. At December 31, 2011, loans in forbearance status as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance were 6.9 percent for loans that have been in active repayment status for less than 25 months. The percentage drops to 1.3 percent for loans that have been in active repayment status for more than 48 months. Approximately 80 percent of our “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loans in forbearance status has been in active repayment status less than 25 months.

 

69


Table of Contents

 

(Dollars in millions)

   Monthly Scheduled Payments Due     Not Yet in
Repayment
       

December 31, 2011

   0 to 12     13 to 24     25 to 36     37 to 48     More than 48       Total  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment

   $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ 6,522      $ 6,522   

Loans in forbearance

     920        194        126        66        80        —          1,386   

Loans in repayment — current

     6,866        6,014        5,110        3,486        5,646        —          27,122   

Loans in repayment — delinquent 31-60 days

     506        212        158        83        117        —          1,076   

Loans in repayment — delinquent 61-90 days

     245        100        78        41        56        —          520   

Loans in repayment — delinquent greater than 90 days

     709        317        205        102        134        —          1,467   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 9,246      $ 6,837      $ 5,677      $ 3,778      $ 6,033      $ 6,522        38,093   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Unamortized discount

                 (873

Receivable for partially charged-off loans

                 1,241   

Allowance for loan losses

                 (2,171
              

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loans, net

               $ 36,290   
              

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

     10.0     2.8     2.2     1.8     1.3     —       4.4
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   Monthly Scheduled Payments Due     Not Yet in
Repayment
       

December 31, 2010

   0 to 12     13 to 24     25 to 36     37 to 48     More than 48       Total  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment

   $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ 8,340      $ 8,340   

Loans in forbearance

     980        167        92        47        54        —          1,340   

Loans in repayment — current

     8,342        5,855        4,037        2,679        3,975        —          24,888   

Loans in repayment — delinquent 31-60 days

     537        209        117        63        85        —          1,011   

Loans in repayment — delinquent 61-90 days

     258        92        55        27        39        —          471   

Loans in repayment — delinquent greater than 90 days

     815        336        156        75        100        —          1,482   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 10,932      $ 6,659      $ 4,457      $ 2,891      $ 4,253      $ 8,340        37,532   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Unamortized discount

                 (894

Receivable for partially charged-off loans

                 1,040   

Allowance for loan losses

                 (2,022
              

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loans, net

               $ 35,656   
              

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

     9.0     2.5     2.1     1.6     1.3     —       4.6
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   Monthly Scheduled Payments Due     Not Yet in
Repayment
       

December 31, 2009

   0 to 12     13 to 24     25 to 36     37 to 48     More than 48       Total  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment

   $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ —        $ 11,456      $ 11,456   

Loans in forbearance

     1,144        139        69        31        37        —          1,420   

Loans in repayment — current

     8,817        4,730        3,119        1,878        2,864        —          21,408   

Loans in repayment — delinquent 31-60 days

     642        159        79        40        59        —          979   

Loans in repayment — delinquent 61-90 days

     316        81        41        23        30        —          491   

Loans in repayment — delinquent greater than 90 days

     999        251        110        53        75        —          1,488   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 11,918      $ 5,360      $ 3,418      $ 2,025      $ 3,065      $ 11,456        37,242   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

Unamortized discount

                 (908

Receivable for partially charged-off loans

                 728   

Allowance for loan losses

                 (1,967
              

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loans, net

               $ 35,095   
              

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

     9.6     2.6     2.0     1.6     1.2     —       5.5
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

70


Table of Contents

The table below stratifies the portfolio of “Core Earnings” basis Private Education Loans in forbearance by the cumulative number of months the borrower has used forbearance as of the dates indicated. As detailed in the table below, 4 percent of loans currently in forbearance have cumulative forbearance of more than 24 months.

 

     December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
    December 31,
2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Forbearance
Balance
     % of
Total
    Forbearance
Balance
     % of
Total
    Forbearance
Balance
     % of
Total
 

Cumulative number of months borrower has used forbearance

               

Up to 12 months

   $ 887         64   $ 958         71   $ 1,050         74

13 to 24 months

     446         32        343         26        332         23   

More than 24 months

     53         4        39         3        38         3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,386         100   $ 1,340         100   $ 1,420         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Private Education Loan Repayment Options

Certain loan programs allow borrowers to select from a variety of repayment options depending on their loan type and their enrollment/loan status, which include the ability to extend their repayment term or change their monthly payment. The chart below provides the optional repayment offerings in addition to the standard level principal and interest payments as of December 31, 2011.

 

    Loan Program  

(Dollars in millions)

  Signature and
Other
    Smart Option     Career
Training
    Total  

$ in Repayment

  $ 24,212      $ 4,196      $ 1,777      $ 30,185   

$ in Total

    31,484        4,765        1,844        38,093   

Payment method by enrollment status:

       

In-school/Grace

    Deferred (1)     

 

Deferred(1), Interest-only

or fixed $25/month

  

  

   

$

Interest-only or fixed

25/month

  

  

 

Repayment

   
 
Level principal and
interest or graduated
  
  
   

 

Level principal and

interest

  

  

   
 
Level principal and
interest
  
  
 

 

  (1) 

“Deferred” includes loans for which no payments are required and interest charges are capitalized into the loan balance.

The graduated repayment program that is part of Signature and Other Loans includes an interest-only payment feature that may be selected at the option of the borrower. Borrowers elect to participate in this program at the time they enter repayment following their grace period. This program is available to borrowers in repayment, after their grace period, who would like a temporary lower payment from the required principal and interest payment amount. Borrowers participating in this program pay monthly interest with no amortization of their principal balance for up to 48 payments after entering repayment (dependent on the loan product type). The maturity date of the loan is not extended when a borrower participates in this program. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, borrowers in repayment owing approximately $7.2 billion (24 percent of loans in repayment) and $7.5 billion (27 percent of loans in repayment), respectively, were enrolled in the interest-only program. Of these amounts, 11 percent and 12 percent were non-traditional loans as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

71


Table of Contents

FFELP Loan Portfolio Performance

FFELP Loan Delinquencies and Forbearance

The tables below present our FFELP Loan delinquency trends

 

     GAAP-Basis
FFELP Loan Delinquencies
 
     December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance      %     Balance      %     Balance      %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 22,887         $ 28,214         $ 35,079      

Loans in forbearance(2)

     19,575           22,028           14,121      

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

               

Loans current

     77,093         81.9     80,026         82.8     57,528         82.4

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     5,419         5.8        5,500         5.7        4,250         6.1   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     3,438         3.7        3,178         3.3        2,205         3.1   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     8,231         8.6        7,992         8.2        5,844         8.4   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans in repayment

     94,181         100     96,696         100     69,827         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans, gross

     136,643           146,938           119,027      

FFELP Loan unamortized premium

     1,674           1,900           2,187      
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Total FFELP Loans

     138,317           148,838           121,214      

FFELP Loan allowance for losses

     (187        (189        (161   
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

FFELP Loans, net

   $ 138,130         $ 148,649         $ 121,053      
  

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

    

Percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

        68.9        65.8        58.7
     

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

        18.1        17.2        17.6
     

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

FFELP Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

        17.2        18.6        16.8
     

 

 

      

 

 

      

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

Loans for borrowers who may still be attending school or engaging in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation, as well as loans for borrowers who have requested and qualify for other permitted program deferments such as military, unemployment, or economic hardship.

 

  (2) 

Loans for borrowers who have used their allowable deferment time or do not qualify for deferment, that need additional time to obtain employment or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors.

 

  (3) 

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

 

72


Table of Contents

 

     Off-Balance Sheet
FFELP Loan
Delinquencies(4)
 
     December 31,
2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance     %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 3,312     

Loans in forbearance(2)

     2,726     

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

    

Loans current

     11,304        82.5

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     804        5.9   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     439        3.2   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     1,160        8.4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans in repayment

     13,707        100
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans, gross

     19,745     

FFELP Loan unamortized premium

     577     
  

 

 

   

Total FFELP Loans

     20,322     

FFELP Loan allowance for losses

     (25  
  

 

 

   

FFELP Loans, net

   $ 20,297     
  

 

 

   

Percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

       69.4
    

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

       17.5
    

 

 

 

FFELP Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

       16.6
    

 

 

 

 

     “Core Earnings” Basis
FFELP Loan Delinquencies
 
     December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance     %     Balance     %     Balance     %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 22,887        $ 28,214        $ 38,391     

Loans in forbearance(2)

     19,575          22,028          16,847     

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

            

Loans current

     77,093        81.9     80,026        82.8     68,832        82.4

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     5,419        5.8        5,500        5.7        5,054        6.0   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     3,438        3.7        3,178        3.3        2,644        3.2   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     8,231        8.6        7,992        8.2        7,004        8.4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans in repayment

     94,181        100     96,696        100     83,534        100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans, gross

     136,643          146,938          138,772     

FFELP Loan unamortized premium

     1,674          1,900          2,764     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total FFELP Loans

     138,317          148,838          141,536     

FFELP Loan allowance for losses

     (187       (189       (186  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

FFELP Loans, net

   $ 138,130        $ 148,649        $ 141,350     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

       68.9       65.8       60.2
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

       18.1       17.2       17.6
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

FFELP Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

       17.2       18.6       16.8
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Loans for borrowers who may still be attending school or engaging in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation, as well as loans for borrowers who have requested and qualify for other permitted program deferments such as military, unemployment, or economic hardship.

 

(2) 

Loans for borrowers who have used their allowable deferment time or do not qualify for deferment, that need additional time to obtain employment or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors.

 

(3) 

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

 

(4) 

On January 1, 2010, upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance, all off-balance sheet loans are included in GAAP-basis.

 

73


Table of Contents

Allowance for FFELP Loan Losses

The following table summarizes changes in the allowance for FFELP Loan losses.

 

     Activity in Allowance for FFELP Loans  
     GAAP-Basis
Years Ended December 31,
    Off-Balance Sheet
Years Ended December 31,
    “Core Earnings” Basis
Years Ended December 31,
 

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009     2011     2010(1)     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Allowance at beginning of period

   $ 189      $ 161      $ 138      $ —        $ 25      $ 27      $ 189      $ 186      $ 165   

Provision for FFELP Loan losses

     86        98        106        —          —          13        86        98        119   

Charge-offs

     (78     (87     (79     —          —          (15     (78     (87     (94

Student loan sales and securitization activity

     (10     (8     (4     —          —          —          (10     (8     (4

Consolidation of securitization trusts(1)

     —          25        —          —          (25     —          —          —          —     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Allowance at end of period

   $ 187      $ 189      $ 161      $ —        $ —        $ 25      $ 187      $ 189      $ 186   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment

     .08     .11     .11     —       —       .10     .08     .11     .11

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment and forbearance

     .07     .09     .10     —       —       .09     .07     .09     .09

Allowance as a percentage of the ending total loans, gross

     .14     .13     .14     —       —       .13     .14     .13     .13

Allowance as a percentage of ending loans in repayment

     .20     .20     .23     —       —       .18     .20     .20     .22

Allowance coverage of charge-offs

     2.4        2.2        2.0        —          —          1.7        2.4        2.2        2.0   

Ending total loans, gross

   $ 136,643      $ 146,938      $ 119,027      $ —        $ —        $ 19,745      $ 136,643      $ 146,938      $ 138,772   

Average loans in repayment

   $ 94,359      $ 82,255      $ 69,020      $ —        $ —        $ 14,293      $ 94,359      $ 82,255      $ 83,313   

Ending loans in repayment

   $ 94,181      $ 96,696      $ 69,827      $ —        $ —        $ 13,707      $ 94,181      $ 96,696      $ 83,534   

 

(1)

Upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, we consolidated all of our off-balance sheet securitization trusts.

 

74


Table of Contents

Liquidity and Capital Resources

Funding and Liquidity Risk Management

The following “Liquidity and Capital Resources” discussion concentrates on our Consumer Lending and FFELP Loans segments. Our Business Services and Other segments require minimal capital.

We define liquidity risk as the potential inability to meet our contractual and contingent financial obligations as they come due, as well as the potential inability to fund Private Education Loan originations. Our primary liquidity objective is to ensure our ongoing ability to meet our funding needs for our businesses throughout market cycles, including during periods of financial stress. Our two primary liquidity needs are funding the originations of Private Education Loans and retiring unsecured debt upon maturity. To achieve that objective we analyze and monitor our liquidity needs, maintain excess liquidity and access diverse funding sources including the issuance of unsecured debt, the issuance of secured debt primarily through asset backed securitizations and/or other financing facilities and through deposits at Sallie Mae Bank (“the Bank”), our Utah industrial bank subsidiary.

We define liquidity as cash and high-quality liquid securities that we can use to meet our funding requirements as they arise. Our primary liquidity risk relates to our ability to fund new originations and raise replacement funding at a reasonable cost as our unsecured debt matures. In addition, we must continue to obtain funding at reasonable rates to meet our other business obligations and to continue to grow our business. Key risks associated with our liquidity relate to our ability to access the capital markets and access them at reasonable rates. This ability may be affected by our credit ratings, as well as the overall availability of funding sources in the marketplace. In addition, credit ratings may be important to customers or counterparties when we compete in certain markets and when we seek to engage in certain transactions, including over-the-counter derivatives.

Credit ratings and outlooks are opinions subject to ongoing review by the ratings agencies and may change from time to time based on our financial performance, industry dynamics and other factors. Other factors that influence our credit ratings include the ratings agencies’ assessment of the general operating environment, our relative positions in the markets in which we compete, reputation, liquidity position, the level and volatility of earnings, corporate governance and risk management policies, capital position and capital management practices. A negative change in our credit rating could have a negative effect on our liquidity because it would raise the cost and availability of funding and potentially require additional cash collateral or restrict cash currently held as collateral on existing borrowings or derivative collateral arrangements. It is our objective to improve our credit ratings so that we can continue to efficiently access the capital markets even in difficult economic and market conditions.

Recent market volatility has elevated the potential cost of capital markets issuance. Regardless, we continue to expect to fund our ongoing liquidity needs, including the origination of new Private Education Loans and the repayment of $1.8 billion of senior unsecured notes to mature in 2012, primarily through our current cash and investment position and the collection of additional bank deposits, the very predictable operating cash flows provided by earnings and repayment of principal on unencumbered student loan assets and distributions from our securitization trusts (including servicing fees which are priority payments within the trusts). We may also draw down on FFELP ABCP Facilities and the facility with the Federal Home Loan Bank in Des Moines (the “FHLB-DM Facility”); and we may also issue term ABS and unsecured debt.

Currently, new Private Education Loan originations are initially funded through deposits and subsequently securitized to term on a programmatic basis. We have $1.5 billion of cash at the Bank as of December 31, 2011 available to fund future originations. We no longer originate FFELP Loans and therefore no longer have liquidity requirements for new FFELP Loan originations.

The acquisition of loan portfolios may require additional funding. Additionally, it is our intent to refinance, primarily through securitizations, the FFELP Loans that are currently in the ED Conduit Program by its January 2014 maturity date. We currently have $21.4 billion of collateral in the ED Conduit Program. While the assets in

 

75


Table of Contents

this facility can be put to ED at the conclusion of the program thus eliminating a call on our liquidity, we intend to refinance these assets in the term ABS market prior to the facility’s expiration. In addition, capacity is maintained in our FFELP ABCP Facility and our FHLB-DM Facility to finance a portion of this collateral should term financing not be achieved or available.

Sources of Liquidity and Available Capacity

The following tables detail our main sources of primary liquidity and our main sources of secondary liquidity (unused secured credit facilities contingent upon obtaining eligible collateral).

 

(Dollars in millions)

   December 31, 2011      December 31, 2010  

Sources of primary liquidity:

     

Unrestricted cash and liquid investments:

     

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 2,794       $ 4,342   

Investments

     71         85   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unrestricted cash and liquid investments(1)

   $ 2,865       $ 4,427   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unencumbered FFELP Loans

   $ 994       $ 1,441   

Sources of secondary liquidity contingent on obtaining eligible collateral:

     

Unused secured credit facilities: FFELP ABCP Facilities and FHLB-DM Facility(2)

   $ 11,312       $ 12,601   

 

  (1)

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, ending balances include $1.5 billion and $2.0 billion, respectively, of cash and liquid investments at the Bank. This cash will be used primarily to originate or acquire student loans at the Bank. Our ability to pay dividends from the Bank is subject to capital and liquidity requirements applicable to the Bank.

 

  (2)

Current borrowing capacity under the FFELP ABCP Facilities and FHLB-DM Facility is determined based on qualifying collateral from the unencumbered FFELP Loans reported in primary liquidity above. Additional borrowing capacity would primarily be used to fund FFELP Loan portfolio acquisitions and to refinance FFELP Loans used as collateral in the ED Conduit Program Facility. The total amount we can borrow is contingent upon obtaining eligible collateral. If we use our unencumbered FFELP Loans as collateral to borrow against these facilities, the remaining amount we could borrow is reduced accordingly.

 

     Average Balances  
     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010      2009  

Sources of primary liquidity:

        

Unrestricted cash and liquid investments:

        

Cash and cash equivalents

   $ 3,623       $ 6,078       $ 5,713   

Investments

     95         94         145   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unrestricted cash and liquid investments(1)

   $ 3,718       $ 6,172       $ 5,858   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Unused bank lines of credit

   $ —         $ 2,069       $ 4,014   

Unencumbered FFELP Loans

   $ 1,399       $ 1,897       $ 3,507   

Sources of secondary liquidity contingent on obtaining eligible collateral:

        

Unused secured credit facilities: FFELP ABCP Facilities and FHLB-DM Facility(2)

   $ 11,356       $ 12,947       $ 1,802   

 

  (1) 

For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, average balances include $1.2 billion, $2.3 billion and $2.0 billion, respectively, of cash and liquid investments at the Bank. This cash will be used primarily to originate or acquire student loans at the Bank. Our ability to pay dividends from the Bank is subject to capital and liquidity requirements applicable to the Bank.

 

  (2) 

Current borrowing capacity under the FFELP ABCP Facilities and FHLB-DM Facility is determined based on qualifying collateral from the unencumbered FFELP Loans reported in primary liquidity above. Additional borrowing capacity would primarily be used to fund FFELP Loan portfolio acquisitions and to refinance FFELP Loans used as collateral in the ED Conduit Program Facility. The total amount we can borrow is contingent upon obtaining eligible collateral. If we use our unencumbered FFELP Loans as collateral to borrow against these facilities, the remaining amount we could borrow is reduced accordingly.

 

76


Table of Contents

In addition to the assets listed in the table above, we hold a number of other unencumbered assets, consisting primarily of Private Education Loans and other assets. At December 31, 2011, we had a total of $20.2 billion of unencumbered assets (which includes the assets that comprise our primary liquidity and are available to serve as collateral for our secondary liquidity), excluding goodwill and acquired intangibles. Total unencumbered student loans, net, comprised $12.0 billion of our unencumbered assets of which $11.0 billion and $1.0 billion related to Private Education Loans, net, and FFELP Loans, net, respectively.

For further discussion of our various sources of liquidity, such as the ED Conduit Program, the Sallie Mae Bank, our continued access to the ABS market, our asset-backed financing facilities, the lending agreement we entered into with the FHLB-DM and our issuance of unsecured debt, see “Note 6 — Borrowings” to our consolidated financial statements.

The following table reconciles encumbered and unencumbered assets and their net impact on total tangible equity.

 

(Dollars in billions)

   December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
 

Net assets of consolidated variable interest entities (encumbered assets)

   $ 12.9      $ 13.1   

Tangible unencumbered assets(1)

     20.2        22.3   

Unsecured debt

     (24.1     (26.9

Mark-to-market on unsecured hedged debt(2)

     (1.9     (1.4

Other liabilities, net

     (2.3     (2.6
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total tangible equity

   $ 4.8      $ 4.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

Excludes goodwill and acquired intangible assets.

 

  (2)

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, there were $1.6 billion and $1.4 billion, respectively, of net gains on derivatives hedging this debt in unencumbered assets, which partially offset these losses.

2011 Transactions

During 2011, we issued a $2.0 billion senior unsecured bond. Additionally, we issued a total of $2.4 billion in FFELP ABS and $2.1 billion in Private Education Loan ABS. We expect to be a programmatic issuer of ABS throughout 2012.

In the fourth-quarter 2011, we closed on a $3.4 billion Private Education Loan asset-backed commercial paper facility that matures in January 2014. This facility was used to finance the call of Private Education Loan asset-backed securities in the fourth-quarter 2011 and in early 2012 at a significant discount to the bond’s par amount. This resulted in a reduced cost of funds compared to that of the called bonds.

In 2011 we repurchased $894 million face amount of our senior unsecured notes in the aggregate, with maturity dates ranging from 2011 to 2014, which resulted in a realized “Core Earnings” gain of $64 million.

On June 17, 2011, September 16, 2011, and December 16, 2011, we paid a quarterly dividend of $.10 per share on our common stock, the first dividends paid since early 2007. In April 2011, we authorized the repurchase of up to $300 million of outstanding common stock in open market transactions and terminated all previous authorizations. During the second and third quarters of 2011, we repurchased 19.1 million shares for an aggregate purchase price of $300 million. With this action, we fully utilized this share repurchase authorization.

2012 Transactions

The following financing transactions have taken place in 2012:

 

   

On January 13, 2012, the FFELP ABCP Facility was amended to increase the amount available to $7.5 billion, reflecting an increase of $2.5 billion over the previously scheduled facility reduction. In addition,

 

77


Table of Contents
 

the amendment extends the final maturity date by one year to January 9, 2015 and increases the amount available at future step-down dates.

 

   

On January 19, 2012, we issued $765 million of FFELP ABS.

 

   

On January 27, 2012, we issued a two-part $1.5 billion senior unsecured bond. $750 million has a five-year term, the remaining $750 million has a ten-year term.

 

   

On February 9, 2012, we issued $547 million of Private Education Loan ABS.

In addition, on January 26, 2012, we increased our quarterly dividend on our common stock to $0.125 per share. The next such quarterly dividend will be paid on March 16, 2012. We also authorized the repurchase of up to $500 million of outstanding common stock.

Counterparty Exposure

Counterparty exposure related to financial instruments arises from the risk that a lending, investment or derivative counterparty will not be able to meet its obligations to us. Risks associated with our lending portfolio are discussed in Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Financial Condition — FFELP Loan Portfolio Performance” and “— Consumer Lending Portfolio Performance.”

Our investment portfolio is composed of very short-term securities issued by a diversified group of highly rated issuers limiting our counterparty exposure. Additionally, our investing activity is governed by Board approved limits on the amount that is allowed to be invested with any one issuer based on the credit rating of the issuer, further minimizing our counterparty exposure. Counterparty credit risk is considered when valuing investments and considering impairment.

Related to derivative transactions, protection against counterparty risk is generally provided by International Swaps and Derivatives Association, Inc. (“ISDA”) Credit Support Annexes (“CSAs”). CSAs require a counterparty to post collateral if a potential default would expose the other party to a loss. All derivative contracts entered into by SLM Corporation and the Bank are covered under such agreements and require collateral to be exchanged based on the net fair value of derivatives with each counterparty. Our securitization trusts require collateral in all cases if the counterparty’s credit rating is withdrawn or downgraded below a certain level. Additionally, securitizations involving foreign currency notes issued after November 2005 also require the counterparty to post collateral to the trust based on the fair value of the derivative, regardless of credit rating. The trusts are not required to post collateral to the counterparties. In all cases, our exposure is limited to the value of the derivative contracts in a gain position net of any collateral we are holding. We consider counterparties’ credit risk when determining the fair value of derivative positions on our exposure net of collateral.

We have liquidity exposure related to collateral movements between us and our derivative counterparties. Movements in the value of the derivatives, which are primarily affected by changes in interest rate and foreign exchange rates, may require us to return cash collateral held or may require us to access primary liquidity to post collateral to counterparties. If our credit ratings are downgraded from current levels, we may be required to segregate additional unrestricted cash collateral into restricted accounts.

 

78


Table of Contents

The table below highlights exposure related to our derivative counterparties at December 31, 2011.

 

(Dollars in millions)

  SLM Corporation
and Sallie Mae Bank
Contracts
    Securitization Trust
Contracts(1)
 

Exposure, net of collateral

  $ 113      $ 807   

Percent of exposure to counterparties with credit ratings below S&P AA- or Moody’s Aa3

    98     32

Percent of exposure to counterparties with credit ratings below S&P A- or Moody’s A3

    0     0

 

  (1) 

Current turmoil in the European markets has led to increased disclosure of exposure to those markets. Of the total net exposure, $691 million is related to financial institutions located in France; of this amount, $498 million carries a guarantee from the French government. $690 million of the $691 million exposure relates to derivatives held at our securitization trusts. Counterparties to these derivatives are required to post collateral when their credit rating is withdrawn or downgraded below a certain level. As of December 31, 2011, no collateral was required to be posted. Adjustments are made to our derivative valuations for counterparty credit risk. The adjustments made at December 31, 2011 related to derivatives with French financial institutions (including those that carry a guarantee from the French government) decreased the derivative asset value by $179 million. Credit risks for all derivative counterparties are assessed internally on a continual basis.

“Core Earnings” Basis Borrowings

The following tables present the ending balances of our “Core Earnings” basis borrowings at December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, and average balances and average interest rates of our “Core Earnings” basis borrowings for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009. The average interest rates include derivatives that are economically hedging the underlying debt but do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment. (See “‘Core Earnings’ — Definition and Limitations — Differences between ‘Core Earnings’ and GAAP — Reclassification of Realized Gains (Losses) on Derivative and Hedging Activities” of this Item 7).

Ending Balances

 

    December 31, 2011     December 31, 2010     December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

  Short
Term
    Long
Term
    Total     Short
Term
    Long
Term
    Total     Short
Term
    Long
Term
    Total  

Unsecured borrowings:

                 

Senior unsecured debt

  $ 1,801      $ 15,199      $ 17,000      $ 4,361      $ 15,742      $ 20,103      $ 5,185      $ 22,797      $ 27,982   

Brokered deposits

    1,733        1,956        3,689        1,387        3,160        4,547        842        4,795        5,637   

Retail and other deposits

    2,123        —          2,123        1,370        —          1,370        204        —          204   

Other(1)

    1,329        —          1,329        887        —          887        1,268        —          1,268   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total unsecured borrowings

    6,986        17,155        24,141        8,005        18,902        26,907        7,499        27,592        35,091   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Secured borrowings:

                 

FFELP Loans securitizations

    —          107,905        107,905        —          113,671        113,671        64        103,724        103,788   

Private Education Loans securitizations

    —          19,297        19,297        —          21,409        21,409        —          20,624        20,624   

ED Conduit Program Facility

    21,313        —          21,313        24,484        —          24,484        14,314        —          14,314   

ED Participation Program Facility

    —          —          —          —          —          —          9,006        —          9,006   

FFELP ABCP Facility

    —          4,445        4,445        —          5,853        5,853        —          8,801        8,801   

Private Education Loans ABCP Facility

    —          1,992        1,992        —          —          —          —          —          —     

Acquisition financing(2)

    —          916        916        —          1,064        1,064        —          —          —     

FHLB-DM Facility

    1,210        —          1,210        900        —          900        —          —          —     
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total secured borrowings

    22,523        134,555        157,078        25,384        141,997        167,381        23,384        133,149        156,533   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $     29,509      $     151,710      $     181,219      $     33,389      $     160,899      $     194,288      $     30,883      $     160,741      $     191,624   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

“Other” primarily consists of the obligation to return cash collateral held related to derivative exposure.

 

(2)

Relates to the acquisition of $25 billion of student loans at the end of 2010.

 

79


Table of Contents

Secured borrowings comprised 87 percent of our “Core Earnings” basis debt outstanding at December 31, 2011 versus 86 percent at December 31, 2010.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Average
Balance
     Average
Rate
    Average
Balance
     Average
Rate
    Average
Balance
     Average
Rate
 

Unsecured borrowings:

               

Senior unsecured debt

   $ 19,562         2.34   $ 24,480         1.70   $ 31,863         1.77

Brokered deposits

     3,660         2.35        5,123         2.65        4,754         3.50   

Retail and other deposits

     1,684         1.11        644         1.16        128         .59   

Other(1)

     1,187         .17        1,159         .19        1,263         .28   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unsecured borrowings

     26,093         2.16        31,406         1.79        38,008         1.94   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Secured borrowings:

               

FFELP Loans securitizations

     110,474         .93        100,967         .87        105,069         1.15   

Private Education Loans securitizations

     20,976         2.17        21,367         2.13        17,731         1.83   

ED Conduit Program Facility

     22,869         .75        15,096         .70        7,340         .75   

ED Participation Program Facility

     —           —          13,537         .81        14,174         1.43   

FFELP ABCP Facility

     4,989         1.05        6,623         1.24        15,401         2.79   

Private Education Loans ABCP Facility

     272         2.08        —           —          838         5.56   

Acquisition financing(2)

     998         4.81        3         5.28        —           —     

FHLB-DM Facility

     893         .25        403         .35        —           —     
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total secured borrowings

     161,471         1.09        157,996         1.03        160,553         1.41   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $     187,564         1.24   $     189,402         1.16   $     198,561         1.51
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

“Other” primarily consists of the obligation to return cash collateral held related to derivative exposure.

 

(2)

Relates to the acquisition of $25 billion of student loans at the end of 2010.

Contractual Cash Obligations

The following table provides a summary of our obligations associated with long-term notes at December 31, 2011. For further discussion of these obligations, see “Note 6 — Borrowings.”

 

(Dollars in millions)

   1 Year
or Less
     2 to 3
Years
     4 to 5
Years
     Over
5 Years
     Total  

Long-term notes:

              

Senior unsecured debt

   $ —         $ 5,354       $ 3,012       $ 6,833       $ 15,199   

Unsecured term bank deposits

     —           1,956         —           —           1,956   

Secured borrowings(1)

     12,795         26,933         18,949         75,878         134,555   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total contractual cash obligations(2)

   $ 12,795       $ 34,243       $ 21,961       $ 82,711       $ 151,710   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Includes long-term beneficial interests of $127.2 billion of notes issued by consolidated VIEs in conjunction with our securitization transactions and included in long-term notes in the consolidated balance sheet. Timing of obligations is estimated based on our current projection of prepayment speeds of the securitized assets.

 

(2)

The aggregate principal amount of debt that matures in each period is $12.9 billion, $34.5 billion, $22.1 billion and $83.3 billion, respectively. Specifically excludes derivative market value adjustments of $2.7 billion for long-term notes. Interest obligations on notes are predominantly variable in nature, resetting quarterly based on 3-month LIBOR.

Unrecognized tax benefits were $40 million and $39 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. For additional information, see “Note 15 — Income Taxes.”

 

80


Table of Contents

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations addresses our consolidated financial statements, which have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“GAAP”). “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies” includes a summary of the significant accounting policies and methods used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements. The preparation of these financial statements requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and the reported amounts of income and expenses during the reporting periods. Actual results may differ from these estimates under varying assumptions or conditions. On a quarterly basis, management evaluates its estimates, particularly those that include the most difficult, subjective or complex judgments and are often about matters that are inherently uncertain. The most significant judgments, estimates and assumptions relate to the following critical accounting policies that are discussed in more detail below.

Allowance for Loan Losses

In determining the allowance for loan losses, we estimate the principal amount of loans that will default over the next two years (two years being the expected period between a loss event and default) and how much we will recover over time related to the defaulted amount. Our historical experience indicates that, on average, the time between the date that a borrower experiences a default causing event (e.g., the loss trigger event) and the date that we charge off the unrecoverable portion of that loan is two years. Additionally, we estimate an allowance amount sufficient to cover life-of-loan expected losses for loans classified as a troubled debt restructuring (see further discussion below). In the first quarter of 2011, we implemented a new model to estimate the Private Education Loan default amount. Both the prior model and new model are considered “migration models”. Our prior allowance model (in place through December 31, 2010) segmented the portfolio into categories of similar risk characteristics of which we consider school type, credit scores, existence of a cosigner, loan status and loan seasoning as the key credit quality indicators. Our new model uses these credit quality indicators, but incorporates a more granular segmentation of seasoning data into the calculation. Another change in the new allowance model relates to the historical period of experience that we use as a starting point for projecting future defaults. Our new model is based upon a seasonal average, adjusted to the most recent three to six months of actual collection experience as the starting point and applies expected macroeconomic changes and collection procedure changes to estimate expected losses caused by loss events incurred as of the balance sheet date. Our previous model primarily used a one year historical default experience period and incorporated the estimated impact of macroeconomic factors and collection procedure changes on a qualitative basis. Our current model places a greater emphasis on the more recent default experience rather than the default experience for older historical periods, as we believe the recent default experience is more indicative of the probable losses incurred in the loan portfolio today. While we incorporated the new model in the first quarter of 2011, the overall process for calculating the appropriate amount of allowance for Private Education Loan loss did not change. Significantly more judgment has been required over the last several years, compared with years prior, in light of the U.S. economy and its effect on our customer’s ability to pay their obligations. We believe that the current model more accurately reflects recent borrower behavior, loan performance, and collection performance, as well as expectations about economic factors. There was no adjustment to our allowance for loan loss upon implementing this new default projection model in the first quarter of 2011.

Similar to estimating defaults, we begin with historical borrower payment behavior to estimate the timing and amount of future recoveries on Private Education Loan defaults. We use judgment in determining whether historical performance is representative of what we expect to recover in the future. In contrast to the overall improvements in credit quality, delinquency and charge-off trends we saw in 2011, Private Education Loans which defaulted between 2008 and 2011 for which we have previously charged off estimated losses have, to varying degrees, not met our recovery expectations to date and may continue not to do so. (See “Business Segment Earnings Summary — “Core Earnings” Basis — Consumer Lending Segment — Private Education Loans Provision for Loan Losses and Charge-offs” of this Item 7, for further discussion.)

 

81


Table of Contents

On July 1, 2011, we adopted Accounting Standards Update No. 2011-02, Receivables (Topic 310), “A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring Is a Troubled Debt Restructuring.” This new guidance clarifies when a loan restructuring constitutes a troubled debt restructuring. In applying the new guidance we have determined that certain Private Education Loans for which we have granted forbearance of greater than three months are classified as troubled debt restructurings. If a loan meets the criteria for troubled debt accounting then an allowance for loan loss is established which represents the present value of the losses that are expected to occur over the remaining life of the loan. This accounting results in a higher allowance for loan losses than our previously established allowance for these loans as our previous allowance for these loans represented an estimate of charge-offs expected to occur over the next two years (two years being our loss confirmation period). The new accounting guidance was effective as of July 1, 2011 but was required to be applied retrospectively to January 1, 2011. This resulted in $124 million of additional provision for loan losses in the third quarter of 2011 from approximately $3.8 billion of student loans being classified as troubled debt restructurings. This new accounting guidance is only applied to certain borrowers who use their fourth or greater month of forbearance during the time period this new guidance is effective. This new accounting guidance has the effect of accelerating the recognition of expected losses related to our Private Education Loan portfolio. The increase in the provision for losses as a result of this new accounting guidance does not reflect a decrease in credit expectations of the portfolio or an increase in the expected life-of-loan losses related to this portfolio. We believe forbearance is an accepted and effective collections and risk management tool for Private Education Loans. We plan to continue to use forbearance and as a result, we expect to have additional loans classified as troubled debt restructurings in the future (see “Financial Condition — Consumer Lending Portfolio Performance — Allowance for Private Education Loan Losses” of this Item 7. for a further discussion on the use of forbearance as a collection tool).

FFELP Loans are insured as to their principal and accrued interest in the event of default subject to a Risk Sharing level based on the date of loan disbursement. These insurance obligations are supported by contractual rights against the United States. For loans disbursed after October 1, 1993, and before July 1, 2006, we receive 98 percent reimbursement on all qualifying default claims. For loans disbursed on or after July 1, 2006, we receive 97 percent reimbursement. For loans disbursed prior to October 1, 1993, we receive 100 percent reimbursement.

The allowance for FFELP Loan losses uses historical experience of borrower default behavior and a two year loss confirmation period to estimate the credit losses incurred in the loan portfolio at the reporting date. We apply the default rate projections, net of applicable Risk Sharing, to each category for the current period to perform our quantitative calculation. Once the quantitative calculation is performed, we review the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses and determine if qualitative adjustments need to be considered.

Premium and Discount Amortization

The most judgmental estimate for premium and discount amortization on student loans is the Constant Prepayment Rate (“CPR”), which measures the rate at which loans in the portfolio pay down principal compared to their stated terms. Loan consolidation, default, term extension and other prepayment factors affecting our CPR estimates are affected by changes in our business strategy, changes in our competitor’s business strategies, FFELP legislative changes, interest rates and changes to the current economic and credit environment. When we determine the CPR we begin with historical prepayment rates due to consolidation activity, defaults, payoffs and term extensions from the utilization of forbearance. We make judgments about which historical period to start with and then make further judgments about whether that historical experience is representative of future expectations and whether additional adjustment may be needed to those historical prepayment rates.

In the past the consolidation of FFELP Loans and Private Education Loans significantly affected our CPRs and updating those assumptions often resulted in material adjustments to our amortization expense. As a result of the passage of HCERA, there is no longer the ability to consolidate under the FFELP. In addition, due to the current U.S. economic and credit environment, we, as well as many other industry competitors, have suspended our Private Education Loans consolidation program. As a result, we do not expect to consolidate FFELP Loans

 

82


Table of Contents

in the future and do not currently expect others to actively consolidate our FFELP loans. As a result, we expect CPRs related to our FFELP Loans to remain relatively stable over time. See “Business Segment Earnings Summary — ‘Core Earnings’ Basis — FFELP Loans Segment” of this Item 7, for discussion of the potential impact of a recent Special Direct Consolidation Loan Initiative. We expect that in the future both we and our competitors will begin to consolidate Private Education Loans. This is built into the CPR assumption we use for Private Education Loans. However, it is difficult to accurately project the timing and level at which this consolidation activity will begin and our assumption may need to be updated by a material amount in the future based on changes in the economy and marketplace. The level of defaults is a significant component of our FFELP Loan and Private Education Loan CPR. This component of the FFELP Loan and Private Education Loan CPR is estimated in the same manner as discussed in “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates — Allowance for Loan Loss” of this Item 7 — the only difference is for premium and discount amortization purposes the estimate of defaults is a life-of-loan estimate whereas for allowance for loan loss it is a two-year estimate.

Fair Value Measurement

The most significant assumptions used in fair value measurements, including those related to credit and liquidity risk, are as follows:

 

  1. Investments — Our investments primarily consist of overnight/weekly maturity instruments with high credit quality counterparties. However, we consider credit and liquidity risk involving specific instruments in determining their fair value and, when appropriate, have adjusted the fair value of these instruments for the effect of credit and liquidity risk. These assumptions have further been validated by the successful maturity of these investments in the period immediately following the end of the reporting period.

 

  2. Derivatives — When determining the fair value of derivatives, we take into account counterparty credit risk for positions where we are exposed to the counterparty on a net basis by assessing exposure net of collateral held. The net exposure for each counterparty is adjusted based on market information available for that specific counterparty, including spreads from credit default swaps. Additionally, when the counterparty has exposure to us related to our derivatives, we fully collateralize the exposure, minimizing the adjustment necessary to the derivative valuations for our own credit risk. Trusts that contain derivatives are not required to post collateral to counterparties as the credit quality and securitized nature of the trusts minimizes any adjustments for the counterparty’s exposure to the trusts. Adjustments related to credit risk reduced the overall value of our derivatives by $190 million as of December 31, 2011. We also take into account changes in liquidity when determining the fair value of derivative positions. We adjusted the fair value of certain less liquid positions downward by approximately $111 million to take into account a significant reduction in liquidity as of December 31, 2011, related primarily to basis swaps indexed to interest rate indices with inactive markets. A major indicator of market inactivity is the widening of the bid/ask spread in these markets. In general, the widening of counterparty credit spreads and reduced liquidity for derivative instruments as indicated by wider bid/ask spreads will reduce the fair value of derivatives. In addition, certain cross-currency interest rate swaps hedging foreign currency denominated reset rate and amortizing notes in our trusts contain extension features that coincide with the remarketing dates of the notes. The valuation of the extension feature requires significant judgment based on internally developed inputs.

 

  3.

Student Loans — Our FFELP Loans and Private Education Loans are accounted for at cost or at the lower of cost or fair value if the loan is held-for-sale. The fair values of our student loans are disclosed in “Note 13 —Fair Value Measurements.” For both FFELP Loans and Private Education Loans accounted for at cost, fair value is determined by modeling loan level cash flows using stated terms of the assets and internally-developed assumptions to determine aggregate portfolio yield, net present value and average life. The significant assumptions used to project cash flows are prepayment speeds, default rates, cost of funds, the amount funded by debt versus equity, and required return on equity. In addition, the Floor Income component of our FFELP Loan portfolio is valued through discounted cash

 

83


Table of Contents
  flow and option models using both observable market inputs and internally developed inputs. Significant inputs into the models are not generally market observable. They are either derived internally through a combination of historical experience and management’s qualitative expectation of future performance (in the case of prepayment speeds, default rates, and capital assumptions) or are obtained through external broker quotes (as in the case of cost of funds). When possible, market transactions are used to validate the model. In most cases, these are either infrequent or not observable. For FFELP Loans classified as held-for-sale and accounted for at the lower of cost or market, the fair value is based on the committed sales price of the various loan purchase programs established by ED.

For further information regarding the effect of our use of fair values on our results of operations, see “Note 13 — Fair Value Measurements.”

Transfers of Financial Assets and the Variable Interest Entity (“VIE”) Consolidation Model — Changes in Accounting Principles effective January 1, 2010

The new consolidation accounting adopted on January 1, 2010 significantly changed the consolidation model for Variable Interest Entities (“VIEs”). This new rule, among other things, (1) eliminated the exemption for QSPEs, (2) provided a new approach for determining who should consolidate a VIE that is more focused on control rather than economic interest, (3) changed when it is necessary to reassess who should consolidate a VIE and (4) required additional disclosure.

Under these new rules, if we have a variable interest in a VIE and we have determined that we are the primary beneficiary of the VIE then we will consolidate the VIE. We are considered the primary beneficiary if we have both: (1) the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance and (2) the obligation to absorb losses or receive benefits of the entity that could potentially be significant to the VIE. There is considerable judgment that has to be used as it relates to determining the primary beneficiary of the VIEs with which we are associated. There are no “bright line” tests. Rather, the assessment of who has the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly affects the VIE’s economic performance and who has the obligation to absorb losses or receive benefits of the entity that could potentially be significant to the VIE is very qualitative and judgmental in nature. However, based on our current relationship with our securitization trusts and other financing vehicles which are considered VIEs, we believe the assessment is more straightforward. As it relates to our securitized assets, we are the servicer of those securitized assets (which means we “have the power” to direct the activities of the trust) and we own the Residual Interest (which means we “have the loss and gain obligation that could potentially be significant to the VIE”) of the securitization trusts. As a result we are the primary beneficiary of our securitization trusts and other financing vehicles. See “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies” for further details regarding the adoption of these new rules on January 1, 2010.

Derivative Accounting

The most significant judgments related to derivative accounting are: (1) concluding the derivative is an effective hedge and qualifies for hedge accounting and (2) determining the fair value of certain derivatives and hedged items. To qualify for hedge accounting a derivative must be concluded to be a highly effective hedge upon designation and on an ongoing basis. There are no “bright line” tests on what is considered a highly effective hedge. We use a historical regression analysis to prove ongoing and prospective hedge effectiveness. See previous discussion under “Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates — Fair Value Measurement” of this Item 7 for significant judgments related to the valuation of derivatives. Although some of our valuations are more judgmental than others, we compare the fair values of our derivatives that we calculate to those provided by our counterparties on a monthly basis. We view this as a critical control which helps validate these judgments. Any significant differences with our counterparties are identified and resolved appropriately.

 

84


Table of Contents

Goodwill and Intangible Assets

In determining annually (or more frequently if required) whether goodwill is impaired, we first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is “more-likely-than-not” that the fair value of a reporting unit, which is the same as or one level below a business segment, is less than its carrying amount as a basis for determining whether it is necessary to perform additional goodwill impairment testing. The “more-likely-than-not” threshold is defined as having a likelihood of more than 50 percent. If this “more-likely-than-not” threshold is met, then we will complete a quantitative goodwill impairment analysis which consists of a comparison of the fair value of the reporting unit to our carrying value, including goodwill. If the carrying value of the reporting unit exceeds the fair value, a goodwill impairment analysis will be performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. If we determine that this event has occurred, we perform an analysis to determine the fair value of the business unit. There are significant judgments involved in determining the fair value of a business unit, including assumptions regarding estimates of future cash flows from existing and new business activities, customer relationships, the value of existing customer contracts, the value of other tangible and intangible assets, as well as assumptions regarding what we believe a third party would be willing to pay for all of the assets and liabilities of the business unit. This calculation requires us to estimate the appropriate discount and growth rates to apply to those projected cash flows and the appropriate control premium to apply to arrive at the final fair value. The business units for which we must estimate the fair value are not publicly traded and often there is not comparable market data available for that individual business to aid in its valuation. We use a third party appraisal firm to provide an opinion on the fair values we conclude upon.

Risk Management

Our Approach

The products, services and markets in which we operate, as well as the various regulatory authorities and regimes to which our businesses, financial condition and lending practices are subject, continue to undergo dramatic change. We recognize that to maintain our reputation with customers and protect the interests of our shareholders and other key constituencies we must continually refresh our understanding of each of our business models, identify and manage the risks related to each of these businesses. Risk management, assessment and oversight responsibilities exist and are documented, reviewed and coordinated at various levels of the Company.

Risk Oversight

Our Board of Directors and its standing committees oversee our overall strategic direction, including setting our risk management philosophy, tolerance and parameters; and establishing procedures for assessing the risks our businesses face as well as the risk management practices our management team develop and utilize. We escalate to our Board of Directors any significant departures from established tolerances and parameters and review new and emerging risks.

In 2011, our Board of Directors invested significant time and effort in continuing to consider and address changes in our risk profile resulting from the end of FFELP in 2010. Particular attention was paid to the strategic redirection of our businesses into consumer lending products and various strategies for expanding our business services opportunities. The format of our strategic business plan, key performance measures and related risk tolerances and parameters and escalation procedures were revised accordingly. Our Board of Directors also directed our Legal, Compliance and Internal Audit groups to work with management and the Board to review and report on the state of existing Board and management risk practices and procedures and to undertake such improvements as the Board of Directors or its committees may direct.

The standing committees of our Board of Directors and their current risk oversight portfolios are as follows:

Executive Committee — has full authority of our Board of Directors to take action when the Board is not in session and includes all board committee chairs, lead outside director, Chief Executive Officer (“CEO”) and

 

85


Table of Contents

Chairman. Key risk functions include working with management to establish and present to our Board of Directors acceptable risk tolerances and parameters for the Company; periodic review and allocation of oversight of particular risks to the committees of the Board for oversight and reporting to the Board of Directors; and advance review with the Audit Committee of all our earnings releases, periodic reports and management’s opinions on business outlook and financial guidance.

Finance and Operations Committee — assists the Board of Directors through its oversight and reporting on capital management, funding/liquidity strategy, acquisitions, and business operation matters. Key risk functions include monitoring our management’s performance within agreed risk parameters and tolerances with respect to all aspects of our operational and financial risk profile, including our Private Education Loan programs and new product initiatives; credit, interest rate and currency risks; investment, asset, and liability management policies and contingency funding plan.

Audit Committee — assists the Board of Directors through its oversight and reporting on the integrity of our financial statements and internal controls processes. Key risk functions include periodically reviewing our financial statements and public disclosures and financial and disclosure policies and underlying assumptions; the qualifications, performance and independence of our independent auditors and Internal Audit group; management’s efforts and effectiveness in managing legal and regulatory compliance and litigation risks; the risk assessment, audit plans and conduct of the Internal Audit group; our information security practices and procedures; and compliance with material aspects of the our Code of Business Conduct and related policies regarding independence and transactions with affiliates.

Compensation and Personnel Committee — assists the Board of Directors through its oversight and reporting matters of executive compensation and personnel. Key risk functions include the approval of compensation, benefits and employment arrangements for our CEO, other senior executive officers and the independent members of the Board; approval of all equity-based plans; general oversight of all benefit, compensation and incentive plans applicable to executive management; consideration of the risk management review of compensation practices conducted at least annually by our Chief Credit and Chief Compliance Officers; advising on various human resources matters, including succession planning and talent management.

Nominating and Governance Committee — assists the Board of Directors through its oversight and reporting of appropriate standards for governance, board operations and qualifications and recommendations of directors. Key risk functions include establishing appropriate standards for corporate governance and guidelines, conducting our Board of Directors’ annual self-assessment survey and taking actions regarding its results as relates to improving the operations of the Board of Directors, the qualifications of its directors and succession planning at the Board of Directors and CEO levels.

Strategy Committee — This committee engages the CEO and senior management from time to time to develop and prepare for the Board of Directors’ annual strategic planning process and facilitate the exchange of information and ideas with our management team in their development of proposals to be considered and approved by the Board of Directors regarding our long-term strategic agenda and initiatives. The committee has no separate or delegated authority from that of our Board of Directors.

Risk Assessment

Our Internal Audit Department monitors our various risk management and compliance efforts, identifies areas that may require increased focus and resources, and reports significant control issues and recommendations to executive management and the Audit Committee of our Board of Directors. At least annually, Internal Audit performs a risk assessment to identify our top risks and to help develop the annual internal audit plan. Risks are rated on significance and likelihood of occurrence and communicated to our management team members who allocate appropriate attention and resources. The risk assessment focuses on those risks most relevant to us and our subsidiaries (including the Bank). The assessment process includes completion of an anonymous survey by our officers followed by interviews with and reports to senior leadership.

 

86


Table of Contents

Risk Management

Our senior executive management team, individually and through participation in or more of our internal risk management committees, are ultimately responsible for the management of risk across our businesses. Each of these committees or their senior executive sponsors have specified periodic reporting and issue escalation obligations to our Board of Directors and their standing committees. Our key internal risk management committees currently include:

Disclosure Committee — reviews and approves content of periodic SEC reporting documents, earnings releases and related disclosure policies and procedures.

Loan Loss Reserve Committee — oversees the sufficiency of our loan loss reserves and considers current or emerging issues affecting delinquency and default trends which may result in adjustments in our allowances for loan losses.

Critical Accounting Assumptions Committee — oversees critical accounting assumptions, as well as key judgments and estimates, utilized in preparation of our financial statements.

Asset and Liability Committee — oversees our investment portfolio and strategy and our compliance with our investment policy.

Corporate Credit Committee — oversees the overall credit and portfolio management strategy, policy review and monitoring.

Corporate Compliance Committee — oversees regulatory compliance risk management activities for Sallie Mae and its affiliates.

ICE Steering Committee — oversees our Internal Controls Excellence (“ICE”) initiative and Sarbanes-Oxley compliance and sponsors periodic forums in which the top internal control deficiencies are discussed and analyzed to ensure the control deficiencies are identified, understood by all relevant affected parties, and have established resolution plans supported by adequate resources.

Customer Products and Services Assessment Committee — considers all matters relating to risks affecting us and our wholly- and majority-owned subsidiaries associated with new, expanded, or modified products or services and makes recommendations regarding proposed products or service offerings based on their inherent risks and controls.

Each business segment is primarily responsible and accountable for managing risks specific to its area utilizing formalized processes and procedures that have been developed by each division in collaboration with internal risk management partners to identify, monitor, manage and escalate the risks specific to that business segment’s activities. Our executive management team and internal risk management partners, including compliance, credit risk, human resources, legal, information technology, finance and accounting, and information security are responsible for providing our business segments with the training, systems and specialized expertise necessary to properly perform their risk management duties.

Our Significant Risks

Significant risks may be grouped into the following categories: (1) funding and liquidity; (2) operational; (3) political/reputational; (4) market; (5) credit; and (6) legal and compliance. More specific descriptions of the particular risks of each type we currently face are discussed in Item 1A “Risk Factors” above.

Funding and Liquidity Risk Management

Funding and liquidity risk involves our potential inability to fund liability maturities and deposit withdrawals, fund asset growth and business operations, and meet contractual obligations at reasonable market

 

87


Table of Contents

rates. Our primary liquidity objective is to ensure our ongoing ability to meet our funding needs for our businesses throughout market cycles, including during periods of financial stress. Our two primary liquidity risks involve our ongoing ability to originate Private Education Loans and retire indebtedness as it matures. Key objectives associated with our funding liquidity needs relate to our ability to access the capital markets at reasonable rates and to continue to maintain retail deposits and funding sources through the Bank.

Our funding and liquidity risk management activities are centralized within our Corporate Finance department, which is responsible for planning and executing our funding activities and strategies. We analyze and monitor our liquidity risk, maintain excess liquidity and access diverse funding sources depending on current market conditions. Funding and liquidity risks are overseen and recommendations approved primarily through our internal Asset and Liability Committee. The Finance and Operations Committee of the Board of Directors is responsible for periodically reviewing and approving our funding and liquidity positions and contingency funding plan. Our Board of Directors also receives regular reports on our performance against funding and liquidity plans at each meeting.

Operational Risk Management

Operational risk arises from the potential that inadequate information systems, operational problems, breaches in internal controls, fraud, or unforeseen catastrophes will result in unexpected losses. The cornerstone of our annual operational risk management program involves our Board of Directors’ approval of our annual strategic business plan and management’s recommendations for how to grow our business while focused on managing risks to acceptable parameters.

Our Board of Directors receives operations reports (which includes operating metrics and performance against annual plan) from our Chief Executive and Chief Operating Officers at each regularly scheduled meeting. Additionally, the Finance & Operations Committee receives business development updates regarding our various business initiatives that provide information and metrics about each key component of business operations. The Audit Committee of the Board of Directors receives periodic information security updates and reviews operational and systems-related matters to insure their implementation produce no significant internal control issues.

Operational risk exposures are managed through a combination of business line management and enterprise-wide oversight. Our Chief Operating Officer (“COO”) is responsible for all of our business operations (credit, servicing, collections, and technology). Management committees, comprised of senior managers and subject matter experts, focus on particular aspects of operational risk. Enterprise-wide oversight is conducted by a number of our internal risk management committees listed above. Most comprehensively, the Customer Products and Services Assessment Committee confirms that in connection with new, expanded, or modified products or services it recommends for approval that all significant risks are properly identified; adequate controls are in place to monitor risks to established, prudent limits; and monitoring of risk management activities, exposures, and issues are performed.

Market Risk Management

Market risk is the risk to our financial condition resulting from adverse movements in market rates or prices, such as interest rates, foreign exchange rates, credit spreads or equity prices. We are exposed to various types of market risk, in particular interest rate risk and other risks that arise through the management of our investment portfolio. Market risk exposures are managed through our internal Asset and Liability Committee. The responsibilities of this committee include: maintaining oversight and responsibility for all risks associated with managing our assets and liabilities, and recommending limits to be included in our risk appetite and investment structure. These activities are closely tied to those related to the management of our funding and liquidity risks. Consequently, the Finance and Operations Committee of the Board of Directors is also responsible for periodically reviewing and approving our investment and asset and liability management policies and contingency funding plan. The Finance and Operations Committee as well as our Chief Financial Officer report to the full Board of Directors on matters of market risk management.

 

88


Table of Contents

Political and Reputation Risk Management

Political and reputation risk is the risk that changes in laws and regulations or actions affecting impacting our reputation could affect the profitability and sustainability of our business.

Management proactively assesses and manages political and reputation risk. Our government relations team of employees manages our review and response to all formal inquiries from members of Congress, state legislators, and their staff, including providing targeted messaging that reinforces our public policy goals. We review and consider political and reputational risks on an integrated basis in connection with the risk management oversight activities conducted in the various aspects of our business on matters as diverse as the launch of new products and services, our credit underwriting activities and how we fund our operations. Our public relations, marketing and media teams constantly monitor our perception in print, electronic and social media; actively provide assistance and support to our customers and other constituencies and maintain and promote the value of our considerable corporate brand. Significant political and reputation risks are reported to and monitored by the Finance and Operations Committee of our Board of Directors. Our Legal, Government Relations and Compliance groups efforts are coordinated through our General Counsel and regularly meet and collaborate with our Media and Investor Relations teams to provide more coordinated monitoring and management of our political and reputational risks.

Credit and Counterparty Risk Management

Credit and counterparty risk is the risk of loss stemming from one party’s failure to repay a loan or otherwise meet a contractual obligation. We have credit or counterparty risk exposure with borrowers and co-borrowers with whom we have made Private Education Loans, the various counterparties with whom we have entered into derivative contracts, the various issuers with whom we make investments, and with several higher education institutions related to academic facilities loans secured by real estate. Credit and counterparty risks are overseen by our Chief Credit Officer, his staff and the internal risk management committee he chairs. Our Chief Credit Officer reports regularly to our Board of Directors, Finance and Operations and Audit Committees with respect to the various matters of which each have oversight.

The credit risk related to Private Education Loans are managed within a credit risk infrastructure which includes (i) a well-defined underwriting and collection policy framework; (ii) an ongoing monitoring and review process of portfolio segments and trends; (iii) assignment and management of credit authorities and responsibilities; and (iv) establishment of an allowance for loan losses that covers estimated losses based upon portfolio and economic analysis.

Credit and counterparty risk related to derivative contracts is managed by reviewing counterparties for credit strength on an ongoing basis and via our credit policies, which place limits on the amount of exposure we may take with any one counterparty and, in most cases, require collateral to secure the position. The credit and counterparty risk associated with derivatives is measured based on the replacement cost should the counterparties with contracts in a gain position to the Company fail to perform under the terms of the contract.

Compliance and Legal Risk Management

Compliance risk is the operational risk of legal or regulatory sanctions, financial loss or damage to reputation resulting from failure to comply with laws, regulations, rules, other regulatory requirements, or codes of conduct and other standards of self-regulatory organizations applicable to us. Legal risk arises, in part, from the potential that unenforceable contracts, lawsuits or adverse judgments can disrupt or otherwise negatively affect our operations or condition. These risks are inherent in all of our businesses. Both compliance and legal risk are sub-sets of operational risk but are recognized as a separate and complementary risk category given their importance in our business. We can be exposed to regulatory and compliance risk in key areas such as our private education lending, collections or loan servicing businesses if compliance with legal and regulatory requirements is not properly implemented, documented or tested, as well as when an oversight program does not include appropriate audit and control features.

 

89


Table of Contents

The Audit Committee of our Board of Directors has oversight over the establishment of standards related to our monitoring and control of regulatory and compliance risks and the qualification of employees overseeing these risk management functions. The Audit Committee annually approves our Corporate Compliance Plan, has responsibility for considering significant breaches of our Code of Business Conduct and receives regular reports from executive management team members responsible for the regulatory and compliance risk management functions.

Primary ownership and responsibility for regulatory and compliance risk is placed with the business segments to manage their specific regulatory and compliance risks. Our Compliance group supports these activities by providing extensive training, monitoring and testing of the processes, policies and procedures utilized by our business segments, maintaining consumer lending regulatory and information security policies and procedures, and working in close coordination with our Legal group. Our Corporate Compliance Committee serves as a regular internal forum where key compliance issues and risks are discussed and business, compliance and legal professional review testing of existing regulatory compliance procedures and approve new or revised procedures.

Our Code of Business Conduct and the on-going training our employees receive in many compliance areas provide a framework for our employees to conduct themselves with the highest integrity. We instill a risk-conscious culture through communications, training, policies and procedures. We have strengthened the linkage between the management performance process and individual compensation to encourage employees to work toward corporate-wide compliance goals.

Common Stock

The following table summarizes our common share repurchases and issuances.

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011      2010      2009  

Common stock repurchased

     19,054,115         —           —     

Average purchase price per share

   $ 15.77       $ —         $ —     

Shares repurchased related to employee stock-based compensation plans(1)

     3,024,662         1,097,647         263,640   

Average purchase price per share

   $ 15.71       $ 13.44       $ 20.29   

Authority remaining at end of period for repurchases

     —           38,841,923         38,841,923   

Common shares issued

     3,886,217         1,803,683         536,134   

 

        

(1)     Comprises shares withheld from stock option exercises and vesting of restricted stock for employees’ tax withholding obligations and shares tendered by employees to satisfy option exercise costs.

         

 

The closing price of our common stock on December 31, 2011 was $13.40.

Our shareholders have authorized the issuance of 1.125 billion shares of common stock (par value of $.20). At December 31, 2011, 509 million shares were issued and outstanding and 34.9 million shares were unissued but encumbered for outstanding stock options for employee compensation and remaining authority for stock-based compensation plans. The stock-based compensation plans are described in Note 11, “Stock-Based Compensation Plans and Arrangements.”

In March 2011, we retired 70 million shares of common stock held in treasury. This retirement decreased the balance in treasury stock by $1.9 billion, with corresponding decreases of $14 million in common stock and $1.9 billion in additional paid-in capital. There was no impact to total equity from this transaction.

During 2009, we converted $339 million of our Series C Preferred Stock to common stock. As part of this conversion, we delivered to the holders of the preferred stock: (1) approximately 17 million shares (the number

 

90


Table of Contents

of common shares they would most likely receive if the preferred stock they held mandatorily converted to common shares in the fourth quarter of 2010) plus (2) a discounted amount of the preferred stock dividends the holders of the preferred stock would have received if they held the preferred stock through the mandatory conversion date. The accounting treatment for this conversion resulted in additional dividends recorded as part of preferred stock dividends for the year of approximately $53 million.

On December 15, 2010, the mandatory conversion date, the remaining 810,370 shares of our Series C Preferred Stock were converted into 41 million shares of common stock.

Dividend and Share Repurchase Program

On June 17, 2011, September 16, 2011, and December 16, 2011, we paid a quarterly dividend of $.10 per share on our common stock, the first dividends paid since early 2007. In April 2011, we authorized the repurchase of up to $300 million of outstanding common stock in open market transactions and terminated all previous authorizations. During the second and third quarters of 2011, we repurchased 19.1 million shares for an aggregate purchase price of $300 million. With this action, we fully utilized this share repurchase authorization.

On January 26, 2012, we increased the quarterly dividend on our common stock to $.125 per share. The next such quarterly dividend will be paid on March 16, 2012. We also authorized the repurchase of up to $500 million of outstanding common stock in open market transactions.

 

91


Table of Contents
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk

Interest Rate Sensitivity Analysis

Our interest rate risk management seeks to limit the impact of short-term movements in interest rates on our results of operations and financial position. The following tables summarize the potential effect on earnings over the next 12 months and the potential effect on fair values of balance sheet assets and liabilities at December 31, 2011 and 2010, based upon a sensitivity analysis performed by management assuming a hypothetical increase in market interest rates of 100 basis points and 300 basis points while funding spreads remain constant. Additionally, as it relates to the effect on earnings, a sensitivity analysis was performed assuming the funding index increases 25 basis points while holding the asset index constant, if the funding index is different than the asset index. The earnings sensitivity is applied only to financial assets and liabilities, including hedging instruments, that existed at the balance sheet date and does not take into account new assets, liabilities or hedging instruments that may arise in 2012.

 

     As of December 31, 2011
Impact on Annual Earnings If:
    As of December 31, 2010
Impact on Annual Earnings If:
 
     Interest Rates:      Funding
Spreads
    Interest Rates:     Funding
Spreads
 

(Dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

   Increase
100 Basis
Points
     Increase
300 Basis
Points
     Increase
25 Basis
Points(1)
    Increase
100 Basis
Points
    Increase
300 Basis
Points
    Increase
25 Basis
Points(1)
 

Effect on Earnings

              

Change in pre-tax net income before unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities

   $ 3       $ 61       $ (419   $ (129   $ (140   $ (368

Unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities

     493         814         (16     131        82        (28
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase in net income before taxes

   $ 496       $ 875       $ (435   $ 2      $ (58   $ (396
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Increase in diluted earnings per common share

   $ .965       $ 1.702       $ (.846   $ .004      $ (0.110   $ (.746
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

If an asset is not funded with the same index/frequency reset of the asset then it is assumed the funding index increases 25 basis points while holding the asset index constant.

 

92


Table of Contents

 

     At December 31, 2011  
            Interest Rates:  
            Change from
Increase of
100 Basis
Points
    Change from
Increase of
300 Basis
Points
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Fair Value              $                   %                   $                   %        

Effect on Fair Values

           

Assets

           

Total FFELP Loans

   $ 134,196       $ (665     —     $ (1,335     (1 )% 

Private Education Loans

     33,968         —          —          —          —     

Other earning assets

     9,871         —          —          (1     —     

Other assets

     8,943         (639     (7     (1,420     (16 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets gain/(loss)

   $ 186,978       $ (1,304     (1 )%    $ (2,756     (1 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

           

Interest bearing liabilities

   $ 171,152       $ (730     —     $ (2,002     (1 )% 

Other liabilities

     4,128         (617     (15     (801     (19
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities (gain)/loss

   $ 175,280       $ (1,347     (1 )%    $ (2,803     (2 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     At December 31, 2010  
            Interest Rates:  
            Change from
Increase of
100 Basis
Points
    Change from
Increase of
300 Basis
Points
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Fair Value              $                   %                   $                   %        

Effect on Fair Values

           

Assets

           

Total FFELP Loans

   $ 147,163       $ (649     —     $ (1,318     (1 )% 

Private Education Loans

     30,949         —          —          —          —     

Other earning assets

     11,641         (1     —          (2     —     

Other assets

     9,449         (565     (6     (996     (11 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets gain/(loss)

   $ 199,202       $ (1,215     (1 )%    $ (2,316     (1 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

           

Interest bearing liabilities

   $ 187,959       $ (704     —     $ (1,938     (1 )% 

Other liabilities

     3,136         (217     (7     257        8   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities (gain)/loss

   $ 191,095       $ (921     —     $ (1,681     (1 )% 
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

A primary objective in our funding is to minimize our sensitivity to changing interest rates by generally funding our floating rate student loan portfolio with floating rate debt. However, due to the ability of some FFELP loans to earn Floor Income, we can have a fixed versus floating mismatch in funding if the student loan earns at the fixed borrower rate and the funding remains floating. In addition, we can have a mismatch in the index (including the frequency of reset) of floating rate debt versus floating rate assets.

During the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, certain FFELP Loans were earning Floor Income and we locked in a portion of that Floor Income through the use of Floor Income contracts. The result of these hedging transactions was to convert a portion of the fixed rate nature of student loans to variable rate, and to fix the relative spread between the student loan asset rate and the variable rate liability.

In the preceding tables, under the scenario where interest rates increase 100 and 300 basis points, the change in pre-tax net income before the unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities is primarily due to the impact of (i) our unhedged loans being in a fixed-rate mode due to Floor Income, while being funded with

 

93


Table of Contents

variable debt in low interest rate environments; and (ii) a portion of our variable assets being funded with fixed rate liabilities and equity. Item (i) will generally cause income to decrease when interest rates increase from a low interest rate environment, whereas item (ii) will generally offset this decrease. The variance in the change in pre-tax income before unrealized gains (losses) on derivatives when comparing the 2011 analysis versus the 2010 analysis was the result of the SLC acquisition at December 31, 2010. In the 2010 analysis, the assets from the acquisition that earn Floor Income were reflected in the analysis at December 31, 2010, however, the Floor Income Contracts hedging these assets were not entered into until the first half of 2011. Therefore the 2010 analysis reflects a large decrease in this line from the loss of the unhedged Floor Income as rates were increased. In the 2011 analysis, this Floor Income had been hedged and the increase in the line resulted from a portion of our variable assets being funded with fixed rate debt. The large increase in the unrealized gains on derivatives and hedging activities line in the 2011 analysis versus the 2010 analysis, primarily is due to the impact of the additional Floor Income Contracts discussed above.

Under the scenario in the tables above labeled “Asset and Funding Index Mismatches,” the main driver of the decrease in pre-tax income before unrealized gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities is the result of LIBOR-based debt funding commercial paper-indexed assets. See “Asset and Liability Funding Gap” of this Item 7A for a further discussion. Increasing the spread between indices will also impact the unrealized gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities as it relates to basis swaps that hedge the mismatch between the asset and funding indices.

In addition to interest rate risk addressed in the preceding tables, we are also exposed to risks related to foreign currency exchange rates. Foreign currency exchange risk is primarily the result of foreign currency denominated debt issued by us. When we issue foreign denominated corporate unsecured and securitization debt, our policy is to use cross currency interest rate swaps to swap all foreign currency denominated debt payments (fixed and floating) to U.S. dollar LIBOR using a fixed exchange rate. In the tables above, there would be an immaterial impact on earnings if exchange rates were to decrease or increase, due to the terms of the hedging instrument and hedged items matching. The balance sheet interest bearing liabilities would be affected by a change in exchange rates; however, the change would be materially offset by the cross currency interest rate swaps in other assets or other liabilities. In the current economic environment, volatility in the spread between spot and forward foreign exchange rates has resulted in material mark-to-market impacts to current-period earnings which have not been factored into the above analysis. The earnings impact is noncash, and at maturity of the instruments the cumulative mark-to-market impact will be zero.

Asset and Liability Funding Gap

The tables below present our assets and liabilities (funding) arranged by underlying indices as of December 31, 2011. In the following GAAP presentation, the funding gap only includes derivatives that qualify as effective hedges (those derivatives which are reflected in net interest margin, as opposed to those reflected in the “gains (losses) on derivatives and hedging activities, net” line on the consolidated statements of income). The difference between the asset and the funding is the funding gap for the specified index. This represents our exposure to interest rate risk in the form of basis risk and repricing risk, which is the risk that the different indices may reset at different frequencies or may not move in the same direction or at the same magnitude.

Management analyzes interest rate risk and in doing so includes all derivatives that are economically hedging our debt whether they qualify as effective hedges or not (“Core Earnings” basis). Accordingly, we are also presenting the asset and liability funding gap on a “Core Earnings” basis in the table that follows the GAAP presentation.

 

94


Table of Contents

GAAP-Basis

 

Index

(Dollars in billions)

   Frequency of
Variable
Resets
   Assets      Funding(2)      Funding
Gap
 

3-month Commercial paper(1)

   daily    $ 129.6       $ —         $ 129.6   

3-month Treasury bill

   weekly      7.6         —           7.6   

Prime

   annual      .7         —           .7   

Prime

   quarterly      4.9         —           4.9   

Prime

   monthly      21.8         —           21.8   

Prime

   daily      —           2.8         (2.8

PLUS Index

   annual      .5         —           .5   

3-month LIBOR

   daily      —           —           —     

3-month LIBOR

   quarterly      —           120.3         (120.3

1-month LIBOR

   monthly      9.6         16.9         (7.3

CMT/CPI Index

   monthly/quarterly      —           1.6         (1.6

Non Discrete reset(3)

   monthly      —           32.8         (32.8

Non Discrete reset(4)

   daily/weekly      9.8         3.5         6.3   

Fixed Rate(5)

        8.8         15.4         (6.6
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

      $ 193.3       $ 193.3       $ —     
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

See Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Business Segment Earnings Summary — “Core Earnings” Basis — FFELP Loans Segment — FFELP Loans Net Interest Margin” for discussion regarding Consolidated Appropriations Act of 2012 and the effect it will have on the FFELP student lender payment index in 2012.

 

 

  (2)

Funding includes all derivatives that management considers economic hedges of interest rate risk and reflects how we internally manage our interest rate exposure.

 

 

  (3)

Funding consists of auction rate securities, the ABCP Facilities, the ED Conduit Program facility and the FHLB-DM facility.

 

 

  (4)

Assets include restricted and unrestricted cash equivalents and other overnight type instruments. Funding includes retail and other deposits and the obligation to return cash collateral held related to derivatives exposures.

 

 

  (5)

Assets include receivables and other assets (including goodwill and acquired intangibles). Funding includes other liabilities and stockholders’ equity (excluding series B Preferred Stock).

 

The “Funding Gaps” in the above table are primarily interest rate mismatches in short-term indices between our assets and liabilities. We address this issue typically through the use of basis swaps that typically convert quarterly reset three-month LIBOR to other indices that are more correlated to our asset indices. These basis swaps do not qualify as effective hedges and as a result the effect on the funding index is not included in our interest margin and is therefore excluded from the GAAP presentation.

 

95


Table of Contents

“Core Earnings” Basis

 

Index

(Dollars in billions)

   Frequency of
Variable
Resets
   Assets      Funding(2)      Funding
Gap
 

3-month Commercial paper(1)

   daily    $ 129.6       $ —         $ 129.6   

3-month Treasury bill

   weekly      7.6         1.8         5.8   

Prime

   annual      .7         —           .7   

Prime

   quarterly      4.9         —           4.9   

Prime

   monthly      21.8         4.5         17.3   

Prime

   daily      —           2.8         (2.8

PLUS Index

   annual      .5         —           .5   

3-month LIBOR

   daily      —           20.2         (20.2

3-month LIBOR

   quarterly      —           79.0         (79.0

1-month LIBOR

   monthly      9.6         26.1         (16.5

1-month LIBOR

   daily      —           8.0         (8.0

Non Discrete reset(3)

   monthly      —           32.9         (32.9

Non Discrete reset(4)

   daily/weekly      9.8         3.5         6.3   

Fixed Rate(5)

        6.1         11.8         (5.7
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

      $ 190.6       $ 190.6       $ —     
     

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

See Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Business Segment Earnings Summary — “Core Earnings” Basis — FFELP Loans Segment — FFELP Loans Net Interest Margin” for discussion regarding Consolidated Appropriations Act of 2012 and the effect it will have on the FFELP student lender payment index in 2012.

 

 

  (2)

Funding includes all derivatives that management considers economic hedges of interest rate risk and reflects how we internally manage our interest rate exposure.

 

 

  (3)

Funding consists of auction rate securities, the ABCP Facilities, the ED Conduit Program facility and the FHLB-DM facility.

 

 

  (4)

Assets include restricted and unrestricted cash equivalents and other overnight type instruments. Funding includes retail and other deposits and the obligation to return cash collateral held related to derivatives exposures.

 

 

  (5)

Assets include receivables and other assets (including goodwill and acquired intangibles). Funding includes other liabilities and stockholders’ equity (excluding series B Preferred Stock).

 

We use interest rate swaps and other derivatives to achieve our risk management objectives. Our asset liability management strategy is to match assets with debt (in combination with derivatives) that have the same underlying index and reset frequency or when economical, have interest rate characteristics that we believe are highly correlated. For example, a large portion of our daily reset 3-month commercial paper indexed assets are funded with liabilities indexed to LIBOR. The use of funding with index types and reset frequencies that are different from our assets exposes us to interest rate risk in the form of basis and repricing risk. This could result in our cost of funds not moving in the same direction or with the same magnitude as the yield on our assets. While we believe this risk is low, as all of these indices are short-term with rate movements that are highly correlated over a long period of time, market disruptions can lead to a temporary divergence between indices resulting in a negative impact to our earnings.

 

96


Table of Contents

Weighted Average Life

The following table reflects the weighted average life for our earning assets and liabilities at December 31, 2011.

 

(Averages in Years)

   Weighted  Average
Life
 

Earning assets

  

Student loans

     7.6   

Other loans

     6.3   

Cash and investments

     0.1   
  

 

 

 

Total earning assets

     7.2   
  

 

 

 

Borrowings

  

Short-term borrowings

     0.3   

Long-term borrowings

     7.0   
  

 

 

 

Total borrowings

     5.9   
  

 

 

 

 

Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

Reference is made to the financial statements listed under the heading “(a) 1.A. Financial Statements” of Item 15 hereof, which financial statements are incorporated by reference in response to this Item 8.

 

Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

Nothing to report.

 

Item 9A. Controls and Procedures

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

Our management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, evaluated the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)) as of December 31, 2011. Based on this evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that, as of December 31, 2011, our disclosure controls and procedures were effective to ensure that information required to be disclosed by us in the reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is (a) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms and (b) accumulated and communicated to our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosure.

Managements’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended). Under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, we assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011. In making this assessment, our management used the criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). Management also used an IT governance framework that is based on the COSO framework, Control Objectives for Information and related Technology, which was issued by the Information Systems Audit and Control Association and the IT Governance Institute. Based on our assessment and those criteria, management concluded that, as of December 31, 2011, our internal control over financial reporting is effective.

 

97


Table of Contents

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, audited the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, as stated in their report which appears below.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

No change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) occurred during the fiscal quarter ended December 31, 2011 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

Item 9B. Other Information

Nothing to report.

 

98


Table of Contents

PART III.

 

Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

The information contained in the Proxy Statement to be filed on Schedule 14A relating to our Annual Meeting of Shareholders (the “2012 Proxy Statement”) scheduled to be held on May 24, 2012, including information appearing under “Proposal 1: Election of Directors,” “Executive Officers,” “Other Matters — Section 16(a) Beneficial Ownership Reporting Compliance,” and “Corporate Governance” in the 2012 Proxy Statement, is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 11. Executive Compensation

The information contained in the 2012 Proxy Statement, including information appearing under “Executive Compensation” and “Director Compensation” in the 2012 Proxy Statement, is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

The information contained in the 2012 Proxy Statement, including information appearing under “Equity Compensation Plan Information,” “Ownership of Common Stock” and “Ownership of Common Stock by Directors and Executive Officers” in the 2012 Proxy Statement, is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

The information contained in the 2012 Proxy Statement, including information appearing under “Other Matters — Certain Relationships and Transactions” and “Corporate Governance” in the 2012 Proxy Statement, is incorporated herein by reference.

 

Item 14. Principal Accounting Fees and Services

The information contained in the 2012 Proxy Statement, including information appearing under “Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm” and “Equity Compensation Plan Information” in the 2012 Proxy Statement, is incorporated herein by reference.

 

99


Table of Contents

PART IV.

 

Item 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules

(a)  1.  Financial Statements

A. The following consolidated financial statements of SLM Corporation and the Report of the Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm thereon are included in Item 8 above:

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-2   

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

     F-3   

Consolidated Statements of Income for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

     F-4   

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December  31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

     F-5   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

     F-8   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-9   

2.  Financial Statement Schedules

All schedules are omitted because they are not applicable or the required information is shown in the consolidated financial statements or notes thereto.

3.  Exhibits

The exhibits listed in the accompanying index to exhibits are filed or incorporated by reference as part of this Annual Report.

We will furnish at cost a copy of any exhibit filed with or incorporated by reference into this Annual Report. Oral or written requests for copies of any exhibits should be directed to the Corporate Secretary.

 

100


Table of Contents

4.  Appendices

Appendix A — Federal Family Education Loan Program

(b)  Exhibits

 

    3.1    Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-159447) filed on May 22, 2009).
    3.2    Certificate of Designation of 7.25% Mandatory Convertible Preferred Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 3, 2008).
    3.3    By-Laws of the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 21, 2011).
    4.1    Indenture, dated as of October 1, 2000, between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon, as successor to J.P. Morgan Chase Bank, National Association, formerly Chase Manhattan Bank (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on October 5, 2000).
    4.2    Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of January 16, 2003, between the registrant and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on January 17, 2003).
    4.3    Amended Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of December 17, 2004, between the Company and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on December 17, 2004).
    4.4    Second Amended Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of July 22, 2008, between the Company and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on July 25, 2008).
    4.5    Sixth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of October 15, 2008, between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on October 15, 2008).
    4.6    Medium Term Note Master Note, Series A (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on November 7, 2001).
    4.7
   Medium Term Note Master Note, Series B (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on January 28, 2003).
  10.1    Note Purchase and Security Agreement between Bluemont Funding 1; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A.; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.; Banc of America Securities LLC; J.P. Morgan Securities Inc.; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, “National Association; and Sallie Mae, Inc., dated January 15, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.40 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.2    Schedule of Contracts Substantially Identical to Exhibit 10.10 in all Material Respects: between Town Center Funding 1 LLC and Town Hall Funding I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.41 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.3*    Amendment No. 1 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Bluemont Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce Fenner Smith Incorporated, as Lead Arrangers; the Conduit Lenders, the Alternate Lenders and the LIBOR Lenders party thereto; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of January 14, 2011.

 

101


Table of Contents
  10.4*    Amendment No. 1 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Center Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce Fenner Smith Incorporated, as Lead Arrangers; the Conduit Lenders, the Alternate Lenders and the LIBOR Lenders party thereto; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of January 14, 2011.
  10.5*    Amendment No. 1 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Hall Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce Fenner Smith Incorporated, as Lead Arrangers; the Conduit Lenders, the Alternate Lenders and the LIBOR Lenders party thereto; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of January 14, 2011.
  10.6*    Amendment No. 2 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Bluemont Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A, Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of August 2, 2011.
  10.7*    Amendment No. 2 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Center Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A, Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of August 2, 2011.
  10.8*    Amendment No. 2 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Hall Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A, Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of August 2, 2011.
  10.9*    Amended and Restated Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Bluemont Funding I, as the Trust; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR Lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, as Lead Arrangers; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; and Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator, dated as of January 13, 2012.
  10.10*    Amended and Restated Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Center Funding I, as the Trust; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, as Lead Arrangers; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; and Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator, dated as of January 13, 2012.

 

102


Table of Contents
  10.11*    Amended and Restated Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Hall Funding I, as the Trust; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, as Lead Arrangers; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; and Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator, dated as of January 13, 2012.
  10.12    Affiliate Collateral Pledge and Security Agreement between SLM Education Credit Finance Corporation, HICA Education Loan Corporation and the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, dated January 15, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.13    Advances, Pledge and Security Agreement between HICA Education Loan Corporation and the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, dated January 15, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.14    Asset Purchase Agreement between The Student Loan Corporation; Citibank, N.A.; Citibank (South Dakota) National Association; SLC Student Loan Receivables I, Inc., SLM Corporation, Bull Run 1 LLC, SLM Education Credit Finance Corporation and Sallie Mae, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 8, 2010).
  10.15†    Retainer Agreement between Anthony P. Terracciano and the Company, dated January 7, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 9, 2008).
  10.16†    Amendment to Retainer Agreement Anthony Terracciano and the Company, dated December 24, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.17†    Second Amendment to Retainer Agreement between Anthony P. Terracciano and the Company, dated September 23, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.44 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.18†    Employment Agreement between John F. Remondi and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2008).
  10.19†    Employment Agreement between Joseph DePaulo and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 6, 2010).
  10.20†    Employment Agreement between Laurent C. Lutz and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.47 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.21†    Confidential Agreement and Release of John (Jack) Hewes (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.48 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.22†    Form of SLM Corporation Executive Severance Plan for Senior Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 4, 2011).
  10.23†    Form of SLM Corporation Change in Control Severance Plan for Senior Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 4, 2011).
  10.24†*    Form of Director’s Indemnification Agreement.
  10.25†*    Sallie Mae 401(k) Savings Plan.
  10.26†*    Amendment Number One to the Sallie Mae 401(k) Savings Plan.
  10.27†*    Amendment Number Two to the Sallie Mae 401(k) Savings Plan.
  10.28†    Sallie Mae Supplemental 401(k) Savings Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).

 

103


Table of Contents
  10.29†    Sallie Mae Deferred Compensation Plan for Key Employees Restatement Effective January 1, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.30†*    SLM Corporation Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors.
  10.31†    Sallie Mae Supplemental Cash Account Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.32†    Sallie Mae Employee Stock Purchase Plan, Amended and Restated as of February 15, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 5, 2011).
  10.33†    SLM Holding Corporation Directors Stock Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit A of the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (file no. 001-13251), as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 10, 1998).
  10.34†    SLM Holding Corporation Management Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit B of the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (file no. 001-13251), as filed on April 10, 1998).
  10.35†    Form of Stock Option Agreement, SLM Corporation Incentive Plan, ISO, Price-Vested with Replacements 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q (file no. 001-13251) filed on November 9, 2004).
  10.36†    Form of Stock Option Agreement, SLM Corporation Incentive Plan, Non-Qualified, Price-Vested Options-2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q (file no. 001-13251) filed on November 9, 2004).
  10.37†    Amended and Restated SLM Corporation Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (file no. 001-13251) filed on May 25, 2005).
  10.38†    Director’s Stock Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (file no. 001-13251) filed on May 25, 2005).
  10.39†    Form of Stock Option Agreement SLM Corporation Incentive Plan Net-Settled, Price-Vested Options — 1 year minimum — 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K (file no. 001-13251) filed on March 9, 2006).
  10.40†    Form of SLM Corporation Incentive Stock Plan Stock Option Agreement, Net-Settled, Performance Vested Options, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.41†    Form of SLM Corporation Incentive Plan Performance Stock Term Sheet, “Core Earnings” Net Income Target-Sustained Performance, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.42†    SLM Corporation Directors Equity Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-159447) filed on May 22, 2009).
  10.43†    SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-159447) filed on May 22, 2009).
  10.44†    Form of SLM Corporation Directors Equity Plan Non-Employee Director Restricted Stock Agreement 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 5, 2009).
  10.45†    Form of SLM Corporation Directors Equity Plan Non-Employee Director Stock Option Agreement 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 5, 2009).

 

104


Table of Contents
  10.46†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Stock Option Agreement, Net Settled, Time Vested Options – 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10. 7 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 6, 2010).
  10.47†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Performance Stock Award Term Sheet, Time Vested – 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 6, 2010).
  10.48†    Amendment to Stock Option and Restricted/Performance Stock Terms (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.49 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.49†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Stock Option Agreement, Net Settled, Time Vested Options – 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.50 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.50†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Restricted Stock and Restricted Stock Unit Term Sheet, Time Vested – 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.51 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  12.1*    Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
  16.1    Letter from PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP to the Securities and Exchange Commission, dated December 6, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 16.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 6, 2011).
  21.1*    List of Subsidiaries.
  23*    Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP.
  31.1*    Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
  31.2*    Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
  32.1*    Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
  32.2*    Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
101.INS    XBRL Instance Document.
101.SCH    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document.
101.CAL    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.
101.DEF    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document.
101.LAB    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document.
101.PRE    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document.

 

Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Arrangement

 

*

Filed herewith

 

105


Table of Contents

SIGNATURES

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned hereunto duly authorized.

Dated: February 27, 2012

SLM CORPORATION
By:   /S/ ALBERT L. LORD
 

Albert L. Lord

Vice Chairman and Chief Executive Officer

Pursuant to the requirement of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

 

Signature

  

Title

 

Date

/S/ ALBERT L. LORD

Albert L. Lord

   Vice Chairman and Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)   February 27, 2012

/S/ JONATHAN C. CLARK

Jonathan C. Clark

   Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial and Accounting Officer)   February 27, 2012

/S/ ANTHONY P. TERRACCIANO

Anthony P. Terracciano

   Chairman of the Board of Directors   February 27, 2012

/S/ ANN TORRE BATES

Ann Torre Bates

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ WILLIAM M. DIEFENDERFER, III

William M. Diefenderfer, III

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ DIANE SUITT GILLELAND

Diane Suitt Gilleland

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ EARL A. GOODE

Earl A. Goode

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ RONALD F. HUNT

Ronald F. Hunt

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ MICHAEL E. MARTIN

Michael E. Martin

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ BARRY A. MUNITZ

Barry A. Munitz

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ HOWARD H. NEWMAN

Howard H. Newman

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ A. ALEXANDER PORTER, JR.

A. Alexander Porter, Jr.

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ FRANK C. PULEO

Frank C. Puleo

   Director   February 27, 2012

 

106


Table of Contents

Signature

  

Title

 

Date

/S/ WOLFGANG SCHOELLKOPF

Wolfgang Schoellkopf

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ STEVEN L. SHAPIRO

Steven L. Shapiro

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ J. TERRY STRANGE

J. Terry Strange

   Director   February 27, 2012

/S/ BARRY L. WILLIAMS

Barry L. Williams

   Director   February 27, 2012

 

107


Table of Contents

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

INDEX

 

     Page  

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-2   

Consolidated Balance Sheets

     F-3   

Consolidated Statements of Income

     F-4   

Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity

     F-5   

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

     F-8   

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

     F-9   

 

F-1


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Stockholders of SLM Corporation:

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated financial statements listed in the index present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of SLM Corporation and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company changed the manner in which it accounts for transfers and servicing of financial assets and consolidations of variable interest entities in 2010.

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
McLean, VA
February 27, 2012

 

F-2


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS

(In millions, except per share amounts)

 

     December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
 

Assets

    

FFELP Loans (net of allowance for losses of $187 and $189, respectively)

   $ 138,130      $ 148,649   

Private Education Loans (net of allowance for losses of $2,171 and $2,022 respectively)

     36,290        35,656   

Investments

    

Available-for-sale

     70        83   

Other

     1,052        873   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total investments

     1,122        956   

Cash and cash equivalents

     2,794        4,343   

Restricted cash and investments

     5,873        6,255   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets, net

     478        478   

Other assets

     8,658        8,970   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 193,345      $ 205,307   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities

    

Short-term borrowings

   $ 29,573      $ 33,616   

Long-term borrowings

     154,393        163,543   

Other liabilities

     4,128        3,136   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities

     188,094        200,295   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies

    

Equity

    

Preferred stock, par value $.20 per share, 20 million shares authorized

    

Series A: 3.3 million and 3.3 million shares issued, respectively, at stated value of $50 per share

     165        165   

Series B: 4 million and 4 million shares issued, respectively, at stated value of $100 per share

     400        400   

Common stock, par value $.20 per share, 1.125 billion shares authorized: 529 million and 595 million shares issued, respectively

     106        119   

Additional paid-in capital

     4,136        5,940   

Accumulated other comprehensive loss (net of tax benefit of $8 and $26, respectively)

     (14     (45

Retained earnings

     770        309   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total SLM Corporation stockholders’ equity before treasury stock

     5,563        6,888   

Less: Common stock held in treasury at cost: 20 million and 68 million shares, respectively

     320        1,876   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total SLM Corporation stockholders’ equity

     5,243        5,012   

Noncontrolling interest

     8          
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total equity

     5,251        5,012   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total liabilities and equity

   $ 193,345      $ 205,307   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Supplemental information — assets and liabilities of consolidated variable interest entities:

 

     December 31,
2011
     December 31,
2010
 

FFELP Loans

   $ 135,536       $ 145,750   

Private Education Loans

     24,962         24,355   

Restricted cash and investments

     5,609         5,983   

Other assets

     2,638         3,706   

Short-term borrowings

     21,313         24,484   

Long-term borrowings

     134,533         142,244   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net assets of consolidated variable interest entities

   $ 12,899       $ 13,066   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-3


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF INCOME

(In millions, except per share amounts)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

Interest income:

      

FFELP Loans

   $ 3,461      $ 3,345      $ 3,094   

Private Education Loans

     2,429        2,353        1,582   

Other loans

     21        30        56   

Cash and investments

     19        26        26   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

     5,930        5,754        4,758   

Total interest expense

     2,401        2,275        3,035   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income

     3,529        3,479        1,723   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     1,295        1,419        1,119   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

     2,234        2,060        604   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Other income (loss):

      

Securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue

                   295   

Gains (losses) on loans and investments, net

     (35     325        284   

Losses on derivative and hedging activities, net

     (959     (361     (604

Servicing revenue

     381        405        440   

Contingency revenue

     333        330        294   

Gains on debt repurchases

     38        317        536   

Other

     68        6        88   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income (loss)

     (174     1,022        1,333   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Expenses:

      

Salaries and benefits

     521        561        540   

Other operating expenses

     579        647        503   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total operating expenses

     1,100        1,208        1,043   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization expense

     24        699        76   

Restructuring expenses

     9        85        10   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

     1,133        1,992        1,129   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from continuing operations, before income tax expense

     927        1,090        808   

Income tax expense

     328        493        264   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income from continuing operations

     599        597        544   

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of tax expense (benefit)

     33        (67     (220
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income

     632        530        324   

Less: net loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

     (1              
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to SLM Corporation

     633        530        324   

Preferred stock dividends

     18        72        146   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to SLM Corporation common stock

   $ 615      $ 458      $ 178   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

      

Continuing operations

   $ 1.13      $ 1.08      $ .85   

Discontinued operations

     .06        (.14     (.47
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.19      $ .94      $ .38   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average common shares outstanding

     517        487        471   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

      

Continuing operations

   $ 1.12      $ 1.08      $ .85   

Discontinued operations

     .06        (.14     (.47
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.18      $ .94      $ .38   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Average common and common equivalent shares outstanding

     523        488        472   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dividends per common share attributable to SLM Corporation

   $ .30      $      $   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-4


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

(In millions, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Preferred
Stock
Shares
    Common Stock Shares     Preferred
Stock
    Common
Stock
     Additional
Paid-In
Capital
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
    Retained
Earnings
    Treasury
Stock
    Total
Stockholders’
Equity
    Noncontrolling
Interest
    Total
Equity
 
                         
                         
       Issued      Treasury     Outstanding                     

Balance at December 31, 2008

     8,449,770        534,411,271         (66,958,400     467,452,871      $ 1,714      $ 108       $ 4,684      $ (77   $ 426      $ (1,856   $ 4,999      $ 7      $ 5,006   

Comprehensive income:

                            

Net income (loss)

                       324          324          324   

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

                            

Change in unrealized gains (losses) on investments, net of tax

                     3            3          3   

Change in unrealized gains (losses) on derivatives, net of tax

                     40            40          40   

Defined benefit pension plans adjustment

                     (7         (7       (7
                        

 

 

     

 

 

 

Comprehensive income (loss)

                           360          360   

Cash dividends:

                            

Preferred stock, series A ($3.49 per share)

                       (11       (11       (11

Preferred stock, series B ($1.76 per share)

                       (7       (7       (7

Preferred stock, series C ($72.50 per share)

                       (97       (97       (97

Issuance of common shares

       536,036         98        536,134             3              3          3   

Preferred stock issuance costs and related amortization

                   1          (1                  

Conversion of preferred shares

     (339,400     17,272,269           17,272,269        (339     3         366          (30                  

Tax benefit related to employee stock-based compensation plans

                   (9           (9       (9

Stock-based compensation expense

                   47              47          47   

Shares repurchased related to employee stock-based compensation plans

          (263,640     (263,640                (6     (6       (6

Sale of international Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business

                                  (7     (7
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2009

     8,110,370        552,219,576         (67,221,942     484,997,634      $ 1,375      $ 111       $ 5,092      $ (41   $ 604      $ (1,862   $ 5,279      $      $ 5,279   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

(In millions, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Preferred
Stock
Shares
    Common Stock Shares     Preferred
Stock
    Common
Stock
     Additional
Paid-In
Capital
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
    Retained
Earnings
    Treasury
Stock
    Total
Stockholders’
Equity
    Noncontrolling
Interest
     Total
Equity
 
                          
                          
       Issued      Treasury     Outstanding                      

Balance at December 31, 2009

     8,110,370        552,219,576         (67,221,942     484,997,634      $ 1,375      $ 111       $ 5,092      $ (41   $ 604      $ (1,862   $ 5,279      $
 
 
  
  
   $ 5,279   

Comprehensive income:

                             

Net income

                       530          530           530   

Other comprehensive income, net of tax:

                             

Change in unrealized gains (losses) on investments, net of tax

                     1            1           1   

Change in unrealized gains (losses) on derivatives, net of tax

                     5            5           5   

Defined benefit pension plans adjustment

                     (10         (10        (10
                        

 

 

      

 

 

 

Comprehensive income

                           526           526   

Cash dividends:

                             

Preferred stock, series A ($3.49 per share)

                       (12       (12        (12

Preferred stock, series B ($1.05 per share)

                       (4       (4        (4

Preferred stock, series C ($72.50 per share)

                       (56       (56        (56

Issuance of common shares

       1,803,683           1,803,683             16              16           16   

Conversion of preferred shares

     (810,370     41,240,215           41,240,215        (810     8         802                          

Tax benefit related to employee stock-based compensation plans

                   (9           (9        (9

Stock-based compensation expense

                   39              39           39   

Cumulative effect of accounting change

                       (753       (753        (753

Shares repurchased related to employee stock-based compensation plans

          (1,097,647     (1,097,647                (14     (14             (14
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2010

     7,300,000        595,263,474         (68,319,589     526,943,885      $ 565      $ 119       $ 5,940      $ (45   $ 309      $ (1,876   $ 5,012      $
 
 
  
  
   $ 5,012   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

(In millions, except share and per share amounts)

 

     Preferred
Stock
Shares
     Common Stock Shares     Preferred
Stock
     Common
Stock
    Additional
Paid-In
Capital
    Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
    Retained
Earnings
    Treasury
Stock
    Total
Stockholders’
Equity
    Noncontrolling
Interest
    Total
Equity
 
                          
                          
        Issued     Treasury     Outstanding                     

Balance at December 31, 2010

     7,300,000         595,263,474        (68,319,589     526,943,885      $ 565       $ 119      $ 5,940      $ (45   $ 309      $ (1,876   $ 5,012      $      $ 5,012   

Comprehensive income:

                            

Net income

                       633          633        (1     632   

Other comprehensive income, net of tax:

                            

Change in unrealized gains (losses) on investments, net of tax

                     2            2          2   

Change in unrealized gains (losses) on derivatives, net of tax

                     31            31          31   

Defined benefit pension plans adjustment

                     (2         (2       (2
                        

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Comprehensive income

                           664        (1     663   

Cash dividends:

                            

Common stock ($.30 per share)

                       (154       (154       (154

Preferred stock, series A ($3.49 per share)

                       (12       (12       (12

Preferred stock, series B ($1.59 per share)

                       (6       (6       (6

Issuance of common shares

        3,886,217          3,886,217           1        40              41          41   

Retirement of common stock in treasury

        (70,074,369     70,074,369                  (14     (1,890         1,904                   

Tax benefit related to employee stock-based compensation plans

                   (10           (10       (10

Stock-based compensation expense

                   56              56          56   

Common stock repurchased

          (19,054,115     (19,054,115                (300     (300       (300

Shares repurchased related to employee stock-based compensation plans

          (3,024,662     (3,024,662                (48     (48       (48

Acquisition of noncontrolling interest

                                  9        9   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2011

     7,300,000         529,075,322        (20,323,997     508,751,325      $ 565       $ 106      $ 4,136      $ (14   $ 770      $ (320   $ 5,243      $ 8      $ 5,251   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS

(In millions)

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

Operating activities

      

Net income attributable to SLM Corporation

   $ 633      $ 530      $ 324   

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:

      

(Income) loss from discontinued operations, net of tax

     (33     67        220   

(Gains) losses on loans and investments, net

     35        (6     1   

(Gains) on debt repurchases

     (38     (317     (536

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization expense

     24        699        76   

Stock-based compensation cost

     56        40        51   

Unrealized (gains)/losses on derivative and hedging activities

     145        (478     324   

Provisions for loan losses

     1,295        1,419        1,119   

Student loans originated for sale, net

            (9,648     (19,100

Decrease (increase) in restricted cash — other

     15        (2     40   

Decrease (increase) in accrued interest receivable

     463        (4     894   

Increase (decrease) in accrued interest payable

     75        (77     (517

Adjustment for non-cash loss related to Retained Interest

                   330   

Decrease in other assets

     423        1,206        375   

(Decrease) in other liabilities

     (12     (121     (30
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by (used in) operating activities — continuing operations

     3,081        (6,692     (16,429
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by operating activities — discontinued operations

                   515   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net cash provided by (used in) operating activities

     3,081        (6,692     (15,914
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Investing activities

      

Student loans acquired

     (3,888     (4,611     (5,973

Loans purchased from securitized trusts

                   (6

Reduction of student loans:

      

Installment payments, claims and other

     12,290        9,812        7,319   

Proceeds from sales of student loans

     753        588        788   

Other investing activities, net

     (210     (96     (419

Purchases of available-for-sale securities

     (142     (38,303     (128,478

Proceeds from maturities of available-for-sale securities

     193        39,465        128,052   

Purchases of held-to-maturity and other securities

     (277     (142     (1

Proceeds from maturities of held-to-maturity securities and other securities

     265        136        79   

Decrease (increase) in restricted cash — variable interest entities

     376        426        (1,180
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by investing activities — continuing operations

     9,360        7,275        181   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash provided by investing activities — discontinued operations

     114        139        130   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total net cash provided by investing activities

     9,474        7,414        311   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activities

      

Borrowings collateralized by loans in trust — issued

     4,553        5,917        12,998   

Borrowings collateralized by loans in trust — repaid

     (13,408     (10,636     (5,690

Asset-backed commercial paper conduits, net

     887        (2,060     (16,138

ED Participation Program, net

            11,252        19,302   

ED Conduit Program facility, net

     (3,172     664        14,314   

Other short-term borrowings issued

     239               298   

Other short-term borrowings repaid

     (38     (168     (1,435

Other long-term borrowings issued

     2,354        1,464        4,333   

Other long-term borrowings repaid

     (6,498     (9,955     (9,504

Other financing activities, net

     696        (21     (955

Retail and other deposits, net

     754        1,166        204   

Other

     1               (8

Common stock repurchased

     (300              

Common stock dividends paid

     (154              

Preferred dividends paid

     (18     (72     (116
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net cash (used in) provided by financing activities

     (14,104     (2,449     17,603   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net (decrease) increase in cash and cash equivalents

     (1,549     (1,727     2,000   

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     4,343        6,070        4,070   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

   $ 2,794      $ 4,343      $ 6,070   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Cash disbursements made (refunds received) for:

      

Interest

   $ 2,413      $ 2,372      $ 3,657   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income taxes paid

   $ 559      $ 200      $ 328   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income taxes (received)

   $ (37   $ (628   $ (30
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Noncash activity:

      

Investing activity — Student loans and other assets acquired

   $ 783      $ 25,638      $   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating activity — Other assets acquired and other liabilities assumed, net

   $ 19      $ 376      $   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Financing activity — Borrowings assumed in acquisition of student loans and other assets

   $ 802      $ 26,014      $   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements.

 

F-8


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

1. Organization and Business

SLM Corporation (“we”, “us”, “our”, or the “Company”) is a holding company that operates through a number of subsidiaries. We were formed in 1972 as the Student Loan Marketing Association, a federally chartered government-sponsored enterprise (the “GSE”), with the goal of furthering access to higher education by acting as a secondary market for federal student loans. In 2004, we completed our transformation to a private company through our wind-down of the GSE. The GSE’s outstanding obligations were placed into a Master Defeasance Trust Agreement as of December 29, 2004, which was fully collateralized by direct, noncallable obligations of the United States.

We provide Private Education Loans that help students and their families bridge the gap between family resources, federal loans, grants, student aid, scholarships and the cost of a college education. We also provide savings products to help save for a college education. In addition we provide servicing and collection services on federal loans. We also offer servicing, collection and transaction support directly to colleges and universities in addition to the saving for college industry. Finally, we are the largest private owner of Federal Family Education Loan Program (“FFELP”) Loans.

On March 30, 2010, President Obama signed into law H.R. 4872, the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010 (“HCERA”), which included the SAFRA Act. Effective July 1, 2010, legislation eliminated the authority to originate new loans under FFELP and required that all new federal loans be made through the Direct Student Loan Program (“DSLP”). Consequently, we no longer originate FFELP Loans. Net interest income from our FFELP Loan portfolio and fees associated with servicing FFELP Loans and collecting on delinquent and defaulted FFELP Loans on behalf of Guarantors has been our largest source of income. The law does not alter or affect the terms and conditions of existing FFELP Loans.

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies

Use of Estimates

Our financial reporting and accounting policies conform to generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“GAAP”). The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Key accounting policies that include significant judgments and estimates include the allowance for loan losses, the effective interest rate method (amortization of student loan and debt premiums and discounts), fair value measurements, goodwill and acquired intangible asset impairment assessments, and derivative accounting.

Consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of SLM Corporation and its majority-owned and controlled subsidiaries and those Variable Interest Entities (“VIEs”) for which we are the primary beneficiary, after eliminating the effects of intercompany accounts and transactions.

On January 1, 2010, we adopted the new consolidation accounting guidance. Under the new consolidation accounting guidance, if an entity has a variable interest in a VIE and that entity is determined to be the primary beneficiary of the VIE then that entity will consolidate the VIE. The primary beneficiary is the entity which has both: (1) the power to direct the activities of the VIE that most significantly impact the VIE’s economic performance and (2) the obligation to absorb losses or receive benefits of the entity that could potentially be significant to the VIE. As it relates to our securitized assets, we are the servicer of the securitized assets and own the Residual Interest of the securitization trusts. As a result, we are the primary beneficiary of our securitization trusts and consolidated those trusts that were previously off-balance sheet at their historical cost basis on

 

F-9


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

January 1, 2010. The historical cost basis is the basis that would exist if these securitization trusts had remained on-balance sheet since they settled. The new guidance did not change the accounting of any other VIEs in which we had a variable interest as of January 1, 2010.

After the adoption of the new accounting guidance, our results of operations no longer reflect securitization, servicing and Residual Interest revenue related to these securitization trusts, but instead report interest income, provisions for loan losses associated with the securitized assets and interest expense associated with the debt issued from the securitization trusts to third parties, consistent with our accounting treatment of prior on-balance sheet securitization trusts.

The following table summarizes the change in the consolidated balance sheet resulting from the consolidation of the off-balance sheet securitization trusts upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance.

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   At January  1,
2010
 

FFELP Stafford Loans (net of allowance of $15)

   $ 5,500   

FFELP Consolidation Loans (net of allowance of $10)

     14,797   

Private Education Loans (net of allowance of $524)

     12,341   
  

 

 

 

Total student loans

     32,638   

Restricted cash and investments

     1,041   

Other assets

     1,370   
  

 

 

 

Total assets consolidated

     35,049   
  

 

 

 

Long-term borrowings

     34,403   

Other liabilities

     6   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities consolidated

     34,409   
  

 

 

 

Net assets consolidated on balance sheet

     640   

Less: Residual Interest removed from balance sheet

     1,828   
  

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of accounting change before taxes

     (1,188
  

 

 

 

Tax effect

     434   
  

 

 

 

Cumulative effect of accounting change after taxes recorded to retained earnings

   $ (754
  

 

 

 

Fair Value Measurement

We use estimates of fair value in applying various accounting standards for our financial statements. Fair value measurements are used in one of four ways:

 

   

In the consolidated balance sheet with changes in fair value recorded in the consolidated statement of income;

 

   

In the consolidated balance sheet with changes in fair value recorded in the accumulated other comprehensive income section of the consolidated statement of changes in stockholders’ equity;

 

   

In the consolidated balance sheet for instruments carried at lower of cost or fair value with impairment charges recorded in the consolidated statement of income; and

 

   

In the notes to the financial statements.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

Fair value is defined as the price to sell an asset or transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between willing and able market participants. In general, our policy in estimating fair values is to first look at observable market prices for identical assets and liabilities in active markets, where available. When these are not available, other inputs are used to model fair value such as prices of similar instruments, yield curves, volatilities, prepayment speeds, default rates and credit spreads (including for our liabilities), relying first on observable data from active markets. Depending on current market conditions, additional adjustments to fair value may be based on factors such as liquidity, credit, and bid/offer spreads. Transaction costs are not included in the determination of fair value. When possible, we seek to validate the model’s output to market transactions. Depending on the availability of observable inputs and prices, different valuation models could produce materially different fair value estimates. The values presented may not represent future fair values and may not be realizable.

We categorize our fair value estimates based on a hierarchical framework associated with three levels of price transparency utilized in measuring financial instruments at fair value. Classification is based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value of the instrument. The three levels are as follows:

 

   

Level 1 — Quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that we have the ability to access at the measurement date. The types of financial instruments included in level 1 are highly liquid instruments with quoted prices.

 

   

Level 2 — Inputs from active markets, other than quoted prices for identical instruments, are used to determine fair value. Significant inputs are directly observable from active markets for substantially the full term of the asset or liability being valued.

 

   

Level 3 — Pricing inputs significant to the valuation are unobservable. Inputs are developed based on the best information available. However, significant judgment is required by us in developing the inputs.

Loans

Loans, consisting primarily of federally insured student loans and Private Education Loans, that we have the ability and intent to hold for the foreseeable future are classified as held for investment and are carried at amortized cost. Amortized cost includes the unamortized premiums, discounts, and capitalized origination costs and fees, all of which are amortized to interest income as further discussed below. Loans which are held-for-investment also have an allowance for loan loss as needed. Any loans we have not classified as held-for-investment are classified as held-for-sale, and carried at the lower of cost or fair value. Loans are classified as held-for-sale when we have the intent and ability to sell such loans. Loans which are held-for-sale do not have the associated premium, discount, and capitalized origination costs and fees amortized into interest income. In addition, once a loan is classified as held-for-sale, there is no further adjustment to the loan’s allowance for loan loss that existed immediately prior to the reclassification to held-for-sale.

As market conditions permit, we may securitize loans as a source of financing for those loans. If we elect to use a securitization program to finance loans, loans are selected based on the required characteristics to structure the desired transaction at the most favorable financing terms (e.g., type of loan, mix of interim vs. repayment status, credit rating and maturity dates). Due to some of the structuring terms, certain transactions may qualify for sale treatment while others do not qualify for sale treatment and are recorded as financings.

All of our student loans, except for those which were sold under the U.S. Department of Education’s (“ED’s”) Purchase Program, as defined and discussed below, are initially categorized as held-for-investment until there is certainty as to each specific loan’s ultimate financing because we do not securitize all loans and currently all of our securitizations do not qualify for sales treatment. It is only when we have selected the loans to

 

F-11


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

securitize and that securitization transaction qualifies as a sale do we transfer the loans into the held-for-sale classification and carry them at the lower of cost or fair value. If we anticipate recognizing a gain related to the impending securitization, then the fair value of the loans is higher than their respective cost basis and no valuation allowance is recorded.

Under The Ensuring Continued Access to Student Loans Act of 2008 (“ECASLA”), ED implemented the Loan Purchase Commitment Program (the “Purchase Program”) and Loan Participation Purchase Program (the “Participation Program”). Under the Purchase Program, ED agreed to purchase eligible FFELP Loans at a set price by September 30, 2010 at our option. Because we had the intent to sell such loans to ED we classified all loans eligible to be sold to ED under the Purchase Program as held-for-sale. These loans were included in the “FFELP Stafford Held-for-Sale Loans” line on our consolidated balance sheets.

Student Loan Income

For loans classified as held-for-investment, we recognize student loan interest income as earned, adjusted for the amortization of premiums and capitalized direct origination costs, accretion of discounts, and Repayment Borrower Benefits. These adjustments result in income being recognized based upon the expected yield of the loan over its life after giving effect to prepayments and extensions, and to estimates related to Repayment Borrower Benefits. The estimate of the prepayment speed includes the effect of consolidations, voluntary prepayments and student loan defaults, all of which shorten the life-of-loan. Prepayment speed estimates also consider the utilization of deferment, forbearance and extended repayment plans which lengthen the life-of-loan. For Repayment Borrower Benefits, the estimates of their effect on student loan yield are based on analyses of historical payment behavior of borrowers who are eligible for the incentives and its effect on the ultimate qualification rate for these incentives. If our expectation is that the utilization of Repayment Borrower Benefits was to increase in future periods, it would reduce our current student loan yield. We regularly evaluate the assumptions used to estimate the prepayment speeds and the qualification rates used for Repayment Borrower Benefits. In instances where there are changes to the assumptions, amortization is adjusted on a cumulative basis to reflect the change since the acquisition of the loan. We also pay an annual 105 basis point Consolidation Loan Rebate Fee on FFELP Consolidation Loans which is netted against student loan interest income. Additionally, interest earned on student loans reflects potential non-payment adjustments in accordance with our uncollectible interest recognition policy as discussed further in “Allowance for Loan Losses” of this Note 2. We do not amortize any premiums, discounts or other adjustments to the basis of student loans when they are classified as held-for-sale.

Allowance for Loan Losses

We consider a loan to be impaired when, based on current information, a loss has been incurred and it is probable that we will not receive all contractual amounts due. When making our assessment as to whether a loan is impaired, we also take into account more than insignificant delays in payment. We generally evaluate impaired loans on an aggregate basis by grouping similar loans. Impaired loans also include those loans which are individually assessed and measured for impairment, such as in a troubled debt restructuring. We maintain an allowance for loan losses at an amount sufficient to absorb losses incurred in our portfolios at the reporting date based on a projection of estimated probable credit losses incurred in the portfolio.

In determining the allowance for loan losses, we estimate the principal amount of loans that will default over the next two years (two years being the expected period between a loss event and default) and how much we expect to recover over time related to the defaulted amount. Our historical experience indicates that, on average, the time between the date that a borrower experiences a default causing event (i.e., the loss trigger event) and the date that we charge off the unrecoverable portion of that loan is two years. Additionally we estimate an allowance amount sufficient to cover life-of-loan expected losses for loans classified as a troubled debt

 

F-12


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

restructuring (see “Allowance for Private Education Loan Losses” to this Note 2). We start with historical experience of customer default behavior. We make judgments about which historical period to start with and then make further judgments about whether that historical experience is representative of future expectations and whether additional adjustment may be needed to those historical default rates. We also take the economic environment into consideration when calculating the allowance for loan loss. We analyze key economic statistics and the effect we expect it to have on future defaults. Key economic statistics analyzed as part of the allowance for loan loss are unemployment rates (total and specific to college graduates) and other asset type delinquency rates (e.g., credit cards and mortgages). Significantly more judgment has been required over the last several years, compared with years prior, in light of the recent downturn in the U.S. economy and high levels of unemployment and its effect on our customer’s ability to pay their obligations.

We estimate the allowance for loan losses for our loan portfolio using an analysis of delinquent and current accounts. Our model is used to estimate the likelihood that a loan receivable may progress through the various delinquency stages and ultimately charge off. The evaluation of the allowance for loan losses is inherently subjective, as it requires material estimates that may be susceptible to significant changes. Our default estimates are based on a loss confirmation period of two years (i.e., our allowance for loan loss covers the next two years of expected charge-offs). The two-year estimate for the allowance for loan losses is subject to a number of assumptions. If actual future performance in delinquency, charge-offs and recoveries are significantly different than estimated, this could materially affect our estimate of the allowance for loan losses and the related provision for loan losses on our income statement.

Below we describe in further detail our policies and procedures for the allowance for loan losses as they relate to our Private Education Loan and FFELP Loan portfolios.

Allowance for Private Education Loan Losses

We determine the collectability of our Private Education Loan portfolio by evaluating certain risk characteristics. We consider school type, credit score, existence of a cosigner, loan status and loan seasoning as the key credit quality indicators because they have the most significant effect on our determination of the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses. The type of school borrowers attend can have an impact on their job prospects after graduation and therefore affects their ability to make payments. Credit scores are an indicator of the credit worthiness of a borrower and the higher the credit score the more likely it is the borrower will be able to make all of their contractual payments. Loan status affects the credit risk because a past due loan is more likely to result in a credit loss than an up-to-date loan. Additionally, loans in a deferred payment status have different credit risk profiles compared with those in current pay status. Loan seasoning affects credit risk because a loan with a history of making payments generally has a lower incidence of default than a loan with a history of making infrequent or no payments. The existence of a cosigner lowers the likelihood of default. We monitor and update these credit quality indicators in the analysis of the adequacy of our allowance for loan losses on a quarterly basis.

To estimate the probable credit losses incurred in the loan portfolio at the reporting date, we use historical experience of borrower payment behavior in connection with the key credit quality indicators and incorporate management expectation regarding macroeconomic and collection procedure factors. Similar to estimating defaults, we use historical borrower payment behavior to estimate the timing and amount of future recoveries on charged-off loans. We use judgment in determining whether historical performance is representative of what we expect to collect in the future. We then apply the default and collection rate projections to each category of loans. Once the quantitative calculation is performed, we review the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses and determine if qualitative adjustments need to be considered. Additionally, we consider changes in laws and regulations that could potentially impact the allowance for loan losses.

 

F-13


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

Similar to the rules governing FFELP payment requirements, our collection policies allow for periods of nonpayment for borrowers requesting additional payment grace periods upon leaving school or experiencing temporary difficulty meeting payment obligations. This is referred to as forbearance status and is considered separately in our allowance for loan losses. The loss confirmation period is in alignment with our typical collection cycle and takes into account these periods of nonpayment.

In the first quarter of 2011, we implemented a new model to estimate the Private Education Loan default amount. Both the prior model and new model are considered “migration models”. Our prior allowance model (in place through December 31, 2010) segmented the portfolio into categories of similar risk characteristics of which we consider school type, credit scores, existence of a cosigner, loan status and loan seasoning as the key credit quality indicators. Our new model uses these credit quality indicators, but incorporates a more granular segmentation of seasoning data into the calculation. Another change in the new allowance model relates to the historical period of experience that we use as a starting point for projecting future defaults. Our new model is based upon a seasonal average, adjusted to the most recent three to six months of actual collection experience as the starting point and applies expected macroeconomic changes and collection procedure changes to estimate expected losses caused by loss events incurred as of the balance sheet date. Our previous model primarily used a one-year historical default experience period and incorporated the estimated impact of macroeconomic factors and collection procedure changes on a qualitative basis. Our current model places a greater emphasis on the more recent default experience rather than the default experience for older historical periods, as we believe the recent default experience is more indicative of the probable losses incurred in the loan portfolio today. While we incorporated the new model in the first quarter of 2011, the overall process for calculating the appropriate amount of allowance for Private Education Loan loss did not change. Significantly more judgment has been required over the last several years, compared with years prior, in light of the U.S. economy and its effect on our customers’ ability to pay their obligations. We believe that the current model more accurately reflects recent borrower behavior, loan performance and collection performance, as well as expectations about economic factors. There was no adjustment to our allowance for loan losses upon implementing this new default projection model in the first quarter of 2011.

On July 1, 2011, we adopted new guidance that clarified when a loan restructuring constitutes a troubled debt restructuring (“TDR”). In applying the new guidance we determined that certain Private Education Loans for which we granted forbearance of greater than three months are classified as troubled debt restructurings. If a loan meets the criteria for troubled debt accounting then an allowance for loan loss is established which represents the present value of the losses that are expected to occur over the remaining life of the loan. This accounting results in a higher allowance for loan losses than our previously established allowance for these loans as our previous allowance for these loans represented an estimate of charge-offs expected to occur over the next two years (two years being our loss confirmation period). The new accounting guidance was effective as of July 1, 2011 but was required to be applied retrospectively to January 1, 2011. This resulted in $124 million of additional provision for loan losses in the third quarter of 2011 from approximately $3.8 billion of student loans being classified as troubled debt restructurings. This new accounting guidance is only applied to certain borrowers who use their fourth or greater month of forbearance during the time period this new guidance is effective. This new accounting guidance has the effect of accelerating the recognition of expected losses related to our Private Education Loan portfolio. The increase in the provision for losses as a result of this new accounting guidance does not reflect a decrease in credit expectations of the portfolio or an increase in the expected life-of-loan losses related to this portfolio. We believe forbearance is an accepted and effective collections and risk management tool for Private Education Loans. We plan to continue to use forbearance and as a result, we expect to have additional loans classified as troubled debt restructurings in the future (see “Note 4 — Allowance for Loan Losses” for a further discussion on the use of forbearance as a collection tool).

 

F-14


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

As part of concluding on the adequacy of the allowance for loan loss, we review key allowance and loan metrics. The most relevant of these metrics considered are the allowance coverage of charge-offs ratio; the allowance as a percentage of total loans and of loans in repayment; and delinquency and forbearance percentages.

Certain Private Education Loans do not require borrowers to begin repayment until six months after they have graduated or otherwise left school. Consequently, our loss estimates for these programs are generally low while the borrower is in school. At December 31, 2011, 17 percent of the principal balance in the higher education Private Education Loan portfolio was related to borrowers who are in an in-school/grace/deferment status and not required to make payments. As this population of borrowers leaves school, they will be required to begin payments on their loans, and the allowance for loan losses may change accordingly.

We consider a loan to be delinquent 31 days after the last payment was contractually due. We use a model to estimate the amount of uncollectible accrued interest on Private Education Loans and reserve for that amount against current period interest income.

In general, Private Education Loan principal is charged off against the allowance when at the end of the month the loan exceeds 212 days past due. The charge-off amount equals the estimated loss of the defaulted loan balance. Actual recoveries, as they are received, are applied against the remaining loan balance that was not charged-off. If periodic recoveries are less than originally expected, the difference results in immediate additional provision expense and charge-off of such amount.

Allowance for FFELP Loan Losses

FFELP Loans are insured as to their principal and accrued interest in the event of default subject to a Risk Sharing level based on the date of loan disbursement. These insurance obligations are supported by contractual rights against the United States. For loans disbursed after October 1, 1993, and before July 1, 2006, we receive 98 percent reimbursement on all qualifying default claims. For loans disbursed on or after July 1, 2006, we receive 97 percent reimbursement. For loans disbursed prior to October 1, 1993, we receive 100 percent reimbursement.

Similar to the allowance for Private Education Loan losses, the allowance for FFELP Loan losses uses historical experience of borrower default behavior and a two-year loss confirmation period to estimate the credit losses incurred in the loan portfolio at the reporting date. We apply the default rate projections, net of applicable Risk Sharing, to each category for the current period to perform our quantitative calculation. Once the quantitative calculation is performed, we review the adequacy of the allowance for loan losses and determine if qualitative adjustments need to be considered.

Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents includes term federal funds, Eurodollar deposits, commercial paper, asset-backed commercial paper, treasuries, money market funds and bank deposits with original terms to maturity of less than three months.

Restricted Cash and Investments

Restricted cash primarily includes amounts held in student loan securitization trusts and other secured borrowings. This cash must be used to make payments related to trust obligations. Amounts on deposit in these accounts are primarily the result of timing differences between when principal and interest is collected on the trust assets and when principal and interest is paid on trust liabilities.

In connection with our tuition payment plan product, we receive payments from customers that in turn is owed to schools. This cash, a majority of which has been deposited at Sallie Mae Bank (“the Bank”), our Utah

 

F-15


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

industrial bank subsidiary, is held in escrow for the beneficial owners. In addition, the cash rebates that Upromise members earn from qualifying purchases from Upromise’s participating companies are held in trust for the benefit of the members. This cash is held pursuant to a trust document until distributed in accordance with the Upromise member’s request and/or the terms of the Upromise service agreement. Upromise, which acts as the trustee for the trust, has deposited a majority of the cash with the Bank pursuant to a money market deposit account agreement between the Bank and Upromise as trustee of the trust. Subject to capital requirements and other laws, regulations and restrictions applicable to Utah industrial banks, the cash that is deposited with the Bank in connection with the tuition payment plan and the Upromise rebates described above is not restricted and, accordingly, is not included in restricted cash and investments in our consolidated financial statements, as there is no restriction surrounding our use of the funds.

Securities pledged as collateral related to our derivative portfolio, where the counterparty has rights to replace the securities, are classified as restricted. When the counterparty does not have these rights, the security is recorded in investments and disclosed as pledged collateral in the notes. Additionally, certain counterparties require cash collateral pledged to us to be segregated and held in restricted cash accounts. Cash balances that our indentured trusts deposit in guaranteed investment contracts that are held in trust for the related note holders are classified as restricted investments. Finally, cash received from lending institutions that is invested pending disbursement for student loans is restricted and cannot be disbursed for any other purpose.

Investments

Our available-for-sale investment portfolio consists of investments that are AAA equivalent securities and are carried at fair value, with the temporary changes in fair value carried as a separate component of stockholders’ equity, net of taxes. The amortized cost of debt securities in this category is adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts, which are amortized using the effective interest rate method. Other-than-temporary impairment is evaluated by considering several factors, including the length of time and extent to which the fair value has been less than the amortized cost basis, the financial condition and near-term prospects of the security (considering factors such as adverse conditions specific to the security and ratings agency actions), and the intent and ability to retain the investment to allow for an anticipated recovery in fair value. The entire fair value loss on a security that is other-than-temporary impairment is recorded in earnings if we intend to sell the security or if it is more likely than not that we will be required to sell the security before the expected recovery of the loss. However, if the impairment is other-than-temporary, and those two conditions do not exist, the portion of the impairment related to credit losses is recorded in earnings and the impairment related to other factors is recorded in other comprehensive income. Securities classified as trading are accounted for at fair value with unrealized gains and losses included in investment income. Securities that we have the intent and ability to hold to maturity are classified as held-to-maturity and are accounted for at amortized cost unless the security is determined to have an other-than-temporary impairment. In this case it is accounted for in the same manner described above.

We also have other investments, including a receivable for cash collateral posted to derivative counterparties and our remaining investment in leveraged aircraft leases. These investments are accounted for at amortized cost net of impairments in other investments.

Interest Expense

Interest expense is based upon contractual interest rates adjusted for the amortization of debt issuance costs and premiums and the accretion of discounts. Our interest expense may also be adjusted for net payments/receipts related to interest rate and foreign currency swap agreements and interest rate futures contracts that qualify and are designated as hedges. Interest expense also includes the amortization of deferred gains and losses

 

F-16


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

on closed hedge transactions that qualified as hedges. Amortization of debt issuance costs, premiums, discounts and terminated hedge basis adjustments are recognized using the effective interest rate method.

In addition, three TALF eligible Private Education Loan securitizations issued in 2009 are callable at a discount of 93 or 94 percent of the outstanding principal (depending on the terms of the note). The first call dates occur between two and one-half to four years from the original issue date (depending on the terms of the note) and the note is eligible to be called until the end of the call period which lasts six to twelve months. We have concluded that it is probable we will call these bonds at the call date at the respective discount. Probability is based on the our assessment of whether these bonds can be refinanced at the call date at or lower than a breakeven cost of funds based on the call discount. As a result, we are accreting this call discount as a reduction to interest expense through the first call date using the effective interest rate method. If it becomes less than probable we will call these bonds at a future date, it will result in us reversing this prior accretion as a cumulative catch-up adjustment. We have accreted approximately $278 million, cumulatively, as a reduction of interest expense through December 31, 2011. As of January 2012, two of the three TALF deals had been called by us resulting in $238 million of the $278 million of interest accretion being realized. The third deal is first callable in August 2013.

Transfer of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities

We account for loan sales and debt repurchases in accordance with the applicable accounting guidance. Our securitizations, indentured trust debt, ABCP borrowings, ED Conduit and ED Participation Program facility are accounted for as on-balance sheet secured borrowings. See “Securitization Accounting” of this Note 2 for further discussion on the criteria assessed to determine whether a transfer of financial assets is a sale or a secured borrowing. If a transfer of loans qualifies as a sale we derecognize the loan and recognize a gain or loss as the difference between the carry basis of the loan sold and liabilities retained and the compensation received.

We periodically repurchase our outstanding debt in the open market or through public tender offers. We record a gain or loss on the early extinguishment of debt based upon the difference between the carrying cost of the debt and the amount paid to the third party and is net of hedging gains and losses, where the debt is in a qualifying hedge relationship.

We recognize the results of a transfer of loans and the extinguishment of debt based upon the settlement date of the transaction.

Securitization Accounting

Our securitizations use a two-step structure with a special purpose entity that legally isolates the transferred assets from us, even in the event of bankruptcy. Transactions receiving sale treatment are also structured to ensure that the holders of the beneficial interests issued are not constrained from pledging or exchanging their interests, and that we do not maintain effective control over the transferred assets. If these criteria are not met, then the transaction is accounted for as an on-balance sheet secured borrowing. In all cases, irrespective of whether they qualify as accounting sales our securitizations are legally structured to be sales of assets that isolate the transferred assets from us. If a securitization qualifies as a sale, we then assess whether we are the primary beneficiary of the securitization trust and are required to consolidate such trust. (See “Consolidation” of this Note 2.) If we are the primary beneficiary then no gain or loss is recognized.

We assess the financial structure of each securitization to determine whether the trust or other securitization vehicle meets the sale criteria and account for the transaction accordingly. Prior to January 1, 2010 when the new accounting guidance for transfers of financial instruments was implemented which eliminated the concept of a qualified special purpose entity (“QSPE”), certain trusts would qualify as a QSPE and be accounted for as off-balance sheet trusts if they met all of the applicable criteria.

 

F-17


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

Prior to the adoption on January 1, 2010 of the new accounting guidance that eliminated the concept of QSPEs, in certain securitizations there were terms present within the deal structure that resulted in such securitizations not qualifying for sale treatment by failing to meet the criteria required for the securitization entity (trust) to be a QSPE. Accordingly, these securitization trusts were accounted for as VIEs. Because we were considered the primary beneficiary in such VIEs, the transfer was deemed a financing and the trust was consolidated in our financial statements. The terms present in these structures that prevented sale treatment were: (1) we hold rights that can affect the remarketing of specific trust bonds that are not significantly limited in nature, (2) the trust has the right to enter into interest rate cap agreements after its settlement date that do not relate to the reissuance of third-party beneficial interests or (3) we hold an unconditional call option related to a certain percentage of trust assets.

Subsequent to the adoption of the new accounting guidance regarding consolidations and the transfers of financial instruments on January 1, 2010, all of our securitizations trusts that had previously been accounted for off-balance sheet were consolidated. In addition, we have consolidated all subsequent securitization trusts pursuant to the new consolidation accounting guidance. See “Consolidation” of this Note 2 for additional information regarding the accounting rules for consolidation and the effect of the application of the new guidance as we are the primary beneficiary of these trusts.

Irrespective of whether a securitization receives sale or on-balance sheet treatment, our continuing involvement with our securitization trusts is generally limited to:

 

   

Owning the equity certificates of certain trusts.

 

   

The servicing of the student loan assets within the securitization trusts, on both a pre- and post-default basis.

 

   

Our acting as administrator for the securitization transactions we sponsored, which includes remarketing certain bonds at future dates.

 

   

Our responsibilities relative to representation and warranty violations and the reimbursement of borrower benefits.

 

   

The reimbursement to the trust of borrower benefits afforded the borrowers of student loans that have been securitized.

 

   

Certain back-to-back derivatives entered into by us contemporaneously with the execution of derivatives by certain Private Education Loan securitization trusts.

 

   

The option held by us to buy certain delinquent loans from certain Private Education Loan securitization trusts.

 

   

The option to exercise the clean-up call and purchase the student loans from the trust when the asset balance is 10 percent or less of the original loan balance.

 

   

The option (in certain trusts) to call rate reset notes in instances where the remarketing process has failed.

 

   

The option (in certain trusts that were TALF eligible in 2009) to call the outstanding bonds at a discount to par at a future date

The investors of the securitization trusts have no recourse to our other assets should there be a failure of the trusts to pay when due. Generally, the only arrangements under which we have to provide financial support to the trusts are:

 

   

representation and warranty violations requiring the buyback of loans; and

 

   

funding specific cash accounts within certain trusts related to the remarketing of certain bonds.

 

F-18


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

Under the terms of the transaction documents of certain trusts, we have, from time to time, exercised our options to purchase delinquent loans from Private Education Loan trusts, to purchase the remaining loans from trusts once the loan balance falls below 10 percent of the original amount, or to call rate reset notes. Certain trusts maintain financial arrangements with third parties also typical of securitization transactions, such as derivative contracts (swaps) and bond insurance policies that, in the case of a counterparty failure, could adversely impact the value of any Residual Interest.

Retained Interest in Off-Balance Sheet Securitized Loans

Prior to the adoption of the new consolidation accounting rules on January 1, 2010, certain of our securitization transactions qualified as sales and we retained the Residual Interests in the trusts as well as servicing rights (all of which are referred to as our Retained Interest in off-balance sheet securitized loans). The following accounting policies were applied prior to the January 1, 2010 adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance which required us to consolidate all of our previously off-balance sheet trusts and therefore eliminated any accounting for Residual Interests.

When our securitization transactions qualified for sale treatment we recognized the resulting gain on student loan securitizations in the consolidated statements of income. This gain was based upon the difference between the allocated cost basis of the assets sold and the relative fair value of the assets received. The component in determining the fair value of the assets received that involves the most judgment is the valuation of the Residual Interest. We estimated the fair value of the Residual Interest, both initially and each subsequent quarter, based on the present value of future expected cash flows using our best estimates of the following key assumptions — credit losses, prepayment speeds and discount rates commensurate with the risks involved. Quoted market prices were not available. When we adopted the new financial instruments accounting guidance on January 1, 2008, we elected to carry all Residual Interests at fair value with subsequent changes in fair value recorded in earnings. We chose this election in order to simplify the accounting for Residual Interests under one accounting model.

The fair value of the Fixed Rate Embedded Floor Income is a component of the Residual Interest and was determined initially at the time of the sale of the student loans and during each subsequent quarter. This estimate was based on an option valuation and a discounted cash flow calculation that considered the current borrower rate, Special Allowance Payment (“SAP”) spreads and the term for which the loan is eligible to earn Floor Income as well as time value, forward interest rate curve and volatility factors. Variable Rate Floor Income received was recorded as earned in securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue.

We also receive income for servicing the loans in our securitization trusts which was recognized as earned. We assessed the amounts received as compensation for these activities at inception and on an ongoing basis to determine if the amounts received are adequate compensation. To the extent such compensation was determined to be no more or less than adequate compensation, no servicing asset or obligation was recorded at the time of securitization. Servicing rights are subsequently carried at the lower of cost or market. We do not record servicing assets or servicing liabilities when our securitization trusts are accounted for as on-balance sheet secured financings. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, all of our securitization trusts are on-balance sheet and as a result we do not have servicing assets or liabilities recorded on the consolidated balance sheet related to our securitization trusts.

Derivative Accounting

The accounting guidance for our derivative instruments, which includes interest rate swaps, cross-currency interest rate swaps, interest rate futures contracts, interest rate cap contracts and Floor Income Contracts, requires that every derivative instrument, including certain derivative instruments embedded in other contracts, be

 

F-19


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

recorded at fair value on the balance sheet as either an asset or liability. Derivative positions are recorded as net positions by counterparty based on master netting arrangements (see “Note 7—Derivative Instruments—Risk Management Strategy”) exclusive of accrued interest and cash collateral held or pledged.

Many of our derivatives, mainly interest rate swaps hedging the fair value of fixed-rate assets and liabilities, and cross-currency interest rate swaps, qualify as effective hedges. For these derivatives, the relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged items (including the hedged risk and method for assessing effectiveness), as well as the risk management objective and strategy for undertaking various hedge transactions at the inception of the hedging relationship, is documented. Each derivative is designated to either a specific (or pool of) asset(s) or liability(ies) on the balance sheet or expected future cash flows, and designated as either a “fair value” or a “cash flow” hedge. Fair value hedges are designed to hedge our exposure to changes in fair value of a fixed rate or foreign denominated asset or liability, while cash flow hedges are designed to hedge our exposure to variability of either a floating rate asset’s or liability’s cash flows or an expected fixed rate debt issuance. For effective fair value hedges, both the hedge and the hedged item (for the risk being hedged) are marked-to-market with any difference reflecting ineffectiveness and recorded immediately in the statement of income. For effective cash flow hedges, the change in the fair value of the derivative is recorded in other comprehensive income, net of tax, and recognized in earnings in the same period as the earnings effects of the hedged item. The ineffective portion of a cash flow hedge is recorded immediately through earnings. The assessment of the hedge’s effectiveness is performed at inception and on an ongoing basis, generally using regression testing. For hedges of a pool of assets or liabilities, tests are performed to demonstrate the similarity of individual instruments of the pool. When it is determined that a derivative is not currently an effective hedge, ineffectiveness is recognized for the full change in value of the derivative with no offsetting mark-to-market of the hedged item for the current period. If it is also determined the hedge will not be effective in the future, we discontinue the hedge accounting prospectively, cease recording changes in the fair value of the hedged item, and begin amortization of any basis adjustments that exist related to the hedged item.

We also have derivatives, primarily Floor Income Contracts and certain basis swaps, that we believe are effective economic hedges but do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment. These derivatives are classified as “trading” and as a result they are marked-to-market through earnings with no consideration for the fair value fluctuation of the economically hedged item.

The “gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net” line item in the consolidated statements of income includes the unrealized changes in the fair value of our derivatives (except effective cash flow hedges which are recorded in other comprehensive income), the unrealized changes in fair value of hedged items in qualifying fair value hedges, as well as the realized changes in fair value related to derivative net settlements and dispositions that do not qualify for hedge accounting. Net settlement income/expense on derivatives that qualify as hedges are included with the income or expense of the hedged item (mainly interest expense).

Servicing Revenue

Servicing revenue includes third-party loan servicing, account asset servicing, Campus Solutions revenue and Guarantor servicing revenue.

We perform loan servicing functions for third-parties in return for a servicing fee. Our compensation is typically based on a per-unit fee arrangement or a percentage of the loans outstanding. We recognize servicing revenues associated with these activities based upon the contractual arrangements as the services are rendered. We recognize late fees and forbearance fees on third-party serviced loans as well as on loans in our portfolio according to the contractual provisions of the promissory notes, as well as our expectation of collectability.

 

F-20


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

We earn fees in our Campus Solutions business for processing tuition and other payments for our college and university partners. We recognize this fee income based on contractual arrangements in the period in which the services are provided which generally occurs when the transaction is processed.

We provide a full complement of administrative services to FFELP Guarantors including guarantee issuance through July 1, 2010, and account maintenance for Guarantor agencies. The fees associated with these services are recognized as the services are performed based on contractually determined rates.

We also provide account asset servicing including program management, transfer and servicing agent services and administration services for various 529 college savings plans. Fees associated with these services are recognized as the services are performed based on contractually determined rates.

Contingency Revenue

We receive fees for collections of delinquent debt on behalf of clients performed on a contingency basis. Revenue is earned and recognized upon receipt of the delinquent borrower funds.

We also receive fees from Guarantor agencies for performing default aversion services on delinquent loans prior to default. The fee is received when the loan is initially placed with us and we are obligated to provide such services for the remaining life of the loan for no additional fee. In the event that the loan defaults, we are obligated to rebate a portion of the fee to the Guarantor agency in proportion to the principal and interest outstanding when the loan defaults. We recognize fees received, net of an estimate of future rebates owed due to subsequent defaults, over the service period which is estimated to be the life of the loan.

Other Income

Our Upromise subsidiary has a number of programs that encourage consumers to save for the cost of college education. We have established a consumer savings network which is designed to promote college savings by consumers who are members of this program by encouraging them to purchase goods and services from the companies that participate in the program (“Participating Companies”). Participating Companies generally pay Upromise fees based on member purchase volume, either online or in stores depending on the contractual arrangement with the Participating Company. We recognize revenue as marketing and administrative services are rendered based upon contractually determined rates and member purchase volumes.

Goodwill and Acquired Intangible Assets

We account for goodwill and acquired intangible assets in accordance with the applicable accounting guidance. Under this guidance goodwill is not amortized but is tested periodically for impairment. We test goodwill for impairment annually as of October 1 at the reporting unit level, which is the same as or one level below a business segment. Goodwill is also tested at interim periods if an event occurs or circumstances change that would indicate the carrying amount may be impaired.

In September 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-08, Intangibles — Goodwill and Other (Topic 350), “Testing Goodwill for Impairment.” This guidance permits us to assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is “more-likely-than-not” that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount as a basis for determining whether it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment test described in Topic 350. The “more-likely-than-not” threshold is defined as having a likelihood of more than 50 percent. If, after assessing relevant qualitative factors, we conclude that it is “more-likely-than-not” that the fair value of a reporting unit as of October 1 is less than its carrying amount, we will complete Step 1 of the goodwill impairment analysis. Step

 

F-21


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

1 consists of a comparison of the fair value of the reporting unit to the reporting unit’s carrying value, including goodwill. If the carrying value of the reporting unit exceeds the fair value, Step 2 in the goodwill impairment analysis is performed to measure the amount of impairment loss, if any. Step 2 of the goodwill impairment analysis compares the implied fair value of the reporting unit’s goodwill to the carrying value of the reporting unit’s goodwill. The implied fair value of goodwill is determined in a manner consistent with determining goodwill in a business combination. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit’s goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of the goodwill, an impairment loss is recognized in an amount equal to that excess.

The new guidance is effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. However, an entity can choose to early adopt this new guidance. We early adopted the new guidance in the fourth quarter 2011. After assessing relevant qualitative factors including but not limited to the current legislative environment, stock price performance, market capitalization and EPS results, we determined that it is more-likely-than-not that the fair value of the reporting units exceeds their carrying amounts. Accordingly, we did not perform the Step 1 impairment analysis as of October 1, 2011.

Other acquired intangible assets include but are not limited to tradenames, customer and other relationships, and non-compete agreements. Acquired intangible assets with finite lives are amortized over their estimated useful lives in proportion to their estimated economic benefit. Finite-lived acquired intangible assets are reviewed for impairment using an undiscounted cash flow analysis when an event occurs or circumstances change indicating the carrying amount of a finite-lived asset or asset group may not be recoverable. If the carrying amount of the asset or asset groups exceeds the undiscounted cash flows, the fair value of the asset or asset group is determined using an acceptable valuation technique. An impairment loss would be recognized if the carrying amount of the asset (or asset group) exceeds the fair value of the asset or asset group. The impairment loss recognized would be the difference between the carrying amount and fair value. Indefinite-life acquired intangible assets are not amortized. They are tested for impairment annually as of October 1 or at interim periods if an event occurs or circumstances change that would indicate the carrying value of these assets may be impaired. The annual or interim impairment test of indefinite-lived acquired intangible assets is based primarily on a discounted cash flow analysis.

Restructuring Activities

From time to time we implement plans to restructure our business. In conjunction with these restructuring plans, involuntary benefit arrangements, disposal costs (including contract termination costs and other exit costs), as well as certain other costs that are incremental and incurred as a direct result of our restructuring plans, are classified as restructuring expenses in the accompanying consolidated statements of income.

We sponsor the SLM Corporation Employee Severance Plan (the “Severance Plan”) which provides severance benefits in the event of termination of our full-time employees (with the exception of certain specified levels of management) and part-time employees who work at least 24 hours per week. The Severance Plan establishes specified benefits based on base salary, job level immediately preceding termination and years of service upon termination of employment due to Involuntary Termination or a Job Abolishment, as defined in the Severance Plan. The benefits payable under the Severance Plan relate to past service and they accumulate and vest. Accordingly, we recognize severance costs to be paid pursuant to the Severance Plan when payment of such benefits is probable and reasonably estimable. Such benefits, including severance pay calculated based on the Severance Plan, medical and dental benefits, outplacement services and continuation pay, have been incurred during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, as a direct result of our restructuring initiatives. Accordingly, such costs are classified as restructuring expenses in the accompanying consolidated statements of income. See “Note 12—Restructuring Activities” for further information regarding our restructuring activities.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

Contract termination costs are expensed at the earlier of (1) the contract termination date or (2) the cease use date under the contract. Other exit costs are expensed as incurred and classified as restructuring expenses if (1) the cost is incremental to and incurred as a direct result of planned restructuring activities and (2) the cost is not associated with or incurred to generate revenues subsequent to our consummation of the related restructuring activities.

Software Development Costs

Certain direct development costs associated with internal-use software are capitalized, including external direct costs of services and payroll costs for employees devoting time to the software projects. These costs are included in other assets and are amortized over a period not to exceed five years beginning when the asset is technologically feasible and substantially ready for use. Maintenance costs and research and development costs relating to software to be sold or leased are expensed as incurred.

During the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, we capitalized $8 million, $14 million and $16 million, respectively, in costs related to software development, and expensed $115 million, $154 million and $138 million, respectively, related to routine maintenance and amortization. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the unamortized balance of capitalized internally developed software included in other assets was $36 million and $44 million, respectively. We amortize software development costs over three to five years.

Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation

We recognize stock-based compensation cost in our consolidated statements of income using the fair value based method. Under this method we determine the fair value of the stock-based compensation at the time of the grant and recognize the resulting compensation expense over the vesting period of the stock-based grant.

Income Taxes

We account for income taxes under the asset and liability approach which requires the recognition of deferred tax liabilities and assets for the expected future tax consequences of temporary differences between the carrying amounts and tax basis of our assets and liabilities. To the extent tax laws change, deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted in the period that the tax change is enacted.

“Income tax expense/(benefit)” includes (i) deferred tax expense/(benefit), which represents the net change in the deferred tax asset or liability balance during the year plus any change in a valuation allowance, and (ii) current tax expense/(benefit), which represents the amount of tax currently payable to or receivable from a tax authority plus amounts accrued for unrecognized tax benefits. Income tax expense/(benefit) excludes the tax effects related to adjustments recorded in equity.

If we have an uncertain tax position, then that tax position is recognized only if it is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination based on the technical merits of the position. The amount of tax benefit recognized in the financial statements is the largest amount of benefit that is more than fifty percent likely of being sustained upon ultimate settlement of the uncertain tax position. We recognize interest related to unrecognized tax benefits in income tax expense/(benefit), and penalties, if any, in operating expenses.

Earnings (Loss) per Common Share

We compute earnings (loss) per common share (“EPS”) by dividing net income allocated to common shareholders by the weighted average common shares outstanding. Net income allocated to common shareholders represents net income applicable to common shareholders (net income adjusted for preferred stock

 

F-23


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

dividends including dividends declared, accretion of discounts on preferred stock including accelerated accretion when preferred stock is repaid early, and cumulative dividends related to the current dividend period that have not been declared as of period end). Diluted earnings per common share is computed by dividing income allocated to common shareholders by the weighted average common shares outstanding plus amounts representing the dilutive effect of stock options outstanding, restricted stock, restricted stock units, and the dilution resulting from the conversion of convertible preferred stock, if applicable. See “Note 10—Earnings (Loss) per Common Share” for further discussion.

Discontinued Operations

A “Component” of a business comprises operations and cash flows that can be clearly distinguished operationally and for financial reporting purposes from the rest of the Company. When we determine that a Component of our business has been disposed of or has met the criteria to be classified as held-for-sale such Component is presented separately as discontinued operations if the operations of the Component have been or will be eliminated from our ongoing operations and we will have no continuing involvement with the Component after the disposal transaction is complete. See “Note 17—Discontinued Operations” for further discussion. If a component is classified as held-for-sale, then it is carried at the lower of its cost basis or fair value.

Included within discontinued operations are the accounting results related to our purchasing delinquent and charged-off receivables on various types of consumer debt with a primary emphasis on charged-off credit card receivables, and sub-performing and non-performing mortgage loans (Purchased Paper businesses). At December 31, 2011, we have sold all of these businesses. We accounted for these investments in charged-off receivables and sub-performing and non-performing mortgage loans by establishing static pools of each quarter’s purchases and aggregating them based on common risk characteristics. The pools when formed were initially recorded at fair value, based on each pool’s estimated future cash flows and internal rate of return. We recognized income each month based on each static pool’s effective interest rate. The static pools were tested quarterly for impairment by re-estimating the future cash flows to be received from the pools. If the new estimated cash flows resulted in a pool’s effective interest rate increasing, then this new yield was used prospectively over the remaining life of the static pool. If the new estimated cash flows resulted in a pool’s effective interest rate decreasing, the pool was considered impaired and written down through a valuation allowance to maintain the effective interest rate.

Statement of Cash Flows

Included in our financial statements is the consolidated statement of cash flows. It is our policy to include all derivative net settlements, irrespective of whether the derivative is a qualifying hedge, in the same section of the statement of cash flows that the derivative is economically hedging.

As discussed in “Restricted Cash and Investments” of this Note 2, our restricted cash balances primarily relate to on-balance sheet securitizations. This balance is primarily the result of timing differences between when principal and interest is collected on the trust assets and when principal and interest is paid on the trust liabilities. As such, changes in this balance are reflected in investing activities.

Reclassifications

Certain reclassifications have been made to the balances as of and for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, to be consistent with classifications adopted for 2011, which had no impact on net income, total assets or total liabilities.

 

F-24


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

2. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

 

Recently Issued Accounting Standards

Presentation of Comprehensive Income

In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-05, Comprehensive Income (Topic 220), “Presentation of Comprehensive Income.” The objective of this new guidance is to improve the comparability, consistency, and transparency of financial reporting and to increase the prominence of items reported in other comprehensive income. The new guidance requires all non-owner changes in stockholders’ equity be presented either in a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. The new guidance will be applied retrospectively for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2011. As such, this new guidance will be effective for us in the first quarter 2012. The new guidance will not have an impact on our results of operations.

Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements

In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU No. 2011-04, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820), “Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurement and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRSs.” These amendments (1) clarify the FASB’s intent about the application of existing fair value measurement and disclosure requirements; and (2) change particular principles or requirements for measuring fair value or for disclosing information about fair value measurements. This new guidance is effective prospectively for interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011 and is not expected to have a material impact on our fair value measurements.

 

3. Student Loans

There are three principal categories of FFELP Loans: Stafford, PLUS, and FFELP Consolidation Loans. Generally, Stafford and PLUS Loans have repayment periods of between five and ten years. FFELP Consolidation Loans have repayment periods of twelve to thirty years. FFELP Loans do not require repayment, or have modified repayment plans, while the borrower is in-school and during the grace period immediately upon leaving school. The borrower may also be granted a deferment or forbearance for a period of time based on need, during which time the borrower is not considered to be in repayment. Interest continues to accrue on loans in the in-school, deferment and forbearance period. FFELP Loans obligate the borrower to pay interest at a stated fixed rate or a variable rate reset annually (subject to a cap) on July 1 of each year depending on when the loan was originated and the loan type. FFELP Loans disbursed before April 1, 2006 earn interest at the greater of the borrower’s rate or a floating rate based on the SAP formula, with the interest earned on the floating rate that exceeds the interest earned from the borrower being paid directly by ED. In low or certain declining interest rate environments when student loans are earning at the fixed borrower rate, and the interest on the funding for the loans is variable and declining, we can earn additional spread income that we refer to as Floor Income. For loans disbursed after April 1, 2006, FFELP Loans effectively only earn at the SAP rate, as the excess interest earned when the borrower rate exceeds the SAP rate (Floor Income) is required to be rebated to ED.

FFELP Loans are insured as to their principal and accrued interest in the event of default subject to a Risk Sharing level based on the date of loan disbursement. These insurance obligations are supported by contractual rights against the United States. For loans disbursed after October 1, 1993 and before July 1, 2006, we receive 98 percent reimbursement on all qualifying default claims. For loans disbursed on or after July 1, 2006, we receive 97 percent reimbursement.

On December 23, 2011, the President signed the Consolidated Appropriations Act of 2012 into law. This law includes changes that permit FFELP lenders or beneficial holders to change the index on which the Special

 

F-25


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

3. Student Loans (Continued)

 

Allowance Payments (“SAP”) are calculated for FFELP Loans first disbursed on or after January 1, 2000. The law allows holders to elect to move the index from the Commercial Paper (“CP”) Rate to the one-month LIBOR rate. Such elections must be made by April 1, 2012. As of December 31, 2011, we had $130 billion of loans where we intend to elect the change. This change will help us to better match lender payments with our financing costs. We currently expect the new formula to be developed and available for use in the second quarter of 2012.

We offer a variety of Private Education Loans. The Private Education Loans we make are largely to bridge the gap between the cost of higher education and the amount funded through financial aid, federal loans or borrowers’ resources. Private Education Loans bear the full credit risk of the borrower. We manage this additional risk through historical risk-performance underwriting strategies and the addition of qualified cosigners. Private Education Loans generally carry a variable rate indexed to LIBOR or Prime indices. We encourage borrowers to include a cosignor on the loan, and the majority of loans in our portfolio are cosigned. Similar to FFELP loans, Private Education Loans are generally non-dischargeable in bankruptcy. Most loans have repayment terms of 15 years or more, and payments are typically deferred until after graduation; however, in June 2009 we began to offer interest-only or fixed payment options while the borrower is enrolled in school. Similar to FFELP loans, we offer payment deferment to qualifying borrowers during in-school periods, and offer periods of forbearance subject to maximum terms of 24 months. Forbearance may be granted to borrowers who are exiting their grace period to provide additional time to obtain employment and income to support their obligations, or to current borrowers who are faced with a hardship and request forbearance time to provide temporary payment relief. Interest continues to accrue on loans in any deferred or forbearance period.

The estimated weighted average life of student loans in our portfolio was approximately 7.6 years and 7.7 years at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The following table reflects the distribution of our student loan portfolio by program.

 

 

     December 31,
2011
    Year Ended
December 31, 2011
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Ending
Balance
     % of
Balance
    Average
Balance
     Average
Effective
Interest
Rate
 

FFELP Stafford and Other Student Loans, net(1)

   $ 50,440         29   $ 53,163         1.92

FFELP Consolidation Loans, net

     87,690         50        89,946         2.71   

Private Education Loans, net

     36,290         21        36,955         6.57   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total student loans, net(2)

   $ 174,420         100   $ 180,064         3.27
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     December 31,
2010
    Year Ended
December 31, 2010
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Ending
Balance
     % of
Balance
    Average
Balance
     Average
Effective
Interest
Rate
 

FFELP Stafford and Other Student Loans, net(1)

   $ 56,252         31   $ 61,034         1.93

FFELP Consolidation Loans, net

     92,397         50        81,009         2.67   

Private Education Loans, net

     35,656         19        36,534         6.44   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total student loans, net(2)

   $ 184,305         100   $ 178,577         3.19
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

          
(1)

The FFELP category is primarily Stafford Loans, but also includes federally guaranteed PLUS and HEAL Loans.

 

(2)

The total student loan ending balance includes net unamortized premiums/discounts of $801 and $1,006 as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

F-26


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

3. Student Loans (Continued)

 

As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, 71 percent and 68 percent, respectively, of our student loan portfolio was in repayment.

Loan Acquisitions and Sales

In December 2008, we sold approximately $494 million (principal and accrued interest) of FFELP Loans to ED at a price of 97 percent of principal and unpaid interest pursuant to ED’s authority under ECASLA to make such purchases, and recorded a loss on the sale. Additionally, in early January 2009, we sold an additional $486 million (principal and accrued interest) in FFELP Loans to ED under this program. The loss related to this sale in January was recognized in 2008 as the loans were classified as held-for-sale. The total loss recognized on these two sales for the year ended December 31, 2008 was $53 million and was recorded in “Losses on sales of loans and securities, net” in the consolidated statements of income.

In 2009, we sold to ED approximately $18.5 billion face amount of loans as part of the Purchase Program (approximately $840 million face amount of loans was sold in the third quarter of 2009, with the remainder sold in the fourth quarter of 2009). Outstanding debt of $18.5 billion was paid down related to the Participation Program pursuant to ECASLA in connection with these loan sales. These loan sales resulted in a $284 million gain. The settlement of the fourth-quarter sale of loans out of the Participation Program included repaying the debt by delivering the related loans to ED in a non-cash transaction and receipt of cash from ED for $484 million, representing the reimbursement of a one-percent payment made to ED plus a $75 fee per loan.

In 2010, we sold to ED approximately $20.4 billion face amount of loans as part of the Purchase Program. These loan sales resulted in a $321 million gain. Outstanding debt of $20.3 billion has been paid down related to the Participation Program in connection with these loan sales.

On December 31, 2010, we closed on our agreement to purchase an interest in $26.1 billion of securitized federal student loans and related assets and $25.0 billion of liabilities from the Student Loan Corporation (“SLC”), a subsidiary of Citibank, N.A. The purchase price was approximately $1.1 billion. The assets purchased include the residual interest in 13 of SLC’s 14 FFELP loan securitizations and its interest in SLC Funding Note Issuer related to the U.S. Department of Education’s Straight-A Funding asset-backed commercial paper conduit. We will also service these assets and administer the securitization trusts. We converted all of the underlying loans to our servicing platform by October 2011, and had an interim subservicing agreement for Citibank to service the loans prior to conversion. Because we have determined that we are the primary beneficiary of these trusts we have consolidated these trusts onto our balance sheet. The transaction was funded by a 5-year term loan provided by Citibank in an amount equal to the purchase price.

 

F-27


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

3. Student Loans (Continued)

 

The following table shows the assets and liabilities that were acquired and consolidated on our balance sheet at fair value on December 31, 2010.

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   Acquisition on
December  31, 2010
 

FFELP Stafford Loans

   $ 11,121   

FFELP Consolidation Loans

     14,262   

Loan fair value discount

     (494
  

 

 

 

FFELP Loans

     24,889   

Restricted cash

     749   

Other assets

     446   
  

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 26,084   
  

 

 

 

Long-term borrowings — FFELP trusts

   $ 25,609   

Long-term borrowings — acquisition financing

     1,064   

Long-term borrowings fair value discount

     (659
  

 

 

 

Long-term borrowings

     26,014   

Other liabilities

     70   
  

 

 

 

Total liabilities

   $ 26,084   
  

 

 

 

Certain Collection Tools

Forbearance involves granting the borrower a temporary cessation of payments (or temporary acceptance of smaller than scheduled payments) for a specified period of time. Using forbearance extends the original term of the loan. Forbearance does not grant any reduction in the total repayment obligation (principal or interest). While in forbearance status, interest continues to accrue and is capitalized to principal when the loan re-enters repayment status. Our forbearance policies include limits on the number of forbearance months granted consecutively and the total number of forbearance months granted over the life of the loan. In some instances, we require good-faith payments before granting forbearance. Exceptions to forbearance policies are permitted when such exceptions are judged to increase the likelihood of collection of the loan. Forbearance as a collection tool is used most effectively when applied based on a borrower’s unique situation, including historical information and judgments. We leverage updated borrower information and other decision support tools to best determine who will be granted forbearance based on our expectations as to a borrower’s ability and willingness to repay their obligation. This strategy is aimed at mitigating the overall risk of the portfolio as well as encouraging cash resolution of delinquent loans.

Forbearance may be granted to borrowers who are exiting their grace period to provide additional time to obtain employment and income to support their obligations, or to current borrowers who are faced with a hardship and request forbearance time to provide temporary payment relief. In these circumstances, a borrower’s loan is placed into a forbearance status in limited monthly increments and is reflected in the forbearance status at month-end during this time. At the end of the granted forbearance period, the borrower will enter repayment status as current and is expected to begin making scheduled monthly payments on a go-forward basis.

Forbearance may also be granted to borrowers who are delinquent in their payments. In these circumstances, the forbearance cures the delinquency and the borrower is returned to a current repayment status. In more limited instances, delinquent borrowers will also be granted additional forbearance time.

 

F-28


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

3. Student Loans (Continued)

 

During 2009, we instituted an interest rate reduction program to assist customers in repaying their Private Education Loans through reduced payments, while continuing to reduce their outstanding principal balance. This program is offered in situations where the potential for principal recovery, through a modification of the monthly payment amount, is better than other alternatives currently available. Along with the ability and willingness to pay, the customer must make three consecutive monthly payments at the reduced rate to qualify for the program. Once the customer has made the initial three payments, the loans status is returned to current and the interest rate is reduced for the successive twelve month period.

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses

Our provisions for loan losses represent the periodic expense of maintaining an allowance sufficient to absorb incurred probable losses, net of expected recoveries, in the held-for-investment loan portfolios. The evaluation of the provisions for loan losses is inherently subjective as it requires material estimates that may be susceptible to significant changes. We believe that the allowance for loan losses is appropriate to cover probable losses incurred in the loan portfolios. We segregate our Private Education Loan portfolio into two classes of loans — traditional and non-traditional. Non-traditional loans are loans to (i) borrowers attending for-profit schools with an original Fair Isaac and Company (“FICO”) score of less than 670 and (ii) borrowers attending not-for-profit schools with an original FICO score of less than 640. The FICO score used in determining whether a loan is non-traditional is the greater of the borrower or cosigner FICO score at origination. Traditional loans are defined as all other Private Education Loans that are not classified as non-traditional.

In establishing the allowance for Private Education Loan losses for the year ended 2011, we considered several additional emerging environmental factors with respect to our Private Education Loan portfolio. In particular, we continue to see improving credit quality and continuing positive delinquency and charge-off trends in connection with this portfolio. Improving credit quality is seen in higher FICO scores and cosigner rates, as well as, a more seasoned portfolio compared to the previous year. The delinquency rate has declined to 10.1 percent from 10.6 percent and the charge-off rate has declined to 3.7 percent from 5.0 percent compared to the previous year.

In contrast to these overall improvements in credit quality, delinquency and charge-off trends, Private Education Loans which defaulted between 2008 and 2011 for which we have previously charged off estimated losses have, to varying degrees, not met our post-default recovery expectations to date and may continue not to do so. According to our policy, we have been charging off these periodic shortfalls in expected recoveries against our allowance for Private Education Loan losses and the related receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans and we will continue to do so. Differences in actual future recoveries on these defaulted loans could affect our receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans. We increased our provision for Private Education Loan losses for the third quarter of 2011 in the amount of $143 million to reflect these uncertainties. Continuing historically high unemployment rates may negatively affect future Private Education Loan default and recovery expectations over our estimated two-year loss confirmation period. Consequently, in accordance with our policy, we have also given consideration to these factors in projecting charge-offs for this period and establishing our allowance for Private Education Loan losses. We will continue to monitor defaults and recoveries in light of the continuing weak economy and elevated unemployment rates. For a more detailed discussion of our policy for determining the collectability of Private Education Loan and maintaining our allowance for Private Education Loan losses, see “Note 2—Significant Accounting Policies—Allowance for Private Education Loan Losses.”

 

F-29


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

Allowance for Loan Losses Metrics

 

 

     Allowance for Loan Losses
Year Ended December 31, 2011
 

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP Loans     Private  Education
Loans
    Other
Loans
    Total  

Allowance for Loan Losses

        

Beginning balance

   $ 189      $ 2,022      $ 72      $ 2,283   

Total provision

     86        1,179        30        1,295   

Charge-offs

     (78     (1,072     (33     (1,183

Student loan sales

     (10                   (10

Reclassification of interest reserve(1)

            42               42   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending Balance

   $ 187      $ 2,171      $ 69      $ 2,427   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Allowance:

        

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $      $ 762      $ 51      $ 813   

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 187      $ 1,409      $ 18      $ 1,614   

Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

   $      $      $      $   

Loans:

        

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $      $ 5,313      $ 93      $ 5,406   

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 136,643      $ 34,021      $ 170      $ 170,834   

Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

   $      $      $      $   

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment and forbearance

     .07     3.6     11.3  

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment

     .08     3.7     11.3  

Allowance as a percentage of the ending total loan balance

     .14     5.5     26.3  

Allowance as a percentage of the ending loans in repayment

     .20     7.2     26.3  

Allowance coverage of charge-offs

     2.4        2.0        2.1     

Ending total loans(2)

   $ 136,643      $ 39,334      $ 263     

Average loans in repayment

   $ 94,359      $ 28,790      $ 294     

Ending loans in repayment

   $ 94,181      $ 30,185      $ 263     

 

  (1)

Represents the additional allowance related to the amount of uncollectible interest reserved within interest income that is transferred in the period to the allowance for loan losses when interest is capitalized to a loan’s principal balance.

 

  (2)

Ending total loans for Private Education Loans includes the receivable for partially charged-off loans.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

 

     Allowance for Loan Losses
Year Ended December 31, 2010
 

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP Loans     Private  Education
Loans
    Other
Loans
    Total  

Allowance for Loan Losses

        

Beginning balance

   $ 161      $ 1,443      $ 76      $ 1,680   

Total provision

     98        1,298        23        1,419   

Charge-offs

     (87     (1,291     (27     (1,405

Student loan sales

     (8                   (8

Reclassification of interest reserve(1)

            48               48   

Consolidation of securitization trusts(2)

     25        524               549   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending Balance

   $ 189      $ 2,022      $ 72      $ 2,283   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Allowance:

        

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $      $ 114      $ 59      $ 173   

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 189      $ 1,908      $ 13      $ 2,110   

Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

   $      $      $      $   

Loans:

        

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $      $ 444      $ 114      $ 558   

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 146,938      $ 38,128      $ 228      $ 185,294   

Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

   $      $      $      $   

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment and forbearance

     .09     4.8     6.9  

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment

     .11     5.0     6.9  

Allowance as a percentage of the ending total loan balance

     .13     5.2     21.2  

Allowance as a percentage of the ending loans in repayment

     .20     7.3     21.2  

Allowance coverage of charge-offs

     2.2        1.6        2.7     

Ending total loans(3)

   $ 146,938      $ 38,572      $ 342     

Average loans in repayment

   $ 82,255      $ 25,596      $ 383     

Ending loans in repayment

   $ 96,696      $ 27,852      $ 342     

 

  (1)

Represents the additional allowance related to the amount of uncollectible interest reserved within interest income that is transferred in the period to the allowance for loan losses when interest is capitalized to a loan’s principal balance.

 

  (2)

Upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, we consolidated all of our previously off-balance sheet securitization trusts. (See “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies — Consolidation.”)

 

  (3)

Ending total loans for Private Education Loans includes the receivable for partially charged-off loans.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

 

     Allowance for Loan Losses
Year Ended December 31, 2009
 

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP Loans     Private  Education
Loans
    Other
Loans
    Total  

Allowance for Loan Losses

        

Beginning balance

   $ 138      $ 1,308      $ 61      $ 1,507   

Total provision

     106        967        46        1,119   

Charge-offs

     (79     (876     (31     (986

Student loan sales and securitization activity

     (4                   (4

Reclassification of interest reserve(1)

            44               44   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Ending Balance

   $ 161      $ 1,443      $ 76      $ 1,680   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Allowance:

        

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $      $ 32      $ 57      $ 89   

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 161      $ 1,411      $ 19      $ 1,591   

Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

   $      $      $      $   

Loans:

        

Ending balance: individually evaluated for impairment

   $      $ 174      $ 128      $ 302   

Ending balance: collectively evaluated for impairment

   $ 119,027      $ 24,581      $ 310      $ 143,918   

Ending balance: loans acquired with deteriorated credit quality

   $      $      $      $   

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment and forbearance

     .10     6.7     6.3  

Charge-offs as a percentage of average loans in repayment

     .11     7.2     6.3  

Allowance as a percentage of the ending total loan balance

     .14     5.8     17.4  

Allowance as a percentage of the ending loans in repayment

     .23     10.0     17.4  

Allowance coverage of charge-offs

     2.0        1.6        2.4     

Ending total loans(2)

   $ 119,027      $ 24,755      $ 438     

Average loans in repayment

   $ 69,020      $ 12,137      $ 495     

Ending loans in repayment

   $ 69,827      $ 14,379      $ 438     

 

  (1)

Represents the additional allowance related to the amount of uncollectible interest reserved within interest income that is transferred in the period to the allowance for loan losses when interest is capitalized to a loan’s principal balance.

 

  (2)

Ending total loans for Private Education Loans includes the receivable for partially charged-off loans.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

Key Credit Quality Indicators

FFELP Loans are substantially insured and guaranteed as to their principal and accrued interest in the event of default; therefore, the key credit quality indicator for this portfolio is loan status. The impact of changes in loan status is incorporated quarterly into the allowance for loan losses calculation. For Private Education Loans, the key credit quality indicators are school type, FICO scores, the existence of a cosigner, the loan status and loan seasoning. The school type/FICO score are assessed at origination and maintained through the traditional/non-traditional loan designation. The other Private Education Loan key quality indicators can change and are incorporated quarterly into the allowance for loan losses calculation. The following table highlights the principal balance (excluding the receivable for partially charged-off loans) of our Private Education Loan portfolio stratified by the key credit quality indicators.

 

 

     Private Education Loans
Credit Quality Indicators
 
     December 31, 2011     December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance(3)      % of Balance     Balance(3)      % of Balance  

Credit Quality Indicators

          

School Type/FICO Scores:

          

Traditional

   $ 34,528         91   $ 33,619         90

Non-Traditional(1)

     3,565         9        3,913         10   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 38,093         100   $ 37,532         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Cosigners:

          

With cosigner

   $ 23,507         62   $ 22,259         59

Without cosigner

     14,586         38        15,273         41   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 38,093         100   $ 37,532         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Seasoning(2):

          

1-12 payments

   $ 9,246         24   $ 10,932         29

13-24 payments

     6,837         18        6,659         18   

25-36 payments

     5,677         15        4,457         12   

37-48 payments

     3,778         10        2,891         8   

More than 48 payments

     6,033         16        4,253         11   

Not yet in repayment

     6,522         17        8,340         22   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 38,093         100   $ 37,532         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1)

Defined as loans to borrowers attending for-profit schools (with a FICO score of less than 670 at origination) and borrowers attending not-for-profit schools (with a FICO score of less than 640 at origination).

 

(2) 

Number of months in active repayment for which a scheduled payment was due.

 

(3) 

Balance represents gross Private Education Loans.

 

F-33


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

The following tables provide information regarding the loan status and aging of past due loans.

 

 

     FFELP Loan Delinquencies
December 31,
 
     2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance     %     Balance     %     Balance     %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 22,887        $ 28,214        $ 35,079     

Loans in forbearance(2)

     19,575          22,028          14,121     

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

            

Loans current

     77,093        81.9     80,026        82.8     57,528        82.4

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     5,419        5.8        5,500        5.7        4,250        6.1   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     3,438        3.7        3,178        3.3        2,205        3.1   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     8,231        8.6        7,992        8.2        5,844        8.4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans in repayment

     94,181        100     96,696        100     69,827        100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total FFELP Loans, gross

     136,643          146,938          119,027     

FFELP Loan unamortized premium

     1,674          1,900          2,187     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total FFELP Loans

     138,317          148,838          121,214     

FFELP Loan allowance for losses

     (187       (189       (161  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

FFELP Loans, net

   $ 138,130        $ 148,649        $ 121,053     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

       68.9       65.8       58.7
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of FFELP Loans in repayment

       18.1       17.2       17.6
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

FFELP Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

       17.2       18.6       16.8
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1)

Loans for borrowers who may still be attending school or engaging in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation, as well as loans for borrowers who have requested and qualify for other permitted program deferments such as military, unemployment, or economic hardships.

 

(2) 

Loans for borrowers who have used their allowable deferment time or do not qualify for deferment, that need additional time to obtain employment or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors.

 

(3)

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

 

F-34


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

 

     Private Education Traditional Loan
Delinquencies
 
     December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance     %     Balance     %     Balance     %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 5,866        $ 7,419        $ 7,812     

Loans in forbearance(2)

     1,195          1,156          784     

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

            

Loans current

     25,110        91.4     22,850        91.2     10,844        90.2

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     868        3.2        794        3.2        437        3.6   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     393        1.4        340        1.4        204        1.7   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     1,096        4.0        1,060        4.2        543        4.5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total traditional loans in repayment

     27,467        100     25,044        100     12,028        100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total traditional loans, gross

     34,528          33,619          20,624     

Traditional loans unamortized discount

     (792       (801       (475  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total traditional loans

     33,736          32,818          20,149     

Traditional loans receivable for partially charged-off loans

     705          558          193     

Traditional loans allowance for losses

     (1,542       (1,231       (664  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Traditional loans, net

   $ 32,899        $ 32,145        $ 19,678     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Percentage of traditional loans in repayment

       80.0       74.5       58.3
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of traditional loans in repayment

       8.6       8.8       9.8
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

       4.2       4.4       6.1
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1)

Deferment includes borrowers who have returned to school or are engaged in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation.

 

(2) 

Loans for borrowers who have requested extension of grace period generally during employment transition or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors, consistent with established loan program servicing policies and procedures.

 

(3) 

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

 

F-35


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

 

     Private Education Non-Traditional Loan
Delinquencies
 
     December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Balance     %     Balance     %     Balance     %  

Loans in-school/grace/deferment(1)

   $ 656        $ 921        $ 1,097     

Loans in forbearance(2)

     191          184          184     

Loans in repayment and percentage of each status:

            

Loans current

     2,012        74.0     2,038        72.6     1,578        67.1

Loans delinquent 31-60 days(3)

     208        7.7        217        7.7        209        8.9   

Loans delinquent 61-90 days(3)

     127        4.7        131        4.7        136        5.8   

Loans delinquent greater than 90 days(3)

     371        13.6        422        15.0        429        18.2   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-traditional loans in repayment

     2,718        100     2,808        100     2,352        100
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total non-traditional loans, gross

     3,565          3,913          3,633     

Non-traditional loans unamortized discount

     (81       (93       (84  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Total non-traditional loans

     3,484          3,820          3,549     

Non-traditional loans receivable for partially charged-off loans

     536          482          306     

Non-traditional loans allowance for losses

     (629       (791       (779  
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Non-traditional loans, net

   $ 3,391        $ 3,511        $ 3,076     
  

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

   

Percentage of non-traditional loans in repayment

       76.2       71.8       64.7
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Delinquencies as a percentage of non-traditional loans in repayment

       26.0       27.4       32.9
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

Loans in forbearance as a percentage of loans in repayment and forbearance

       6.6       6.1       7.3
    

 

 

     

 

 

     

 

 

 

 

(1)

Deferment includes borrowers who have returned to school or are engaged in other permitted educational activities and are not yet required to make payments on the loans, e.g., residency periods for medical students or a grace period for bar exam preparation.

 

(2) 

Loans for borrowers who have requested extension of grace period generally during employment transition or who have temporarily ceased making full payments due to hardship or other factors, consistent with established loan program servicing policies and procedures.

 

(3)

The period of delinquency is based on the number of days scheduled payments are contractually past due.

Receivable for Partially Charged-Off Private Education Loans

At the end of each month, for loans that are 212 days past due, we charge off the estimated loss of a defaulted loan balance. Actual recoveries are applied against the remaining loan balance that was not charged off. We refer to this remaining loan balance as the “receivable for partially charged-off loans.” If actual periodic recoveries are less than expected, the difference is immediately charged off through the allowance for loan losses with an offsetting reduction in the receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans. If actual periodic recoveries are greater than expected, they will be reflected as a recovery through the allowance for Private Education Loan losses once the cumulative recovery amount exceeds the cumulative amount originally expected to be recovered. There was $143 million in provision for Private Education Loan losses recorded in 2011 to reflect possible additional future charge-offs related to the receivable for partially charged-off Private Education Loans.

 

F-36


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

The following table summarizes the activity in the receivable for partially charged-off loans.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

Receivable at beginning of period

   $ 1,040      $ 499      $ 222   

Expected future recoveries of current period defaults(1)

     391        459        324   

Recoveries(2)

     (155     (104     (43

Charge-offs(3)

     (35     (43     (4

Consolidation of securitization trusts(4)

            229          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Receivable at end of period

   $ 1,241      $ 1,040      $ 499   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

Remaining loan balance expected to be collected from contractual loan balances partially charged-off during the period. This is the difference between the defaulted loan balance and the amount of the defaulted loan balance that was charged off.

 

  (2)

Current period cash collections.

 

  (3) 

Represents the current period recovery shortfall – the difference between what was expected to be collected and what was actually collected.

 

  (4) 

Upon the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, we consolidated all of our off-balance sheet securitization trusts.

Troubled Debt Restructurings

We modify the terms of loans for certain borrowers when we believe such modifications may increase the ability and willingness of a borrower to make payments and thus increase the ultimate overall amount collected on a loan. These modifications generally take the form of a forbearance, a temporary interest rate reduction or an extended repayment plan. For borrowers experiencing financial difficulty, certain Private Education Loans for which we have granted either a forbearance of greater than three months, an interest rate reduction or an extended repayment plan are classified as troubled debt restructurings. Forbearance provides borrowers the ability to defer payments for a period of time, but does not result in the forgiveness of any principal or interest. While in forbearance status, interest continues to accrue and is capitalized to principal when the loan re-enters repayment status. The recorded investment of loans granted a forbearance that was classified as a troubled debt restructuring was $4.5 billion at December 30, 2011. The recorded investment for troubled debt restructurings from loans granted interest rate reductions or extended repayment plans was $0.7 billion and $0.4 billion at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

F-37


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, all of our troubled debt restructuring loans had a related allowance recorded. The following table provides the recorded investment, unpaid principal balance and related allowance for our troubled debt restructuring loans.

 

 

     Troubled Debt Restructuring Loans  

(Dollars in millions)

   Recorded
Investment(1)
     Unpaid
Principal
Balance
     Related
Allowance
 

December 31, 2011

        

Private Education Loans — Traditional

   $ 4,201       $ 4,259       $ 546   

Private Education Loans — Non-Traditional

     1,048         1,054         216   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 5,249       $ 5,313       $ 762   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

        

Private Education Loans — Traditional

   $ 264       $ 267       $ 66   

Private Education Loans — Non-Traditional

     175         177         48   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 439       $ 444       $ 114   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

The recorded investment is equal to the unpaid principal balance and accrued interest receivable net of unamortized deferred fees and costs.

The following table provides the average recorded investment and interest income recognized for our troubled debt restructuring loans.

 

 

    Years Ended December 31,  
    2011     2010     2009  

(Dollars in millions)

  Average
Recorded
Investment
    Interest
Income
Recognized
    Average
Recorded
Investment
    Interest
Income
Recognized
    Average
Recorded
Investment
    Interest
Income
Recognized
 

Private Education Loans — Traditional

  $ 1,960      $ 121      $ 210      $ 6      $ 23      $ 1   

Private Education Loans — Non-Traditional

    560        48        156        7        28          
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 2,520      $ 169      $ 366      $ 13      $ 51      $ 1   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The following table provides the amount of modified loans that resulted in a troubled debt restructuring, as well as, charge-offs occurring in the troubled debt restructuring portfolio. The majority of our loans that are considered troubled debt restructurings involve a temporary forbearance of payments and do not change the contractual interest rate of the loan.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011      2010      2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Modified
Loans(1)
     Charge-
offs(2)
     Modified
Loans(1)
     Charge-
offs(2)
     Modified
Loans(1)
     Charge-
offs(2)
 

Private Education Loans — Traditional

   $ 4,103       $ 99       $ 171       $ 18       $ 80       $   

Private Education Loans — Non-Traditional

     951         55         106         25         94         1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 5,054       $ 154       $ 277       $ 43       $ 174       $ 1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Represents period ending balance of loans that have been modified during the period.

 

(2) 

Represents loans that charge off at 212 days delinquent during the period that are classified as troubled debt restructurings.

 

F-38


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

4. Allowance for Loan Losses (Continued)

 

Accrued Interest Receivable

The following table provides information regarding accrued interest receivable on our Private Education Loans. The table also discloses the amount of accrued interest on loans greater than 90 days past due as compared to our allowance for uncollectible interest. The allowance for uncollectible interest exceeds the amount of accrued interest on our 90 days past due portfolio for all periods presented.

 

 

     Accrued Interest Receivable
As of December 31,
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Total      Greater than
90 days
Past Due
     Allowance  for
Uncollectible
Interest
 

2011

        

Private Education Loans — Traditional

   $ 870       $ 36       $ 44   

Private Education Loans — Non-Traditional

     148         18         28   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,018       $ 54       $ 72   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2010

        

Private Education Loans — Traditional

   $ 1,062       $ 35       $ 57   

Private Education Loans — Non-Traditional

     209         20         37   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,271       $ 55       $ 94   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

2009

        

Private Education Loans — Traditional

   $ 917       $ 19       $ 31   

Private Education Loans — Non-Traditional

     248         22         65   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1,165       $ 41       $ 96   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

F-39


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

5. Goodwill and Acquired Intangible Assets

Goodwill

All acquisitions must be assigned to a reporting unit or units. A reporting unit is the same as, or one level below, a reportable segment. We have four reportable segments: Consumer Lending, Business Services, FFELP Loans and Other. The following table summarizes our allocation of goodwill, accumulated impairments and net goodwill for our reporting units and reportable segments (which was allocated based upon the relative fair values of the reporting units).

 

 

     As of December 31, 2011      As of December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Gross      Accumulated
Impairments
    Net      Gross      Accumulated
Impairments
    Net  

Total FFELP Loans reportable segment

   $ 194       $ (4   $ 190       $ 194       $ (4   $ 190   

Total Consumer Lending reportable segment

     147                147         147                147   

Business Services reportable segment:
Servicing

     50                50         50                50   

Contingency Services

     136         (129     7         129         (129       

Wind-down Guarantor Servicing

     256         (256             256         (256       

Insurance Services

     11                11                          

Upromise

     140         (140             140         (140       
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total Business Services reportable segment

     593         (525     68         575         (525     50   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 934       $ (529   $ 405       $ 916       $ (529   $ 387   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Goodwill Impairment Testing

In performing our goodwill impairment analysis we assessed relevant qualitative factors to determine whether it is “more-likely-than-not” that the fair value of an individual reporting unit is less than its carrying value. As part of our qualitative assessment, we considered the amount of excess fair value over the carrying values of the FFELP Loans, Private Education Loans and Servicing reporting units as of October 1, 2010 when we performed a step 1 goodwill impairment test and engaged an appraisal firm to estimate the fair values of these reporting units. The fair value of each reporting unit significantly exceeded its carrying amount.

The following table illustrates the carrying value of equity for each reporting unit with remaining goodwill as of December 31, 2010, and the estimated fair value determined in conjunction with Step 1 impairment testing in the fourth quarter of 2010 as determined by a third-party appraisal firm.

 

 

     Carrying Value
of Equity
     Fair Value
of Equity
     $ Difference      % Difference  

(Dollars in millions)

                                

FFELP Loans

   $ 1,777       $ 3,766       $ 1,989            112

Servicing

     123         1,290         1,167            949   

Consumer Lending

     1,920         2,914         994            52   

In conjunction with our qualitative assessment, we also considered the current legislative environment, our 2011 stock price, market capitalization and EPS results as well as significant reductions in our operating expenses. The significant legislative changes from HCERA that affected our reporting units individually and the Company as a whole occurred in 2010. During 2011, there were no significant changes to legislation that would impact current reporting unit fair values. Further, we believe the other qualitative factors we considered would indicate favorable changes to reporting unit fair values. After assessing these relevant qualitative factors, we

 

F-40


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

5. Goodwill and Acquired Intangible Assets (Continued)

 

determined that it is more-likely-than-not that the fair values of the FFELP Loans, Private Education Loans and Servicing reporting units exceed their carrying amounts. Accordingly, we did not perform the Step 1 impairment analysis as of October 1, 2011 for these reporting units.

During 2011, we completed two acquisitions in the Business Services reportable segment which increased goodwill by $18 million, $7 million of which is attributed to the Contingency Services reporting unit and $11 million of which is attributed to Insurance Services. We considered the fair value of these reporting units in conjunction with the qualitative analysis described above and determined that it is more-likely-than-not that the fair values of these reporting units exceed their carrying amounts.

Continued weakness in the economy coupled with changes in the industry resulting from HCERA or other legislation could adversely affect the operating results of our reporting units. If the forecasted performance of our reporting units is not achieved, or if our stock price declines to a depressed level resulting in deterioration in our total market capitalization, the fair value of the FFELP Loans, Servicing, Private Education Loans, Contingency Services and Insurance Services reporting units could be significantly reduced, and we may be required to record a charge to our earnings, which could be material, for an impairment of goodwill.

We revised our segment presentation and reporting unit structure as of October 1, 2010. As such, 2010 interim impairment assessments and testing during interim periods as well as 2009 annual impairment testing were completed based on the reporting unit structure in place during these periods. During the third quarter of 2010, as part of a broad-based assessment of possible changes to our business following the passage of HCERA, we performed certain preliminary valuations which indicated there was possible impairment of goodwill and certain intangible assets in our reporting units which at that time included Lending, Asset Performance Group (“APG”), Guarantor Servicing, Upromise and Other. We identified certain events that occurred during third quarter 2010 that we determined were triggering events because they either resulted in lower expected future cash flows or because they provided indications that market participants would value our reporting units below previous estimates of fair value. Based on the valuations performed in conjunction with Step 1 impairment testing during the third-quarter 2010, no impairment was indicated for the Lending reporting unit, but impairment was indicated for the APG, Guarantor Services and Upromise reporting units. Under the second step of the analysis, determining the implied fair value of goodwill requires valuation of a reporting unit’s identifiable tangible and intangible assets and liabilities in a manner similar to the allocation of purchase price in a business combination. If the carrying value of a reporting unit’s goodwill exceeds its implied fair value, goodwill is deemed impaired and is written down to the extent of the difference. As a result, we impaired the value of our goodwill by $604 million during the third quarter of 2010.

 

F-41


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

5. Goodwill and Acquired Intangible Assets (Continued)

 

Acquired Intangible Assets

Acquired intangible assets include the following:

 

 

     As of December 31, 2011      As of December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Cost
Basis(1)
     Accumulated
Impairment  and
Amortization(1)
    Net      Cost
Basis(1)
     Accumulated
Impairment  and
Amortization(1)
    Net  

Intangible assets subject to amortization:

               

Customer, services and lending relationships

   $ 303       $ (253   $ 50       $ 298       $ (231   $ 67   

Software and technology

     93         (93     —           93         (91     2   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total intangible assets subject to amortization

     396         (346     50         391         (322     69   

Intangible assets not subject to amortization:

               

Trade names and trademarks

     54         (31     23         54         (31     23   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total acquired intangible assets

   $ 450       $ (377   $ 73       $ 445       $ (353   $ 92   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Accumulated impairment and amortization includes impairment amounts only if a portion of the acquired intangible asset has been deemed partially impaired. When an acquired intangible asset is considered fully impaired, and no longer in use, the cost basis and any accumulated amortization related to the asset is written off.

We recorded amortization of acquired intangible assets from continuing operations totaling $24 million, $39 million, and $38 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. We recorded amortization of acquired intangible assets from discontinued operations totaling $0, $0 and $1 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. We will continue to amortize our intangible assets with definite useful lives over their remaining estimated useful lives. We estimate amortization expense associated with these intangible assets will be $17 million, $12 million, $10 million, $7 million and $3 million for the years ended December 31, 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015 and 2016, respectively.

As discussed in “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies,” we test our indefinite life intangible assets annually as of October 1 or during the course of the year if an event occurs or circumstances change which indicate potential impairment of these assets. As of October 1, 2011, the fair value of the indefinite life intangible assets exceeds their carrying value. Accordingly, we recorded no impairment. We also assess whether an event or circumstance has occurred which may indicate impairment of its definite life (amortizing) intangible assets quarterly. During 2011, no such events or circumstances occurred that indicated our definite life intangible assets may be impaired.

In the third quarter of 2010, we recorded impairment of certain acquired intangible assets from continuing operations of $53 million related to the Upromise reporting unit and $3 million related to the Consumer Lending reportable segment.

In the fourth quarter of 2009, we recorded impairment of certain acquired intangible assets from continuing operations of $34 million related to the Guarantor Services reporting unit and $3 million related to the FFELP Loans reportable segment.

 

F-42


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings

Borrowings consist of secured borrowings issued through our securitization program, borrowings through secured facilities and participation programs, unsecured notes issued by us, term and other deposits at the Bank, and other interest-bearing liabilities related primarily to obligations to return cash collateral held. To match the interest rate and currency characteristics of our borrowings with the interest rate and currency characteristics of our assets, we enter into interest rate and foreign currency swaps with independent parties. Under these agreements, we make periodic payments, generally indexed to the related asset rates or rates which are highly correlated to the asset rates, in exchange for periodic payments which generally match our interest obligations on fixed or variable rate notes (see “Note 7 — Derivative Financial Instruments”). Payments and receipts on our interest rate and currency swaps are not reflected in the following tables.

The following table summarizes our borrowings.

 

 

     December 31, 2011      December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Short
Term
     Long
Term
     Total      Short
Term
     Long
Term
     Total  

Unsecured borrowings:

                 

Senior unsecured debt

   $ 1,801       $ 15,199       $ 17,000       $ 4,361       $ 15,742       $ 20,103   

Brokered deposits

     1,733         1,956         3,689         1,387         3,160         4,547   

Retail and other deposits

     2,123                 2,123         1,370                 1,370   

Other(1)

     1,329                 1,329         887                 887   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total unsecured borrowings

     6,986         17,155         24,141         8,005         18,902         26,907   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Secured borrowings:

                 

FFELP Loans securitizations

             107,905         107,905                 113,671         113,671   

Private Education Loans securitizations

             19,297         19,297                 21,409         21,409   

ED Conduit Program Facility

     21,313                 21,313         24,484                 24,484   

FFELP ABCP Facility

             4,445         4,445                 5,853         5,853   

Private Education Loans ABCP Facility

             1,992         1,992                           

Acquisition financing(2)

             916         916                 1,064         1,064   

FHLB-DM Facility

     1,210                 1,210         900                 900   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total secured borrowings

     22,523         134,555         157,078         25,384         141,997         167,381   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total before hedge accounting adjustments

     29,509         151,710         181,219         33,389         160,899         194,288   

Hedge accounting adjustments

     64         2,683         2,747         227         2,644         2,871   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 29,573       $ 154,393       $ 183,966       $ 33,616       $ 163,543       $ 197,159   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

“Other” primarily consists of the obligation to return cash collateral held related to derivative exposures.

 

(2) 

Relates to the acquisition of $25 billion of student loans at the end of 2010.

 

F-43


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

Short-term Borrowings

Short-term borrowings have a remaining term to maturity of one year or less. The following tables summarize outstanding short-term borrowings (secured and unsecured), the weighted average interest rates at the end of each period, and the related average balances and weighted average interest rates during the periods. Rates reflect stated interest of borrowings and related discounts and premiums.

 

 

     December 31, 2011     Year Ended December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

   Ending Balance      Weighted Average
Interest Rate
    Average Balance      Weighted Average
Interest Rate
 

Brokered deposits

   $ 1,733         2.80   $ 1,489         3.17

Retail and other deposits

     2,123         1.00        1,684         1.11   

FHLB-DM Facility

     1,210         .24        893         .25   

ED Conduit Program facility

     21,313         .67        22,869         .75   

FFELP ABCP Facility

                    221         1.01   

Senior unsecured debt

     1,865         4.37        3,070         2.97   

Other interest bearing liabilities

     1,329         .04        1,187         .10   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total short-term borrowings

   $ 29,573         1.01   $ 31,413         1.06
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Maximum outstanding at any month end

   $ 33,100           
  

 

 

         

 

     December 31, 2010     Year Ended December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Ending Balance      Weighted Average
Interest Rate
    Average Balance      Weighted Average
Interest Rate
 

Brokered deposits

   $ 1,387         2.57   $ 1,424         3.00

Retail and other deposits

     1,370         1.28        643         1.16   

FHLB-DM Facility

     900         .30        403         .35   

ED Participation Program Facility

                    13,537         .80   

ED Conduit Program facility

     24,484         .55        15,096         .71   

FFELP ABCP Facility

                    1,767         1.40   

Senior unsecured debt

     4,588         2.28        4,603         2.82   

Other interest bearing liabilities

     887         .14        1,161         .19   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total short-term borrowings

   $ 33,616         .88   $ 38,634         1.10
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Maximum outstanding at any month end

   $ 46,472           
  

 

 

         

 

F-44


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

Long-term Borrowings

The following tables summarize outstanding long-term borrowings (secured and unsecured), the weighted average interest rates at the end of the periods, and the related average balances during the periods. Rates reflect stated interest rate of borrowings and related discounts and premiums.

 

 

     December 31, 2011     Year Ended
December 31,
2011
 
           

Weighted

Average

   

(Dollars in millions)

   Ending
Balance(1)
     Interest
Rate(2)
    Average
Balance
 

Floating rate notes:

       

U.S. dollar-denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2013-2047

   $ 114,861         1.21   $ 120,045   

Non-U.S. dollar-denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2013-2041

     11,838         1.77        11,872   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total floating rate notes

     126,699         1.26        131,917   

Fixed rate notes:

       

U.S. dollar-denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2013-2044

     14,406         5.63        12,363   

Non-U.S.-dollar denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2013-2039

     3,934         3.58        3,662   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total fixed rate notes

     18,340         5.18        16,025   

Brokered deposits — U.S. dollar-denominated, due 2013-2014

     2,001         3.15        2,171   

FFELP ABCP Facility

     4,445         .81        4,768   

Private Education Loans ABCP Facility

     1,992         1.40        272   

SLC acquisition financing

     916         4.79        998   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long-term borrowings

   $ 154,393         1.75   $ 156,151   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

Ending balance is expressed in U.S. dollars using the spot currency exchange rate. Includes fair value adjustments under ASC 815 for notes designated as the hedged item in a fair value hedge.

 

  (2)

Weighted average interest rate is stated rate relative to currency denomination of debt.

 

 

F-45


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

 

     December 31, 2010     Year Ended
December 31,
2010
 
           

Weighted

Average

   

(Dollars in millions)

   Ending
Balance(1)
     Interest
Rate(2)
    Average
Balance
 

Floating rate notes:

       

U.S. dollar-denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2012-2047

   $ 124,053         1.12   $ 112,910   

Non-U.S. dollar-denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2012-2041

     11,999         1.26        12,125   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total floating rate notes

     136,052         1.13        125,035   

Fixed rate notes:

       

U.S. dollar-denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2012-2043

     11,873         5.87        10,918   

Non-U.S.-dollar denominated:

       

Interest bearing, due 2012-2039

     5,485         3.35        6,257   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total fixed rate notes

     17,358         5.06        17,175   

Brokered deposits — U.S. dollar-denominated, due 2012-2019

     3,216         3.40        3,699   

FFELP ABCP Facility

     5,853         .81        4,855   

SLC acquisition financing

     1,064         4.76        3   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total long-term borrowings

   $ 163,543         1.60   $ 150,767   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

Ending balance is expressed in U.S. dollars using the spot currency exchange rate. Includes fair value adjustments under ASC 815 for notes designated as the hedged item in a fair value hedge.

 

  (2)

Weighted average interest rate is stated rate relative to currency denomination of debt.

 

F-46


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

At December 31, 2011, we had outstanding long-term borrowings with call features totaling $5.1 billion. In addition, we have $7.4 billion of prepayable debt related to our ABCP and acquisition financing facilities. Generally, these instruments are callable at the par amount. As of December 31, 2011, the stated maturities and maturities if accelerated to the call dates are shown in the following table:

 

 

    December 31, 2011  
    Stated Maturity(1)     Maturity to Call Date(1)  

(Dollars in millions)

  Senior
Unsecured
Debt
    Brokered
Deposits
    Secured
Borrowings
    Total(2)     Senior
Unsecured
Debt
    Brokered
Deposits
    Secured
Borrowings
    Total  

Year of Maturity

               

2012

  $      $      $ 12,795      $ 12,795      $ 1,583      $      $ 19,819      $ 21,402   

2013

    2,320        948        13,897        17,165        2,311        948        11,488        14,747   

2014

    3,034        1,008        13,036        17,078        3,160        1,008        10,008        14,176   

2015

    711               9,628        10,339        800               9,103        9,903   

2016

    2,301               9,321        11,622        2,301               9,035        11,336   

2017-2047

    6,833               75,878        82,711        5,044               75,102        80,146   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 
    15,199        1,956        134,555        151,710        15,199        1,956        134,555        151,710   

Hedge accounting adjustments

    1,744        45        894        2,683        1,744        45        894        2,683   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

  $ 16,943      $ 2,001      $ 135,449      $ 154,393      $ 16,943      $ 2,001      $ 135,449      $ 154,393   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

We view our securitization trust debt as long-term based on the contractual maturity dates and projecting the expected principal paydowns based on our current estimates regarding loan prepayment speeds. The projected principal paydowns in year 2012 include $12.8 billion related to the securitization trust debt.

 

(2)

The aggregate principal amount of debt that matures in each period is $12.9 billion in 2012, $17.3 billion in 2013, $17.2 billion in 2014, $10.4 billion in 2015, $11.7 billion in 2016, and $83.3 billion in 2017-2047.

Secured Borrowings

VIEs are required to be consolidated by their primary beneficiaries. The criteria to be considered the primary beneficiary changed on January 1, 2010 (see “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies — Consolidation” for further discussion).

 

F-47


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

We currently consolidate all of our financing entities that are VIEs as a result of being the entities’ primary beneficiary. As a result, these financing VIEs are accounted for as secured borrowings. We consolidate the following financing VIEs as of December 31, 2011 and 2010:

 

 

     December 31, 2011  
     Debt Outstanding      Carrying Amount of Assets Securing Debt
Outstanding
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Short
Term
     Long
Term
     Total      Loans      Cash      Other Assets      Total  

Secured Borrowings — VIEs:

                    

ED Conduit Program Facility

   $ 21,313       $       $ 21,313       $ 21,445       $ 621       $ 442       $ 22,508   

FFELP ABCP Facility

             4,445         4,445         4,834         86         54         4,974   

Private Education Loans ABCP Facility

             1,992         1,992         2,595         401         76         3,072   

Securitizations — FFELP Loans

             107,905         107,905         109,257         3,783         529         113,569   

Securitizations — Private Education Loans

             19,297         19,297         22,367         718         582         23,667   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total before hedge accounting adjustments

     21,313         133,639         154,952         160,498         5,609         1,683         167,790   

Hedge accounting adjustments

             894         894                         955         955   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 21,313       $ 134,533       $ 155,846       $ 160,498       $ 5,609       $ 2,638       $ 168,745   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

     December 31, 2010  
     Debt Outstanding      Carrying Amount of Assets Securing Debt
Outstanding
 

(Dollars in millions)

   Short
Term
     Long
Term
     Total      Loans      Cash      Other Assets      Total  

Secured Borrowings — VIEs:

                    

ED Conduit Program Facility

   $ 24,484       $       $ 24,484       $ 24,511       $ 819       $ 634       $ 25,964   

FFELP ABCP Facility

             5,853         5,853         6,290         94         53         6,437   

Securitizations — FFELP Loans

             113,671         113,671         114,949         3,857         981         119,787   

Securitizations — Private Education Loans

             21,409         21,409         24,355         1,213         690         26,258   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total before hedge accounting adjustments

     24,484         140,933         165,417         170,105         5,983         2,358         178,446   

Hedge accounting adjustments

             1,311         1,311                         1,348         1,348   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 24,484       $ 142,244       $ 166,728       $ 170,105       $ 5,983       $ 3,706       $ 179,794   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

The Department of Education Funding Programs

In August 2008, ED implemented the Purchase Program and the Participation Program pursuant to ECASLA. Under the Purchase Program, ED purchased eligible FFELP Loans at a price equal to the sum of (i) par value, (ii) accrued interest, (iii) the one-percent origination fee paid to ED, and (iv) a fixed amount of $75

 

F-48


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

per loan. Under the Participation Program, ED provided short-term liquidity to FFELP lenders by purchasing participation interests in pools of FFELP Loans. FFELP lenders were charged a rate equal to the preceding quarter commercial paper rate plus 0.50 percent on the principal amount of participation interests outstanding. Loans eligible for the Participation or Purchase Programs were limited to FFELP Stafford or PLUS Loans, first disbursed on or after May 1, 2008 but no later than July 1, 2010, with no ongoing borrower benefits other than permitted rate reductions of 0.25 percent for automatic payment processing. In October 2010, we sold $20.4 billion of loans to ED and paid off $20.3 billion of advances outstanding under the Participation Program. This program is no longer in effect and is not available as a source of funding.

Also pursuant to ECASLA, on January 15, 2009, ED announced they would purchase eligible FFELP Stafford and PLUS Loans from a conduit vehicle established to provide funding for eligible student lenders (the “ED Conduit Program”). Loans eligible for the ED Conduit Program must be first disbursed on or after October 1, 2003, but not later than July 1, 2009, and fully disbursed before September 30, 2009, and meet certain other requirements, including those relating to borrower benefits. The ED Conduit Program was launched on May 11, 2009 and accepted eligible loans through July 1, 2010. The ED Conduit Program expires on January 19, 2014. Funding for the ED Conduit Program is provided by the capital markets at a cost based on market rates, with us being advanced 97 percent of the student loan face amount. If the conduit does not have sufficient funds to make the required payments on the notes issued by the conduit, then the notes will be repaid with funds from the Federal Financing Bank (“FFB”). The FFB will hold the notes for a short period of time and, if at the end of that time, the notes still cannot be paid off, the underlying FFELP Loans that serve as collateral to the ED Conduit will be sold to ED through a put agreement at a price of 97 percent of the face amount of the loans. Our intent is to term securitize the loans in the facility before the facility expires. Any loans that remain in the facility as of the expiration date will be sold to ED at a price of 97 percent of the face amount of the loans. As of December 31, 2011, approximately $21.4 billion face amount of our Stafford and PLUS Loans were funded through the ED Conduit Program.

Asset-Backed Financing Facilities

FFELP ABCP Facility

During the first quarter of 2008, we entered into two new asset-backed financing facilities (the “2008 Asset-Backed Financing Facilities”) to fund FFELP and Private Education Loans. In 2009, the FFELP facilities were subsequently amended and reduced and the Private Education facility was retired. On January 15, 2010, we terminated the 2008 Asset-Backed Financing Facilities for FFELP and entered into new multi-year ABCP facilities (the “FFELP ABCP Facility”) which will continue to provide funding for our FFELP Loans.

On January 14, 2011, we amended the FFELP ABCP Facility extending the step-down dates and final term of the facility. The amendment extended the scheduled maturity date to January 10, 2014 and increased the facility size to $7.5 billion, which reflected a $2.5 billion increase over the previously scheduled facility reduction. We paid an extension fee of $2 million. The usage fee for the amended FFELP ABCP Facility remained unchanged at 0.50 percent over the applicable funding rate. In addition, the amended facility extended the step-down dates to $5.0 billion on January 13, 2012 and to $2.5 billion on January 11, 2013.

On January 13, 2012, we amended the FFELP ABCP Facility extending the step-down dates on the amount available for borrowing and the final maturity date of the facility, which will continue to provide funding for our FFELP Loans. The facility amount is now $7.5 billion, reflecting an increase of $2.5 billion over the previously scheduled facility reduction. The scheduled maturity date of the facility is January 9, 2015. We paid an extension fee of $2 million. The usage fee for the facility remains unchanged at 0.50 percent over the applicable funding

 

F-49


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

rate. The amended facility features two contractual step-down reductions on the amount available for borrowing. The first reduction is on January 11, 2013, to $6.5 billion. The second reduction is on January 10, 2014, to $5.5 billion.

Our borrowings under the FFELP ABCP Facility are non-recourse. The maximum amount we may borrow under the FFELP ABCP Facility is limited based on certain factors, including market conditions and the fair value of student loans in the facility. In addition to the funding limits described above, funding under the FFELP ABCP Facility is subject to usual and customary conditions. The FFELP ABCP Facility is subject to termination under certain circumstances. In addition, the facility has financial covenants that if not maintained, will cause the facility to become an amortizing facility. The covenants are, however, curable. The principal financial covenants require us to maintain consolidated tangible net worth of at least $1.38 billion at all times. Consolidated tangible net worth as calculated for purposes of this covenant was $3.5 billion as of December 31, 2011. The covenants also require us to meet either a minimum interest coverage ratio or a minimum net adjusted revenue test based on the four preceding quarters’ adjusted “Core Earnings” financial performance. We were compliant with both of the minimum interest coverage ratio and the minimum net adjusted revenue tests as of the quarter ended December 31, 2011. Increases in the borrowing rate of up to LIBOR plus 4.50 percent could occur if certain asset coverage ratio thresholds are not met. If liquidity agreements are not renewed on the trigger dates, the usage fee increases to 1.00 percent over the applicable funding rate on January 11, 2013 and 1.50 percent over the applicable funding rate on January 10, 2014. Failure to pay off the FFELP ABCP Facility on the maturity date or to reduce amounts outstanding below the annual maximum step downs will result in a 90-day extension of the facility with the interest rate increasing from LIBOR plus 2.00 percent to LIBOR plus 3.00 percent over that period. If, at the end of the 90-day extension, these required paydown amounts have not been made, the collateral can be foreclosed upon. As of December 31, 2011, there was approximately $4.4 billion outstanding in this facility. The book basis of the assets securing this facility at December 31, 2011 was $5.0 billion.

Private Education Loan ABCP Facility

On October 5, 2011, we closed on a $3.4 billion asset-backed commercial paper facility, which matures in January 2014, to fund the call of certain Private Education Loan trust securities issued under the TALF program. We paid an upfront fee of $8 million. The cost of borrowing under the facility is expected to be commercial paper issuance cost plus 1.10 percent, excluding up-front commitment and unused fees. The maximum amount that can be financed steps down to $2.5 billion on July 25, 2012, $1.7 billion on January 25, 2013 and $0.8 billion on July 25, 2013 with final maturity on January 27, 2014. If the amount outstanding is greater than the maximum amount at any step down, the cost increases to commercial paper issuance cost plus 1.95 percent. Our borrowings under the facility are non-recourse. On November 15, 2011, the facility provided the financing to call the outstanding securities issued by SLM Private Education Loan Trust 2009-B ($2.5 billion principal) at its call price of 93 percent of par. On January 17, 2012 the facility was also used to call the outstanding securities issued by SLM Private Education Loan Trust 2009-C ($1.0 billion principal) at its call price of 94 percent of par. At December 31, 2011, there was $2.0 billion outstanding in this facility. The book basis of the assets securing the facility at December 31, 2011 was $3.1 billion.

SLC Acquisition Financing

On December 31, 2010, we closed on our agreement to purchase an interest in $26.1 billion of securitized federal student loans and related assets from the Student Loan Corporation (“SLC”), a subsidiary of Citibank, N.A. The purchase price was approximately $1.1 billion. The transaction was funded by a 5-year term loan provided by Citibank in an amount equal to the purchase price. The loan is secured by the purchased assets and guaranteed by us. The loan bears interest at a rate of LIBOR plus 4.50 percent, and is subject to scheduled quarterly principal payments of the lesser of (i) 2.5 percent of the original principal amount of the term loan or

 

F-50


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

(ii) the residual cash flow derived from the assets securing the loan. In addition, the remaining balance is due on December 31, 2015. Residual cash flow in excess of that needed to make quarterly principal payments is restricted but we are permitted, at our option, to prepay the obligation, in whole or in part, at any time without penalty.

Securitizations

The following table summarizes the securitization transactions issued in 2010 and 2011.

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

            

AAA-rated bonds

Issue

  Date Issued    Total
Issued
   

Cost of Funds

  Weighted
Average
Life

FFELP:

        

2010-1

  April 2010    $ 1,222      1 month LIBOR plus 0.46%   3.3 years

2010-2

  August 2010      760      1 month LIBOR plus 0.56%   4.3 years
    

 

 

     

Total bonds issued in 2010

     $ 1,982       
    

 

 

     

Total loan amount securitized in 2010

     $ 1,965       
    

 

 

     

2011-1

  March 2011    $ 812      1 month LIBOR plus 0.89%   5.5 years

2011-2

  May 2011      821      1 month LIBOR plus 0.94%   5.5 years

2011-3

  November 2011      812 (1)    1 month LIBOR plus 1.28%   7.8 years
    

 

 

     

Total bonds issued in 2011

     $ 2,445       
    

 

 

     

Total loan amount securitized in 2011

     $ 2,344       
    

 

 

     

Private Education:

        

2010-A

  March 2010      1,550      1 month LIBOR plus  3.29%(2)   4.1 years

2010-B

  July 2010      869      1 month LIBOR plus 1.98%   0.9 years

2010-C

  July 2010      1,701      1 month LIBOR plus 2.33%   1.8 years
    

 

 

     

Total bonds issued in 2010

     $ 4,120       
    

 

 

     

Total loan amount securitized in 2010

     $ 6,186       
    

 

 

     

2011-A

  April 2011    $ 562      1 month LIBOR plus 1.99%   3.8 years

2011-B

  June 2011      825      1 month LIBOR plus 1.89%   4.0 years

2011-C

  November 2011      721      1 month LIBOR plus 2.99%   3.4 years
    

 

 

     

Total bonds issued in 2011

     $ 2,108       
    

 

 

     

Total loan amount securitized in 2011

     $ 2,674       
    

 

 

     

 

(1) 

Total size excludes subordinated tranche that was retained at issuance totaling $24 million.

(2) 

Cost of funds expressed on a LIBOR-equivalent basis assuming a Prime/LIBOR spread of 2.75 percent on the $149 million of Prime-indexed bonds.

2012 Transactions

On January 19, 2012, we issued a $765 million FFELP ABS transaction. The AAA bonds were priced at one-month LIBOR plus 0.96 percent with a weighted average life of 4.6 years.

On February 9, 2012, we issued $547 million of Private Education Loan ABS. The AAA bonds were priced at one-month LIBOR plus 2.32 percent with a weighted average life of 3 years.

Auction Rate Securities

At December 31, 2011, we had $3.9 billion of auction rate securities outstanding in securitizations. Since February 2008, problems in the auction rate securities market as a whole led to failures of the auctions pursuant to which certain of our auction rate securities’ interest rates are set. As a result, $3.3 billion of our auction rate

 

F-51


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

securities as of December 31, 2011 bore interest at the maximum rate allowable under their terms. The maximum allowable interest rate on our taxable auction rate securities is generally LIBOR plus 1.50 percent to 3.50 percent, dependant on the security’s credit rating. The maximum allowable interest rate on many of our tax-exempt auction rate securities is a formula driven rate, which produced various maximum rates up to 0.53 percent during the fourth quarter of 2011. As of December 31, 2011, $0.6 billion of auction rate securities with shorter weighted average terms to maturity have had successful auctions, resulting in an average rate of 1.70 percent.

Reset Rate Notes

Certain tranches of our term ABS are reset rate notes. Reset rate notes are subject to periodic remarketing, at which time the interest rates on the notes are reset. We also have the option to repurchase a reset rate note upon a failed remarketing and hold it as an investment until such time it can be remarketed. In the event a reset rate note cannot be remarketed on the remarketing date, and is not repurchased, the interest rate generally steps up to and remains at LIBOR plus 0.75 percent until such time as the bonds are successfully remarketed or repurchased. Our repurchase of a reset rate note requires additional funding, the availability and pricing of which may be less favorable to us than it was at the time the reset rate note was originally issued. Unlike the repurchase of a reset rate note, the occurrence of a failed remarketing does not require additional funding. As a result of the ongoing dislocation in the capital markets, at December 31, 2011, $6.2 billion of our reset rate notes bore interest at, or were swapped to LIBOR plus 0.75 percent due to a failed remarketing. Until capital markets conditions improve, it is possible these and additional reset rate notes will experience failed remarketings. As of December 31, 2011, we had $7.0 billion and $1.5 billion of reset rate notes due to be newly remarketed in 2012 and 2013, respectively, and an additional $4.2 billion to be newly remarked thereafter.

Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines (“FHLB-DM”)

On January 15, 2010, HICA Education Loan Corporation (“HICA”), our subsidiary, entered into a borrowing agreement with the FHLB-DM. Under the agreement, the FHLB-DM will provide advances backed by Federal Housing Finance Agency approved collateral which includes FFELP Loans (but does not include Private Education Loans). The facility is available as long as we maintain membership with FHLB-DM. The amount, price and tenor of future advances will vary and be subject to the agreement’s borrowing conditions as then in effect determined at the time of each borrowing. The maximum amount that can be borrowed, as of December 31, 2011, subject to available collateral, is approximately $8.4 billion. As of December 31, 2011, borrowing under the facility totaled $1.2 billion, and matures by February 15, 2012, and was secured by $1.4 billion of FFELP Loans. We have provided a guarantee to the FHLB-DM for the performance and payment of HICA’s obligations.

Other Funding Sources

Sallie Mae Bank

During the fourth quarter of 2008, the Bank, our Utah industrial bank subsidiary, began expanding its deposit base to fund new Private Education Loan originations. The Bank raises deposits through intermediaries in the brokered Certificate of Deposit (“CD”) market and through direct retail deposit channels. As of December 31, 2011, bank deposits totaled $6.3 billion of which $3.7 billion were brokered term deposits, $2.1 billion were retail and other deposits and $453 million were deposits from affiliates that eliminate in our consolidated balance sheet. Cash and liquid investments totaled $1.5 billion as of December 31, 2011.

In addition to its deposit base, the Bank has borrowing capacity with the Federal Reserve Bank (“FRB”) through a collateralized lending facility. FRB is not obligated to lend; however, in general we can borrow as long

 

F-52


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

as the Bank is generally in sound financial condition. Borrowing capacity is limited by the availability of acceptable collateral. As of December 31, 2011, borrowing capacity was approximately $793 million and there were no outstanding borrowings.

Senior Unsecured Debt

In 2010, we issued $1.5 billion of senior unsecured notes that bear a coupon of 8.00 percent. The notes were swapped to LIBOR with an all-in cost of LIBOR plus 4.65 percent.

On January 14, 2011, we issued a $2 billion five-year 6.25 percent fixed rate unsecured bond. The bond was issued to yield 6.50 percent before underwriting fees. The rate on the bond was swapped from a fixed rate to a floating rate equal to an all-in cost of one-month LIBOR plus 4.46 percent. The proceeds of this bond were designated for general corporate purposes.

On January 27, 2012, we issued a two-part, $1.5 billion deal featuring five-year and 10-year unsecured bonds. The 6.00 percent fixed rate five-year bond was issued for $750 million to yield 6.25 percent before underwriting fees. The rate on the bond was swapped from a fixed rate to a floating rate equal to an all-in cost of one-month LIBOR plus 5.2 percent. The 7.25 percent fixed rate 10-year bond was issued for $750 million to yield 7.50 percent before underwriting fees. The rate on the bond was swapped from a fixed rate to a floating rate equal to an all-in cost of one-month LIBOR plus 5.4 percent. The proceeds of these bonds were designated for general corporate purposes.

The following table summarizes activity related to the senior unsecured debt repurchases. “Gains on debt repurchases” is shown net of hedging-related gains and losses.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
(Dollars in millions)    2011      2010      2009  

Unsecured debt principal repurchased

   $ 894       $ 4,868       $ 3,447   

Gains on debt repurchases

     38         317         536   

Unsecured Revolving Credit Facility

In 2010, we terminated our $1.6 billion revolving credit facility that was scheduled to mature in October 2011.

 

F-53


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

6. Borrowings (Continued)

 

Retained Interest in Securitized Receivables

The following tables summarize the fair value of our Residual Interests, included in our Retained Interest (and the assumptions used to value such Residual Interests), along with the underlying off-balance sheet student loans that relate to those securitizations in transactions that were treated as sales as of December 31, 2009. As noted previously, the Residual Interest was removed from the balance sheet on January 1, 2010.

 

 

     As of December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   FFELP
Stafford and
PLUS
    Consolidation
Loan
Trusts(1)
    Private
Education
Loan Trusts
    Total  

Fair value of Residual Interests

   $ 243      $ 791      $ 794      $ 1,828   

Underlying securitized loan balance

     5,377        14,369        12,986        32,732   

Weighted average life Prepayment speed (annual rate)(2):

     3.3 yrs.        9.0 yrs.        6.3 yrs.     

Prepayment speed (annual rate)(2):

        

Interim status

     0     N/A        0  

Repayment status

     0-14     2-4     2-15  

Life-of-loan — repayment status

     9     3     6  

Expected remaining credit losses (% of outstanding student loan principal)(3)(4)

     .10     .25     5.31  

Residual cash flows discount rate

     10.6     12.3     27.5  

 

  (1) 

Includes $569 million related to the fair value of the Embedded Floor Income as of December 31, 2009.

 

  (2) 

We used Constant Prepayment Rate (“CPR”) curves for Residual Interest valuations that were based on seasoning (the number of months since entering repayment). Under this methodology, a different CPR was applied to each year of a loan’s seasoning. Repayment status CPR used was based on the number of months since first entering repayment (seasoning). Life-of-loan CPR is related to repayment status only and does not include the impact of the loan while in interim status. The CPR assumption used for all periods includes the impact of projected defaults.

 

  (3)

Remaining expected credit losses as of the respective balance sheet date.

 

  (4) 

For Private Education Loan trusts, estimated defaults from settlement to maturity are 12.2 percent at December 31, 2009. These estimated defaults do not include recoveries related to defaults but do include prior purchases of loans at par by us when loans reached 180 days delinquent (prior to default) under a contingent call option. Although these loan purchases do not result in a realized loss to the trust, we have included them here. Not including these purchases in the disclosure would result in estimated defaults of 9.3 percent at December 31, 2009.

 

7. Derivative Financial Instruments

Risk Management Strategy

We maintain an overall interest rate risk management strategy that incorporates the use of derivative instruments to minimize the economic effect of interest rate changes. Our goal is to manage interest rate sensitivity by modifying the repricing frequency and underlying index characteristics of certain balance sheet assets and liabilities so the net interest margin is not, on a material basis, adversely affected by movements in interest rates. We do not use derivative instruments to hedge credit risk associated with debt we issued. As a result of interest rate fluctuations, hedged assets and liabilities will appreciate or depreciate in market value. Income or loss on the derivative instruments that are linked to the hedged assets and liabilities will generally offset the effect of this unrealized appreciation or depreciation for the period the item is being hedged. We view this strategy as a prudent management of interest rate sensitivity. In addition, we utilize derivative contracts to minimize the economic impact of changes in foreign currency exchange rates on certain debt obligations that are denominated in foreign currencies. As foreign currency exchange rates fluctuate, these liabilities will appreciate and depreciate in value. These fluctuations, to the extent the hedge relationship is effective, are offset by changes in the value of the cross-currency interest rate swaps executed to hedge these instruments. Management believes

 

F-54


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

7. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

 

certain derivative transactions entered into as hedges, primarily Floor Income Contracts, basis swaps and Eurodollar futures contracts, are economically effective; however, those transactions generally do not qualify for hedge accounting under GAAP (as discussed below) and thus may adversely impact earnings.

Although we use derivatives to offset (or minimize) the risk of interest rate and foreign currency changes, the use of derivatives does expose us to both market and credit risk. Market risk is the chance of financial loss resulting from changes in interest rates, foreign exchange rates and market liquidity. Credit risk is the risk that a counterparty will not perform its obligations under a contract and it is limited to the loss of the fair value gain in a derivative that the counterparty owes us. When the fair value of a derivative contract is negative, we owe the counterparty and, therefore, have no credit risk exposure to the counterparty; however, the counterparty has exposure to us. We minimize the credit risk in derivative instruments by entering into transactions with highly rated counterparties that are reviewed regularly by our Credit Department. We also maintain a policy of requiring that all derivative contracts be governed by an International Swaps and Derivative Association Master Agreement. Depending on the nature of the derivative transaction, bilateral collateral arrangements generally are required as well. When we have more than one outstanding derivative transaction with the counterparty, and there exists legally enforceable netting provisions with the counterparty (i.e., a legal right to offset receivable and payable derivative contracts), the “net” mark-to-market exposure, less collateral the counterparty has posted to us, represents exposure with the counterparty. When there is a net negative exposure, we consider our exposure to the counterparty to be zero. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, we had a net positive exposure (derivative gain positions to us less collateral which has been posted by counterparties to us) related to SLM Corporation and the Bank derivatives of $113 million and $296 million, respectively.

Our on-balance sheet securitization trusts have $13.6 billion of Euro and British Pound Sterling denominated bonds outstanding as of December 31, 2011. To convert these non-U.S. dollar denominated bonds into U.S dollar liabilities, the trusts have entered into foreign-currency swaps with highly–rated counterparties. In addition, the trusts have entered into $13.8 billion of interest rates swaps which are primarily used to convert Prime received on securitized student loans to LIBOR paid on the bonds. At December 31, 2011, the net positive exposure on swaps in securitization trusts is $807 million. Current turmoil in the European markets has led to increased disclosure of exposure in those markets. Of the total net exposure, $691 million of the net exposure is related to financial institutions located in France. Of this amount, $498 million carries a guarantee from the French government. $690 million of the $691 million exposure relates to derivatives held at our securitization trusts. Counterparties to these derivatives are required to post collateral when their credit rating is withdrawn or downgraded below a certain level. As of December 31, 2011, no collateral was required to be posted. As discussed below, adjustments are made to our derivative valuations for counterparty credit risk based on market credit default swap spreads. The adjustments made at December 31, 2011 related to derivatives with French financial institutions (including those that carry a guarantee from the French government) decreased the derivative asset value by $179 million. Credit risks for all derivative counterparties are assessed internally on a continual basis.

Accounting for Derivative Instruments

Derivative instruments that are used as part of our interest rate and foreign currency risk management strategy include interest rate swaps, basis swaps, cross-currency interest rate swaps, interest rate futures contracts, and interest rate floor and cap contracts with indices that relate to the pricing of specific balance sheet assets and liabilities. The accounting for derivative instruments requires that every derivative instrument, including certain derivative instruments embedded in other contracts, be recorded on the balance sheet as either an asset or liability measured at its fair value. As more fully described below, if certain criteria are met, derivative instruments are classified and accounted for by us as either fair value or cash flow hedges. If these criteria are not met, the derivative financial instruments are accounted for as trading.

 

F-55


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

7. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

 

Fair Value Hedges

Fair value hedges are generally used by us to hedge the exposure to changes in fair value of a recognized fixed rate asset or liability. We enter into interest rate swaps to economically convert fixed rate assets into variable rate assets and fixed rate debt into variable rate debt. We also enter into cross-currency interest rate swaps to economically convert foreign currency denominated fixed and floating debt to U.S. dollar denominated variable debt. For fair value hedges, we generally consider all components of the derivative’s gain and/or loss when assessing hedge effectiveness and generally hedge changes in fair values due to interest rates or interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates or the total change in fair values.

Cash Flow Hedges

We use cash flow hedges to hedge the exposure to variability in cash flows for a forecasted debt issuance and for exposure to variability in cash flows of floating rate debt. This strategy is used primarily to minimize the exposure to volatility from future changes in interest rates. Gains and losses on the effective portion of a qualifying hedge are recorded in accumulated other comprehensive income and ineffectiveness is recorded immediately to earnings. In the case of a forecasted debt issuance, gains and losses are reclassified to earnings over the period which the stated hedged transaction affects earnings. If we determine it is not probable that the anticipated transaction will occur, gains and losses are reclassified immediately to earnings. In assessing hedge effectiveness, generally all components of each derivative’s gains or losses are included in the assessment. We generally hedge exposure to changes in cash flows due to changes in interest rates or total changes in cash flow.

Trading Activities

When derivative instruments do not qualify as hedges, they are accounted for as trading instruments where all changes in fair value are recorded through earnings. We sell interest rate floors (Floor Income Contracts) to hedge the Embedded Floor Income options in student loan assets. The Floor Income Contracts are written options which have a more stringent hedge effectiveness hurdle to meet. Specifically, our Floor Income Contracts do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment because the pay down of principal of the student loans underlying the Floor Income embedded in those student loans does not exactly match the change in the notional amount of our written Floor Income Contracts. Additionally, the term and the interest rate index of the Floor Income Contracts are different from that of the student loans. Therefore, Floor Income Contracts do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment, and are recorded as trading instruments. Regardless of the accounting treatment, we consider these contracts to be economic hedges for risk management purposes. We use this strategy to minimize our exposure to changes in interest rates.

We use basis swaps to minimize earnings variability caused by having different reset characteristics on our interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities. These swaps possess a term of up to 15 years with a pay rate indexed to 91-day Treasury bill, 52-week Treasury bill, LIBOR, Prime, Consumer Price Index or 1-year constant maturity Treasury rates. The specific terms and notional amounts of the swaps are determined based on a review of our asset/liability structure, our assessment of future interest rate relationships, and on other factors such as short-term strategic initiatives. Hedge accounting requires that when using basis swaps, the change in the cash flows of the hedge effectively offset both the change in the cash flows of the asset and the change in the cash flows of the liability. Our basis swaps hedge variable interest rate risk; however, they generally do not meet this effectiveness criterion because the index of the swap does not exactly match the index of the hedged assets. Additionally, some of our FFELP Loans can earn at either a variable or a fixed interest rate depending on market interest rates and, therefore, swaps economically hedging these FFELP Loans do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting treatment. As a result, these swaps are recorded at fair value with changes in fair value reflected currently in the statement of income.

 

F-56


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

7. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

 

Summary of Derivative Financial Statement Impact

The following tables summarize the fair values and notional amounts or number of contracts of all derivative instruments at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and their impact on other comprehensive income and earnings for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

Impact of Derivatives on Consolidated Balance Sheet

 

 

        Cash Flow     Fair Value     Trading     Total  

(Dollars in millions)

 

Hedged Risk

Exposure

  Dec. 31,
2011
    Dec. 31,
2010
    Dec. 31,
2011
    Dec. 31,
2010
    Dec. 31,
2011
    Dec. 31,
2010
    Dec. 31,
2011
    Dec. 31,
2010
 

Fair Values(1)

                 

Derivative Assets:

                 

Interest rate swaps

  Interest rate   $      $      $ 1,471      $ 967      $ 262      $ 200      $ 1,733      $ 1,167   

Cross currency interest rate swaps

  Foreign currency and interest rate                   1,229        1,925        130        101        1,359        2,026   

Other(2)

  Interest rate                                 1        26        1        26   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivative assets(3)

                    2,700        2,892        393        327        3,093        3,219   

Derivative Liabilities:

                 

Interest rate swaps

  Interest rate     (26     (75                   (244     (348     (270     (423

Floor Income Contracts

  Interest rate                                 (2,544     (1,315     (2,544     (1,315

Cross currency interest rate swaps

  Foreign currency and interest rate                   (243     (215                   (243     (215

Other(2)

  Interest rate                                        (1            (1
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivative liabilities(3)

      (26     (75     (243     (215     (2,788     (1,664     (3,057     (1,954
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net total derivatives

    $ (26   $ (75   $ 2,457      $ 2,677      $ (2,395   $ (1,337   $ 36      $ 1,265   
   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Fair values reported are exclusive of collateral held and pledged and accrued interest. Assets and liabilities are presented without consideration of master netting agreements. Derivatives are carried on the balance sheet based on net position by counterparty under master netting agreements, and classified in other assets or other liabilities depending on whether in a net positive or negative position.

 

(2) 

“Other” includes embedded derivatives bifurcated from securitization debt as well as derivatives related to our Total Return Swap Facility.

 

(3) 

The following table reconciles gross positions without the impact of master netting agreements to the balance sheet classification:

 

 

    Other Assets     Other Liabilities  

(Dollars in millions)

  December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
    December 31,
2011
    December 31,
2010
 

Gross position

  $ 3,093      $ 3,219      $ (3,057   $ (1,954

Impact of master netting agreements

    (891     (782     891        782   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Derivative values with impact of master netting agreements (as carried on balance sheet)

    2,202        2,437        (2,166     (1,172

Cash collateral (held) pledged

    (1,326     (886     1,018        809   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net position

  $ 876      $ 1,551      $ (1,148   $ (363
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The above fair values include adjustments for counterparty credit risk for both when we are exposed to the counterparty, net of collateral postings, and when the counterparty is exposed to us, net of collateral postings. The net adjustments decreased the overall net asset positions at December 31, 2011 and 2010 by $190 million and $72 million, respectively. In addition, the above fair values reflect adjustments for illiquid derivatives as

 

F-57


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

7. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

 

indicated by a wide bid/ask spread in the interest rate indices to which the derivatives are indexed. These adjustments decreased the overall net asset positions at December 31, 2011 and 2010 by $111 million and $129 million, respectively.

 

 

    Cash Flow     Fair Value     Trading     Total  

(Dollars in billions)

  Dec.  31,
2011
    Dec.  31,
2010
    Dec.  31,
2011
    Dec.  31,
2010
    Dec.  31,
2011
    Dec.  31,
2010
    Dec.  31,
2011
    Dec.  31,
2010
 

Notional Values:

               

Interest rate swaps

  $ 1.1      $ 1.6      $ 14.0      $ 13.5      $ 73.6      $ 118.9      $ 88.7      $ 134.0   

Floor Income Contracts

                                57.8        39.3        57.8        39.3   

Cross currency interest rate swaps

                  15.5        17.5        .3        .3        15.8        17.8   

Other(1)

                                1.4        1.0        1.4        1.0   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivatives

  $ 1.1      $ 1.6      $ 29.5      $ 31.0      $ 133.1      $ 159.5      $ 163.7      $ 192.1   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

“Other” includes embedded derivatives bifurcated from securitization debt, as well as derivatives related to our Total Return Swap Facility.

Impact of Derivatives on Consolidated Statements of Income

 

 

    Unrealized Gain
(Loss) on
Derivatives(1)(2)
    Realized Gain
(Loss) on
Derivatives(3)
    Unrealized Gain
(Loss) on
Hedged Item(1)
    Total Gain (Loss)  
     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

  2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009     2011     2010     2009  

Fair Value Hedges:

                       

Interest rate swaps

  $ 503      $ 289      $ (801   $ 481      $ 487      $ 403      $ (554   $ (334   $ 850      $ 430      $ 442      $ 452   

Cross currency interest rate swaps

    (723     (1,871     692        314        348        440        664        1,732        (934     255        209        198   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total fair value derivatives

    (220     (1,582     (109     795        835        843        110        1,398        (84     685        651        650   

Cash Flow Hedges:

                       

Interest rate swaps

    (1            2        (39     (58     (75                          (40     (58     (73
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total cash flow derivatives

    (1            2        (39     (58     (75                          (40     (58     (73

Trading:

                       

Interest rate swaps

    183        412        (526     69        11        433                             252        423        (93

Floor Income Contracts

    (267     156        483        (903     (888     (717                          (1,170     (732     (234

Cross currency interest rate swaps

    29        57        (26     8        7        4                             37        64        (22

Other

    22        37        (64     11        31                                    33        68        (64
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total trading derivatives

    (33     662        (133     (815     (839     (280                          (848     (177     (413
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

    (254     (920     (240     (59     (62     488        110        1,398        (84     (203     416        164   

Less: realized gains (losses) recorded in interest expense

                         756        777        768                             756        777        768   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net

  $ (254   $ (920   $ (240   $ (815   $ (839   $ (280   $ 110      $ 1,398      $ (84   $ (959   $ (361   $ (604
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Recorded in “Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net” in the consolidated statements of income.

 

(2) 

Represents ineffectiveness related to cash flow hedges.

 

(3) 

For fair value and cash flow hedges, recorded in interest expense. For trading derivatives, recorded in “Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net.”

 

F-58


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

7. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

 

Impact of Derivatives on Consolidated Statements of Changes in Stockholders’ Equity (net of tax)

 

 

    Years Ended
December 31,
 

(Dollars in millions)

  2011     2010     2009  

Total losses on cash flow hedges

  $ (4   $ (35   $ (22

Realized losses recognized in interest expense(1)(2)(3)

    35        40        63   

Hedge ineffectiveness reclassified to earnings(1)(4)

                  (1
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total change in stockholders’ equity due to gains (losses) on derivatives

  $ 31      $ 5      $ 40   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

     
  (1) 

Amounts included in “Realized gain (loss) on derivatives” in the “Impact of Derivatives on Consolidated Statements of Income” table above.

 

  (2) 

Includes net settlement income/expense.

 

  (3) 

We expect to reclassify $1 million of after-tax net losses from accumulated other comprehensive income to earnings during the next 12 months related to net settlement accruals on interest rate swaps.

 

  (4) 

Recorded in “Gains (losses) derivatives and hedging activities, net” in the consolidated statements of income.

Collateral

Collateral held and pledged related to derivative exposures between us and our derivative counterparties are detailed in the following table:

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   December 31,
2011
     December 31,
2010
 

Collateral held:

     

Cash (obligation to return cash collateral is recorded in short-term borrowings)(1)

   $ 1,326       $ 886   

Securities at fair value — on-balance sheet securitization derivatives (not recorded in financial statements)(2)

     841         585   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total collateral held

   $ 2,167       $ 1,471   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivative asset at fair value including accrued interest

   $ 2,607       $ 2,540   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Collateral pledged to others:

     

Cash (right to receive return of cash collateral is recorded in investments)

   $ 1,018       $ 809   

Securities at fair value (recorded in restricted investments)(3)

             36   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total collateral pledged

   $ 1,018       $ 845   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Derivative liability at fair value including accrued interest and premium receivable

   $ 1,223       $ 747   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, $26 million and $108 million, respectively, were held in restricted cash accounts.

 

(2) 

The trusts do not have the ability to sell or re-pledge securities they hold as collateral.

 

(3) 

Counterparty has the right to sell or re-pledge securities.

Our corporate derivatives contain credit contingent features. At our current unsecured credit rating, we have fully collateralized our corporate derivative liability position (including accrued interest and net of premiums receivable) of $1,034 million with our counterparties. Further downgrades would not result in any additional collateral requirements, except to increase the frequency of collateral calls. Two counterparties have the right to terminate the contracts with further downgrades. We currently have a liability position with these derivative

 

F-59


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

7. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

 

counterparties (including accrued interest and net of premiums receivable) of $306 million and have posted $302 million of collateral to these counterparties. If the credit contingent feature was triggered for these two counterparties and the counterparties exercised their right to terminate, we would be required to deliver additional assets totaling $4 million to settle the contracts. Trust related derivatives do not contain credit contingent features related to our or the trusts’ credit ratings.

 

8. Other Assets

The following table provides the detail of our other assets.

 

 

     December 31, 2011     December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Ending
Balance
     % of
Balance
    Ending
Balance
     % of
Balance
 

Accrued interest receivable

   $ 2,484         29   $ 2,927         33

Derivatives at fair value

     2,202         25        2,437         27   

Income tax asset, net current and deferred

     1,427         17        1,283         14   

Accounts receivable — general

     1,392         16        730         8   

Benefit and insurance-related investments

     466         5        462         5   

Fixed assets, net

     214         3        291         4   

Other loans, net

     193         2        271         3   

Other

     280         3        569         6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 8,658         100   $ 8,970         100
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

 

The “Derivatives at fair value” line in the above table represents the fair value of our derivatives in a gain position by counterparty, exclusive of accrued interest and collateral. At December 31, 2011 and 2010, these balances included $2.5 billion and $2.7 billion, respectively, of cross-currency interest rate swaps and interest rate swaps designated as fair value hedges that were offset by an increase in interest-bearing liabilities related to the hedged debt. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the cumulative mark-to-market adjustment to the hedged debt was $(2.7) billion and $(2.9) billion, respectively.

 

9. Stockholders’ Equity

Preferred Stock

At December 31, 2011, we had outstanding 3.3 million shares of 6.97 percent Cumulative Redeemable Preferred Stock, Series A (the “Series A Preferred Stock”) and 4.0 million shares of Floating-Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series B (the “Series B Preferred Stock”). Neither series has a maturity date but can be redeemed at our option. Redemption would include any accrued and unpaid dividends up to the redemption date. The shares have no preemptive or conversion rights and are not convertible into or exchangeable for any of our other securities or property. Dividends on both series are not mandatory and are paid quarterly, when, as, and if declared by the Board of Directors. Holders of Series A Preferred Stock are entitled to receive cumulative, quarterly cash dividends at the annual rate of $3.485 per share. Holders of Series B Preferred Stock are entitled to receive quarterly dividends based on 3-month LIBOR plus 170 basis points per annum in arrears. Upon liquidation or dissolution of the Company, holders of the Series A and Series B Preferred Stock are entitled to receive $50 and $100 per share, respectively, plus an amount equal to accrued and unpaid dividends for the then current quarterly dividend period, if any, pro rata, and before any distribution of assets are made to holders of our common stock.

 

F-60


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

9. Stockholders’ Equity (Continued)

 

No shares of our 7.25 percent Mandatory Convertible Preferred Stock, Series C (the “Series C Preferred Stock”) remain outstanding. On December 15, 2010, the mandatory conversion date, all remaining 810,370 shares of the Series C Preferred Stock were converted into 41 million shares of our common stock. During 2009, we converted $339 million of our Series C Preferred Stock to common stock. As part of this conversion, we delivered to the holders of the Series C Preferred Stock: (1) approximately 17 million shares (the number of common shares they would most likely receive if the preferred stock they held mandatorily converted to common shares in the fourth quarter of 2010) plus (2) a discounted amount of the preferred stock dividends the holders of the preferred stock would have received if they held the preferred stock through the mandatory conversion date. The accounting treatment for this conversion resulted in additional expense recorded as part of preferred stock dividends for the year ended December 31, 2009 of approximately $53 million.

Common Stock

Our shareholders have authorized the issuance of 1.125 billion shares of common stock (par value of $.20). At December 31, 2011, 509 million shares were issued and outstanding and 34.9 million shares were unissued but encumbered for outstanding stock options for employee compensation and remaining authority for stock-based compensation plans. The stock-based compensation plans are described in “Note 11—Stock-Based Compensation Plans and Arrangements.”

In March 2011, we retired 70 million shares of common stock held in treasury. This retirement decreased the balance in treasury stock by $1.9 billion, with corresponding decreases of $14 million in common stock and $1.9 billion in additional paid-in capital. There was no impact to total equity from this transaction.

Dividend and Share Repurchase Program

On June 17, 2011, September 16, 2011, and December 16, 2011, we paid a quarterly dividend of $.10 per share on our common stock, the first dividends paid since early 2007. In April 2011, we authorized the repurchase of up to $300 million of outstanding common stock in open market transactions and terminated all previous authorizations. During the second and third quarters of 2011, we repurchased 19.1 million shares for an aggregate purchase price of $300 million. With these purchases, we fully utilized this share repurchase authorization.

On January 26, 2012, we increased the quarterly dividend on our common stock to $.125 per share. The next such quarterly dividend will be paid on March 16, 2012. We also authorized the repurchase of up to $500 million of outstanding common stock in open market transactions.

 

F-61


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

9. Stockholders’ Equity (Continued)

 

The following table summarizes our common share repurchases and issuances.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011      2010      2009  

Common stock repurchased(1)

     19,054,115                   

Average purchase price per share

   $ 15.77       $       $   

Shares repurchased related to employee stock-based compensation plans(2)

     3,024,662         1,097,647         263,640   

Average purchase price per share

   $ 15.71       $ 13.44       $ 20.29   

Authority remaining at end of period for repurchases(1)

             38,841,923         38,841,923   

Common shares issued

     3,886,217         1,803,683         536,134   

 

  (1)

In April 2011 we authorized the repurchase of up to $300 million of outstanding common stock in open market transactions, and terminated the previous stock repurchase program which had authorized the repurchase of up to 342.5 million shares. Average purchase price per share includes purchase commission costs.

 

  (2)

Comprises shares withheld from stock option exercises and vesting of restricted stock for employees’ tax withholding obligations and shares tendered by employees to satisfy option exercise costs.

The closing price of our common stock on December 31, 2011 was $13.40.

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss)

Accumulated other comprehensive loss includes the after-tax change in unrealized gains and losses on available-for-sale investments, unrealized gains and losses on derivatives, and the defined benefit pension plans adjustment. The following table presents the cumulative balances of the components of other comprehensive loss.

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   December 31,  
   2011     2010     2009  

Net unrealized gains on investments

   $ 4      $ 2      $ 2   

Net unrealized losses on derivatives

     (18     (49     (54

Net gain on defined benefit pension plans

            2        11   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total accumulated other comprehensive loss

   $ (14   $ (45   $ (41
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-62


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

10. Earnings (Loss) per Common Share

Basic earnings (loss) per common share (“EPS”) are calculated using the weighted average number of shares of common stock outstanding during each period. A reconciliation of the numerators and denominators of the basic and diluted EPS calculations follows.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(In millions, except per share data)

     2011          2010         2009    

Numerator:

       

Net income attributable to SLM Corporation

   $ 633       $ 530      $ 324   

Preferred stock dividends

     18         72        146   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income attributable to SLM Corporation common stock

   $ 615       $ 458      $ 178   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Denominator:

       

Weighted average shares used to compute basic EPS

     517         487        471   

Effect of dilutive securities:

       

Dilutive effect of stock options, non-vested deferred compensation and restricted stock, restricted stock units and Employee Stock Purchase Plan (“ESPP”)(1)

     6         1        1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Dilutive potential common shares(2)

     6         1        1   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Weighted average shares used to compute diluted EPS

     523         488        472   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

       

Continuing operations

   $ 1.13       $ 1.08      $ .85   

Discontinued operations

     .06         (.14     (.47
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.19       $ .94      $ .38   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

       

Continuing operations

   $ 1.12       $ 1.08      $ .85   

Discontinued operations

     .06         (.14     (.47
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ 1.18       $ .94      $ .38   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Includes the potential dilutive effect of additional common shares that are issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options, non-vested deferred compensation and restricted stock, restricted stock units, and the outstanding commitment to issue shares under the ESPP, determined by the treasury stock method.

 

(2)

For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, stock options covering approximately 16 million, 15 million and 42 million shares, respectively, and restricted stock of 2 million, 0 and 1 million shares, respectively, were outstanding but not included in the computation of diluted earnings per share because they were anti-dilutive.

 

11. Stock-Based Compensation Plans and Arrangements

As of December 31, 2011, we have two active stock-based compensation plans that provide for grants of equity awards to our employees and non-employee directors. We also maintain the ESPP. Shares issued under these stock-based compensation plans may be either shares reacquired by us or shares that are authorized but unissued.

Our 2009-2012 Incentive Plan was approved by shareholders on May 22, 2009. At December 31, 2011, 25 million shares were authorized to be issued from this plan.

Our Directors Equity Plan, under which stock options and restricted stock are granted to non-employee members of the board of directors, was approved on May 22, 2009. At December 31, 2011, one million shares were authorized to be issued from this plan.

 

F-63


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

11. Stock-Based Compensation Plans and Arrangements (Continued)

 

From January 1, 2007 through May 21, 2009, we granted stock options and restricted stock to our employees and non-employee directors under the SLM Corporation Incentive Plan and the Directors Stock Plan.

The total stock-based compensation cost recognized in the consolidated statements of income for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $56 million, $40 million and $51 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2011, there was $18 million of total unrecognized compensation cost related to unvested stock awards net of estimated forfeitures, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.9 years.

In the first quarter of 2011, we changed our stock-based compensation plans so that retirement eligible employees would not forfeit unvested stock-based compensation upon their retirement. This change had the effect of accelerating $11 million of future stock-based compensation expenses associated with these unvested stock grants into the first quarter of 2011 for those employees who are retirement eligible or who will become retirement eligible prior to the vesting date.

Stock Options

The maximum term for stock options is 10 years and the exercise price must be equal to or greater than the market price of our common stock on the grant date. We have granted time-vested, price-vested and performance-vested options to our employees and non-employee directors. Time-vested options granted to management and non-management employees generally vest over three years. Price-vested options granted to management employees vest upon our common stock reaching a targeted closing price for a set number of days. Performance-vested options granted to management employees vest one-third per year for three years based on corporate earnings-related performance targets. Options granted to non-employee directors in 2009 and prior years vest upon our common stock price reaching a targeted closing price for a set number of days and options granted after 2009 vest upon the director’s election to the Board.

The fair values of the options granted in the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 were estimated as of the grant date using a Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted average assumptions:

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

Risk-free interest rate

     1.57     1.60     1.51

Expected volatility

     54     60     80

Expected dividend rate

     2.58     0.00     0.00

Expected life of the option

     4.1 years        3.3 years        3.5 years   

Weighted average fair value of options granted

     $5.18        $4.40        $5.82   

The expected life of the options is based on observed historical exercise patterns. Groups of employees (and non-employee directors) that have received similar option grant terms are considered separately for valuation purposes. The expected volatility is based on implied volatility from publicly-traded options on our stock at the grant date and historical volatility of our stock consistent with the expected life of the option. The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. Treasury spot rate at the grant date consistent with the expected life of the option. The dividend yield is based on the projected annual dividend payment per share based on the dividend amount at the grant date, divided by the stock price at the grant date.

 

F-64


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

11. Stock-Based Compensation Plans and Arrangements (Continued)

 

On May 17, 2010, we launched a one-time stock option exchange program to allow certain eligible employees (excluding our named executive officers and members of our Board of Directors) to exchange certain out-of-the-money options for new options with an exercise price equal to the fair market value of our stock as of the grant date. To be eligible for the exchange, the options had to have been granted on or before January 31, 2008, had an exercise price that was greater than or equal to $20.94 per share, had a remaining term that expired after January 1, 2011 and were outstanding as of the start date of the offer and at the time the offer expired. The offering period closed on June 14, 2010. On that date, 15.1 million options were tendered and exchanged for 8.0 million new options with an exercise price of $11.39. None of the replacement options were vested on the date of grant. Replacement options have provisions to vest in six months, twelve months or two annual installments following the grant date, depending on the original vesting status and vesting terms of the eligible options, and will maintain the original contractual term of the eligible options for which they were exchanged. The exchange program was designed so that the fair market value of the new options would not be greater than the fair market value of the options exchanged, and as a result, this stock option exchange did not result in incremental compensation expense to us.

The following table summarizes stock option activity for the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

 

(Dollars in millions, except per share data)

   Number of
Options
    Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price per
Share
     Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Term
     Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value(1)
 

Outstanding at December 31, 2010

     36,085,878      $ 19.88         

Granted

     2,476,230        14.52         

Exercised(2)(3)

     (3,352,823     11.08         

Canceled

     (2,538,220     27.62         
  

 

 

   

 

 

       

Outstanding at December 31, 2011(4)(5)

     32,671,065      $ 19.78         5.5 yrs       $ 48   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Exercisable at December 31, 2011

     20,432,582      $ 24.08         4.3 yrs       $ 24   
  

 

 

   

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (1)

The aggregate intrinsic value represents the total intrinsic value (the aggregate difference between our closing stock price on December 31, 2011 and the exercise price of in-the-money options) that would have been received by the option holders if all in-the-money options had been exercised on December 31, 2011.

 

  (2)

The total intrinsic value of options exercised was $13.8 million, $1.3 million and $.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

  (3)

No cash was received from option exercises for the year ended December 31, 2011. The actual tax benefit realized for the tax deductions from option exercises totaled $5.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

  (4)

As of December 31, 2011, there was $7 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to stock options net of estimated forfeitures, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.5 years.

 

  (5) 

For net-settled options, gross number is reflected.

Restricted Stock

Restricted stock awards generally vest over three years and in some cases based on corporate earnings-related performance targets. Non-vested restricted stock is entitled to dividend equivalent units that vest subject to the same vesting requirements as the underlying restricted stock award.

 

F-65


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

11. Stock-Based Compensation Plans and Arrangements (Continued)

 

The fair value of restricted stock awards is determined on the grant date based on our stock price and is amortized to compensation cost on a straight-line basis over the related vesting periods.

The following table summarizes restricted stock activity for the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

 

     Number of
Shares
    Weighted
Average  Grant
Date
Fair Value
 

Non-vested at December 31, 2010

     701,737      $ 11.98   

Granted

     166,750        13.56   

Vested(1)

     (451,625     12.98   

Canceled

     (4,000     10.31   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Non-vested at December 31, 2011(2)

     412,862      $ 12.07   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

The total fair value of shares that vested during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, was $6 million, $9 million and $9 million, respectively.

 

  (2) 

As of December 31, 2011, there was $1 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to restricted stock net of estimated forfeitures, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.4 years.

Restricted Stock Units

Restricted stock units (“RSUs”) are equity awards granted to employees that entitle the holder to shares of our common stock when the award vests. The fair value of each grant is determined on the grant date based on our stock price and is amortized to compensation cost on a straight-line basis over the related vesting periods. RSUs generally vest over three years and in some cases based on corporate earnings-related performance targets. Non-vested RSUs are entitled to dividend equivalent units that vest subject to the same vesting requirements as the underlying RSU award.

The following table summarizes RSU activity for the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

 

     Number of
RSUs
    Weighted
Average  Grant
Date
Fair Value
 

Outstanding at December 31, 2010

     96,681      $ 10.50   

Granted

     2,779,075        14.75   

Vested and converted to common stock(1)

     (41,625     10.45   

Canceled

     (103,441     14.61   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

Outstanding at December 31, 2011(2)

     2,730,690      $ 14.67   
  

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1)

The total fair value of RSUs that vested and converted to common stock during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $.4 million, $.4 million and $.1 million, respectively.

 

  (2) 

As of December 31, 2011, there was $11 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to RSUs net of estimated forfeitures, which is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 2.2 years.

 

F-66


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

11. Stock-Based Compensation Plans and Arrangements (Continued)

 

Employee Stock Purchase Plan

Under the ESPP, employees can purchase shares of our common stock at the end of a 12-month offering period at a price equal to the share price at the beginning of the 12-month period, less 15 percent, up to a maximum purchase price of $7,500 plus accrued interest. The purchase price for each offering is determined at the beginning of the offering period.

The fair values of the stock purchase rights of the ESPP offerings were calculated using a Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted average assumptions.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
       2011         2010         2009    

Risk-free interest rate

     .27     .33     .53

Expected volatility

     42     61     103

Expected dividend rate

     1.87     0.00     0.00

Expected life of the option

     1 year        1 year        1 year   

Weighted average fair value of stock purchase rights

     $3.63        $3.30        $4.88   

The expected volatility is based on implied volatility from publicly-traded options on our stock at the grant date and historical volatility of our stock consistent with the expected life. The risk-free interest rate is based on the U.S. Treasury spot rate at the grant date consistent with the expected life. The dividend yield is based on the projected annual dividend payment per share based on the current dividend amount at the grant date divided by the stock price at the grant date.

The fair values were amortized to compensation cost on a straight-line basis over a one-year vesting period. As of December 31, 2011, there was $.1 million of unrecognized compensation cost related to the ESPP net of estimated forfeitures, which is expected to be recognized in January 2012.

During the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, plan participants purchased 278,266 shares and 205,528 shares, respectively, of our common stock. No shares were purchased in 2009.

 

12. Restructuring Activities

Restructuring expenses of $9 million, $91 million and $22 million were recorded in the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. Of these amounts, $9 million, $85 million and $10 million was recognized in continuing operations and $0 million, $6 million and $12 million was recognized in discontinued operations, respectively. The following details our restructuring efforts:

 

   

On March 30, 2010, President Obama signed into law H.R. 4872, HCERA, which included the SAFRA Act. Effective July 1, 2010, the legislation eliminated the authority to provide new loans under FFELP and requires all new federal loans to be made through the DSLP. The new law did not alter or affect the terms and conditions of existing FFELP Loans. We have and will continue to restructure our operations in response to this change in law which has and will continue to result in a significant reduction of operating costs due to the elimination of positions and facilities associated with the origination of FFELP Loans. Restructuring expenses associated with this plan for the year ended December 31, 2011 were $9 million and we expect to incur an estimated $10 million of additional restructuring expenses.

In addition, on March 31, 2011, we moved our corporate headquarters to Newark, DE from Reston, VA.

 

F-67


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

12. Restructuring Activities (Continued)

 

   

In response to the College Cost Reduction and Access Act of 2007 (“CCRAA”) and challenges in the capital markets, we initiated a restructuring plan in the fourth quarter of 2007. This plan focused on conforming our lending activities to the economic environment, exiting certain customer relationships and product lines, winding down or otherwise disposing of our debt Purchased Paper businesses, and significantly reducing our operating expenses. This restructuring plan was essentially completed in the fourth quarter of 2009. Under this plan, there were no restructuring expenses for the year ended December 31, 2011. There were $7 million and $22 million of restructuring expenses for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

The following table summarizes the restructuring expenses incurred to date.

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   Years Ended
December 31,
     Cumulative Expense
as of December 31,
 
   2011      2010      2009      2011  

Severance costs

   $ 6       $ 81       $ 8       $ 169   

Lease and other contract termination costs

             1         1         11   

Exit and other costs

     3         3         1         19   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total restructuring expenses from continuing operations(1)

     9         85         10         199   

Total restructuring expenses from discontinued operations

             6         12         29   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ 9       $ 91       $ 22       $ 228   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

(1) 

Aggregate restructuring expenses from continuing operations incurred across our reportable segments are disclosed in “Note 16—Segment Reporting.”

Since the fourth quarter of 2007 through December 31, 2011, cumulative severance costs were incurred in conjunction with aggregate completed and planned position eliminations of approximately 5,500 positions. Position eliminations were across all of our reportable segments, ranging from senior executives to servicing center personnel. Lease and other contract termination costs and exit and other costs incurred during 2011, 2010 and 2009 related primarily to terminated or abandoned facility leases and consulting costs incurred in conjunction with various cost reduction and exit strategies.

The following table summarizes the restructuring liability balance, which is included in other liabilities in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet.

 

 

(Dollars in millions)

   Severance
Costs
    Lease and
Other
Contract
Termination
Costs
    Exit and
Other  Costs
    Total  

Balance at December 31, 2009

   $ 9      $ 4      $      $ 13   

Net accruals from continuing operations

     81        1        3        85   

Net accruals from discontinued operations

     3        3               6   

Cash paid

     (45     (4     (2     (51
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2010

     48        4        1        53   

Net accruals from continuing operations

     6               3        9   

Net accruals from discontinued operations

                            

Cash paid

     (44     (3     (4     (51
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance at December 31, 2011

   $ 10      $ 1      $      $ 11   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-68


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

13. Fair Value Measurements

We use estimates of fair value in applying various accounting standards for our financial statements.

We categorize our fair value estimates based on a hierarchical framework associated with three levels of price transparency utilized in measuring financial instruments at fair value. For additional information regarding our policies for determining fair value and the hierarchical framework, see “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies — Fair Value Measurement.”

During the year ended December 31, 2011, there were no significant transfers of financial instruments between levels.

Student Loans

Our FFELP Loans and Private Education Loans are accounted for at cost or at the lower of cost or market if the loan is held-for-sale. FFELP Loans classified as held-for-sale are those which we have the ability and intent to sell under various ED loan purchase programs. In these instances, the FFELP Loans are valued using the committed sales price under the programs. For all other FFELP Loans and Private Education Loans, fair values were determined by modeling loan cash flows using stated terms of the assets and internally-developed assumptions to determine aggregate portfolio yield, net present value and average life. The significant assumptions used to determine fair value are prepayment speeds, default rates, cost of funds, required return on equity, and expected Repayment Borrower Benefits to be earned. In addition, the Floor Income component of our FFELP Loan portfolio is valued with option models using both observable market inputs and internally developed inputs. A number of significant inputs into the models are internally derived and not observable to market participants. Certain model assumptions were calibrated based upon pricing information related to our acquisition of the Student Loan Corporation FFELP trusts on December 31, 2010.

Cash and Investments (Including “Restricted Cash and Investments”)

Cash and cash equivalents are carried at cost. Carrying value approximated fair value for disclosure purposes. Investments classified as trading or available-for-sale are carried at fair value in the financial statements. Investments in U.S. Treasury securities consisted of Treasury bills that trade in active markets. The fair value was determined using observable market prices. Investments in mortgage-backed securities are valued using observable market prices. These securities are primarily collateralized by real estate properties in Utah and are guaranteed by either a government sponsored enterprise or the U.S. government. Other investments (primarily municipal bonds) for which observable prices from active markets are not available were valued through standard bond pricing models using observable market yield curves adjusted for credit and liquidity spreads. These valuations are immaterial to the overall investment portfolio. The fair value of investments in commercial paper, asset-backed commercial paper, or demand deposits that have a remaining term of less than 90 days when purchased are estimated at cost and, when needed, adjustments for liquidity and credit spreads are made depending on market conditions and counterparty credit risks. No additional adjustments were deemed necessary.

Borrowings

Borrowings are accounted for at cost in the financial statements except when denominated in a foreign currency or when designated as the hedged item in a fair value hedge relationship. When the hedged risk is the benchmark interest rate and not full fair value, the cost basis is adjusted for changes in value due to benchmark interest rates only. Foreign currency-denominated borrowings are re-measured at current spot rates in the financial statements. The full fair value of all borrowings is disclosed. Fair value was determined through

 

F-69


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

13. Fair Value Measurements (Continued)

 

standard bond pricing models and option models (when applicable) using the stated terms of the borrowings, observable yield curves, foreign currency exchange rates, volatilities from active markets or from quotes from broker-dealers. Fair value adjustments for unsecured corporate debt are made based on indicative quotes from observable trades and spreads on credit default swaps specific to the Company. Fair value adjustments for secured borrowings are based on indicative quotes from broker-dealers. These adjustments for both secured and unsecured borrowings are material to the overall valuation of these items and, currently, are based on inputs from inactive markets.

Derivative Financial Instruments

All derivatives are accounted for at fair value in the financial statements. The fair value of a majority of derivative financial instruments was determined by standard derivative pricing and option models using the stated terms of the contracts and observable market inputs. In some cases, we utilized internally developed inputs that are not observable in the market, and as such, classified these instruments as level 3 fair values. Complex structured derivatives or derivatives that trade in less liquid markets require significant estimates and judgment in determining fair value that cannot be corroborated with market transactions. It is our policy to compare our derivative fair values to those received by our counterparties in order to validate the model’s outputs. Any significant differences are identified and resolved appropriately.

When determining the fair value of derivatives, we take into account counterparty credit risk for positions where it is exposed to the counterparty on a net basis by assessing exposure net of collateral held. The net exposures for each counterparty are adjusted based on market information available for the specific counterparty, including spreads from credit default swaps. When the counterparty has exposure to us under derivatives with us, we fully collateralize the exposure, minimizing the adjustment necessary to the derivative valuations for our credit risk. While trusts that contain derivatives are not required to post collateral, when the counterparty is exposed to the trust the credit quality and securitized nature of the trusts minimizes any adjustments for the counterparty’s exposure to the trusts. The net credit risk adjustment (adjustments for our exposure to counterparties net of adjustments for the counterparties’ exposure to us) decreased the valuations by $190 million at December 31, 2011.

Inputs specific to each class of derivatives disclosed in the table below are as follows:

 

   

Interest rate swaps — Derivatives are valued using standard derivative cash flow models. Derivatives that swap fixed interest payments for LIBOR interest payments (or vice versa) and derivatives swapping quarterly reset LIBOR for daily reset LIBOR or one-month LIBOR were valued using the LIBOR swap yield curve which is an observable input from an active market. These derivatives are level 2 fair value estimates in the hierarchy. Other derivatives swapping LIBOR interest payments for another variable interest payment (primarily T-Bill or Prime) or swapping interest payments based on the Consumer Price Index for LIBOR interest payments are valued using the LIBOR swap yield curve and observable market spreads for the specified index. The markets for these swaps are generally illiquid as indicated by a wide bid/ask spread. The adjustment made for liquidity decreased the valuations by $111 million at December 31, 2011. These derivatives are level 3 fair value estimates.

 

   

Cross-currency interest rate swaps — Derivatives are valued using standard derivative cash flow models. Derivatives hedging foreign-denominated bonds are valued using the LIBOR swap yield curve (for both USD and the foreign-denominated currency), cross-currency basis spreads, and forward foreign currency exchange rates. The derivatives are primarily British Pound Sterling and Euro denominated. These inputs are observable inputs from active markets. Therefore, the resulting valuation is a level 2 fair value estimate. Amortizing notional derivatives (derivatives whose notional

 

F-70


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

13. Fair Value Measurements (Continued)

 

 

amounts change based on changes in the balance of, or pool of assets or debt) hedging trust debt use internally derived assumptions for the trust assets’ prepayment speeds and default rates to model the notional amortization. Management makes assumptions concerning the extension features of derivatives hedging rate-reset notes denominated in a foreign currency. These inputs are not market observable; therefore, these derivatives are level 3 fair value estimates.

 

   

Floor Income Contracts — Derivatives are valued using an option pricing model. Inputs to the model include the LIBOR swap yield curve and LIBOR interest rate volatilities. The inputs are observable inputs in active markets and these derivatives are level 2 fair value estimates.

The carrying value of borrowings designated as the hedged item in a fair value hedge are adjusted for changes in fair value due to benchmark interest rates and foreign-currency exchange rates. These valuations are determined through standard bond pricing models and option models (when applicable) using the stated terms of the borrowings, and observable yield curves, foreign currency exchange rates, and volatilities.

Residual Interests

Prior to the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010 (see “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies — Consolidation), the Residual Interests were carried at fair value in the financial statements. No active market exists for student loan Residual Interests; as such, the fair value was calculated using discounted cash flow models and option models. Observable inputs from active markets were used where available, including yield curves and volatilities. Significant unobservable inputs such as prepayment speeds, default rates, certain bonds’ costs of funds and discount rates were used in determining the fair value and required significant judgment. These unobservable inputs were internally determined based upon analysis of historical data and expected industry trends. On a quarterly basis we back-tested our prepayment speeds, default rates and costs of funds assumptions by comparing those assumptions to actual results experienced. We used non-binding broker quotes and industry analyst reports which show changes in the indicative prices of the asset-backed securities tranches immediately senior to the Residual Interest as an indication of potential changes in the discount rate used to value the Residual Interests. Market transactions were not available to validate the models’ results.

 

F-71


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

13. Fair Value Measurements (Continued)

 

The following table summarizes the valuation of our financial instruments that are marked-to-market on a recurring basis.

 

 

     Fair Value Measurements on a Recurring
Basis as of December 31, 2011
    Fair Value Measurements on a Recurring
Basis as of December 31, 2010
 

(Dollars in millions)

    Level 1        Level 2       Level 3       Total       Level 1       Level 2       Level 3       Total   

Assets

                 

Available-for-sale investments:

                 

U.S. Treasury securities

   $       $      $      $      $ 39      $      $      $ 39   

Agency residential mortgage backed securities

             59               59               68               68   

Guaranteed investment contracts

             20               20               20               20   

Other

             11               11               12               12   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total available-for-sale investments

             90               90        39        100               139   

Derivative instruments:(1)

                 

Interest rate swaps

             1,550        183        1,733               1,017        150        1,167   

Cross currency interest rate swaps

             139        1,220        1,359               427        1,599        2,026   

Other

                    1        1                      26        26   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivative assets

             1,689        1,404        3,093               1,444        1,775        3,219   

Counterparty netting

            (891           (782
         

 

 

         

 

 

 

Subtotal(3)

            2,202              2,437   

Cash collateral held

            (1,326           (886
         

 

 

         

 

 

 

Net derivative assets

            876              1,551   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $       $ 1,779      $ 1,404      $ 966      $ 39      $ 1,544      $ 1,775      $ 1,690   
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Liabilities(2)

                 

Derivative instruments(1)

                 

Interest rate swaps

   $       $ (47   $ (223   $ (270   $      $ (183   $ (240   $ (423

Floor Income Contracts

             (2,544            (2,544            (1,315            (1,315

Cross currency interest rate swaps

             (44     (199     (243            (43     (172     (215

Other

                                  (1                   (1
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total derivative instruments

             (2,635     (422     (3,057     (1     (1,541     (412     (1,954

Counterparty netting

            891              782   
         

 

 

         

 

 

 

Subtotal(3)

            (2,166           (1,172

Cash collateral pledged

            1,018              809   
         

 

 

         

 

 

 

Net derivative liabilities

            (1,148           (363
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $       $ (2,635   $ (422   $ (1,148   $ (1   $ (1,541   $ (412   $ (363
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1)

Fair value of derivative instruments excludes accrued interest and the value of collateral.

 

(2)

Borrowings which are the hedged items in a fair value hedge relationship and which are adjusted for changes in value due to benchmark interest rates only are not carried at full fair value and are not reflected in this table.

 

(3)

As carried on the balance sheet.

 

F-72


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

13. Fair Value Measurements (Continued)

 

The following tables summarize the change in balance sheet carrying value associated with Level 3 financial instruments carried at fair value on a recurring basis.

 

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2011(3)  
    Derivative Instruments  

(Dollars in millions)

  Interest
Rate Swaps
    Cross
Currency
Interest
Rate Swaps
    Other     Total
Derivative
Instruments
 

Balance, beginning of period

  $ (90   $ 1,427      $ 26      $ 1,363   

Total gains/(losses) (realized and unrealized):

       

Included in earnings(1)

    69        (176     33        (74

Included in other comprehensive income

                           

Settlements

    (19     (230     (58     (307

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3

                           
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

  $ (40   $ 1,021      $ 1      $ 982   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in unrealized gains/(losses) relating to instruments still held at the reporting date(2)

  $ 6      $ (408   $ 11      $ (391
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2010  
          Derivative instruments        

(Dollars in millions)

  Residual
Interests
    Interest
Rate Swaps
    Floor  Income
Contracts
    Cross
Currency
Interest
Rate Swaps
    Other     Total
Derivative
Instruments
    Total  

Balance, beginning of period

  $ 1,828      $ (272   $ (54   $ 1,596      $ (18   $ 1,252      $ 3,080   

Total gains/(losses) (realized and unrealized):

             

Included in earnings(1)

           234        3        (834     34        (563     (563

Included in other comprehensive income

                                                

Settlements

           4        51        (208     10        (143     (143

Cumulative effect of accounting change(3)

    (1,828     (56            873               817        (1,011

Transfers in and/or out of
Level 3

                                                
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

  $      $ (90   $      $ 1,427      $ 26      $ 1,363      $ 1,363   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in unrealized gains/(losses) relating to instruments still held at the reporting date(2)

  $      $ 111      $      $ (1,010   $ 36      $ (863   $ (863
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-73


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

13. Fair Value Measurements (Continued)

 

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Residual
Interests
    Derivative
Instruments
    Total  

Balance, beginning of period

   $ 2,200      $ (341   $ 1,859   

Total gains/(losses) (realized and unrealized):

      

Included in earnings(1)

     120        91        211   

Included in other comprehensive income

                     

Settlements

     (492     434        (58

Transfers in and/or out of Level 3

            1,068        1,068   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Balance, end of period

   $ 1,828      $ 1,252      $ 3,080   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Change in unrealized gains/(losses) relating to instruments still held at the reporting date

   $ (330 )(4)    $ 439 (2)    $ 109   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

“Included in earnings” comprises the following amounts recorded in the specified line item in the consolidated statements of income:

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

     2011        2010        2009    

Servicing and securitization revenue

   $       $       $ 120   

Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net

     (298      (732      298   

Interest expense

     224         169         (207
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total

   $ (74    $ (563    $ 211   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (2) 

Recorded in “gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net” in the consolidated statements of income.

 

  (3) 

Upon adoption of new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, we consolidated all of our previously off-balance sheet securitization trusts (see “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies — Consolidation”). This resulted in the removal of the Residual Interest and the recording of the fair value of swaps previously not in our consolidated results.

 

  (4) 

Recorded in “securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue” in the consolidated statements of income.

 

F-74


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

13. Fair Value Measurements (Continued)

 

The following table summarizes the fair values of our financial assets and liabilities, including derivative financial instruments.

 

 

     December 31, 2011     December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Fair
Value
    Carrying
Value
    Difference     Fair
Value
    Carrying
Value
    Difference  

Earning assets

            

FFELP Loans

   $ 134,196      $ 138,130      $ (3,934   $ 147,163      $ 148,649      $ (1,486

Private Education Loans

     33,968        36,290        (2,322     30,949        35,656        (4,707

Other loans

     73        193        (120     88        270        (182

Cash and investments(1)

     9,789        9,789               11,553        11,553          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total earning assets

     178,026        184,402        (6,376     189,753        196,128        (6,375
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Interest-bearing liabilities

            

Short-term borrowings

     29,547        29,573        26        33,604        33,616        12   

Long-term borrowings

     141,605        154,393        12,788        154,355        163,544        9,189   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest-bearing liabilities

     171,152        183,966        12,814        187,959        197,160        9,201   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments

            

Floor Income Contracts

     (2,544     (2,544            (1,315     (1,315       

Interest rate swaps

     1,463        1,463               744        744          

Cross currency interest rate swaps

     1,116        1,116               1,811        1,811          

Other

     1        1               25        25          
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

Excess of net asset fair value over carrying value

       $ 6,438          $ 2,826   
      

 

 

       

 

 

 

 

(1) 

“Cash and investments” includes available-for-sale investments that consist of investments that are primarily U.S. Treasury or U.S. agency securities whose cost basis is $85 million and $137 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, versus a fair value of $90 million and $139 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

 

14. Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees

In Re SLM Corporation Securities Litigation. On January 31, 2008, a putative class action lawsuit was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging that the Company and certain officers violated federal securities laws by, among other things, issuing a series of materially false and misleading statements with respect to our financial results for year-end 2006 and the first quarter of 2007. This case and other actions arising out of the same circumstances and alleged acts have been consolidated and are now identified as In Re SLM Corporation Securities Litigation. The case purports to be brought on behalf of those who acquired our common stock between January 18, 2007 and January 23, 2008. On January 24, 2012, the court certified a class, appointed class counsel and appointed a class representative. On February 10, 2012, the parties entered into a settlement term sheet under which we agreed to pay $35 million, which amount includes all attorneys’ fees, administration costs, expenses, class member benefits, and costs of any kind associated with the resolution of this matter. We have denied vigorously all claims asserted against us, but agreed to settle to avoid the burden, expense, risk and uncertainty of continued litigation. The entire settlement amount will be paid by our insurers and the settlement is subject to us entering into a formal settlement agreement and Court approval. As a result there are no loss accruals recorded related to this matter as of December 31, 2011.

 

 

F-75


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

14. Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees (Continued)

 

Mark A. Arthur et al. v. Sallie Mae, Inc. On February 2, 2010, a putative class action suit was filed by a borrower in U.S. District Court for the Western District of Washington alleging that we contacted consumers on their cellular telephones via autodialer without their consent in violation of the Telephone Consumer Protection Act, 47 U.S.C. § 227 et seq. (“TCPA”). Each violation under the TCPA provides for $500 in statutory damages ($1,500 if a willful violation is shown). Plaintiffs were seeking statutory damages, damages for willful violations, attorneys’ fees, costs, and injunctive relief. On October 7, 2011, we entered into an amended settlement agreement under which the Company agreed to a settlement fund of $24.15 million. We have denied vigorously all claims asserted against us, but agreed to settle to avoid the burden, expense, risk and uncertainty of continued litigation. On January 10, 2012, the Court denied, without prejudice, the Motion for Preliminary Approval of the amended settlement agreement noting, however, that although the proposed settlement satisfies the Court’s requirement of overall fairness, the Court expressed concern regarding the proposed form of notice and other forms to be provided in connection with the settlement. On February 9, 2012, the Plaintiffs filed a Renewed Motion for Preliminary Approval addressing the Court’s concerns. As of December 31, 2011 we have accrued $24.15 million related to this matter.

ED’s Office of the Inspector General (“OIG”) commenced an audit regarding Special Allowance Payments on September 10, 2007. On August 3, 2009, we received the final audit report of the OIG related to our billing practices for Special Allowance Payments. Among other things, the OIG recommended that ED instruct us to return approximately $22 million in alleged special allowance overpayments. We continue to believe that our practices were consistent with longstanding ED guidance and all applicable rules and regulations and intend to continue disputing these findings. We provided our response to the Secretary of Education on October 2, 2009 and we provided additional information to ED in 2010. We have not received any further requests since that time. At this time, we estimate the range of potential exposure to be $0 to $22 million. We have not accrued any loss related to this matter as of December 31, 2011.

The Company and its subsidiaries and affiliates also are subject to various claims, lawsuits and other actions that arise in the normal course of business. Most of these matters are claims by borrowers disputing the manner in which their loans have been processed or the accuracy of our reports to credit bureaus. In addition, our collections subsidiaries are routinely named in individual plaintiff or class action lawsuits in which the plaintiffs allege that those subsidiaries have violated a federal or state law in the process of collecting their accounts. We believe that these claims, lawsuits and other actions will not have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or results of operations. Finally, from time to time, the Company receives information and document requests from state attorneys general and Congressional committees concerning certain business practices. Our practice has been and continues to be to cooperate with the state attorneys general and Congressional committees and to be responsive to any such requests.

Contingencies

In the ordinary course of business, we and our subsidiaries are routinely defendants in or parties to pending and threatened legal actions and proceedings including actions brought on behalf of various classes of claimants. These actions and proceedings may be based on alleged violations of consumer protection, securities, employment and other laws. In certain of these actions and proceedings, claims for substantial monetary damage are asserted against us and our subsidiaries.

In the ordinary course of business, we and our subsidiaries are subject to regulatory examinations, information gathering requests, inquiries and investigations. In connection with formal and informal inquiries in these cases, we and our subsidiaries receive numerous requests, subpoenas and orders for documents, testimony and information in connection with various aspects of our regulated activities.

 

F-76


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

14. Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees (Continued)

 

In view of the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of such litigation and regulatory matters, we cannot predict what the eventual outcome of the pending matters will be, what the timing or the ultimate resolution of these matters will be, or what the eventual loss, fines or penalties related to each pending matter may be.

We are required to establish reserves for litigation and regulatory matters where those matters present loss contingencies that are both probable and estimable. When loss contingencies are not both probable and estimable, we do not establish reserves.

Based on current knowledge, reserves have been established for certain litigation or regulatory matters where the loss is both probable and estimable. Based on current knowledge, management does not believe that loss contingencies, if any, arising from pending investigations, litigation or regulatory matters will have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position, liquidity, results of operations or cash flows.

We maintain forward contracts to purchase loans from our lending partners at contractual prices. These contracts typically have a maximum amount we are committed to buy, but lack a fixed or determinable amount as it ultimately is based on the lending partner’s origination activity. At December 31, 2011, there were $17 million of originated loans (Private Education Loans) in the pipeline that we are committed to purchase.

 

15. Income Taxes

Reconciliations of the statutory U.S. federal income tax rates to our effective tax rate for continuing operations follow:

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  
     2011     2010     2009  

Statutory rate

     35.0     35.0     35.0

State tax, net of federal benefit

     .8        1.2        (1.3

Non-deductible goodwill

            9.2          

Other, net

     (.5     (.2     (1.0
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Effective tax rate

     35.3     45.2     32.7
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

The effective tax rates for discontinued operations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 are 38.0 percent, 26.7 percent, and 27.9 percent, respectively. The effective tax rate varies from the statutory U.S. federal rate of 35 percent primarily due to the establishment of valuation allowances against capital loss carryforwards for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009, and due to the impact of state taxes, net of federal benefit, for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

 

F-77


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

15. Income Taxes (Continued)

 

Income tax expense consists of:

 

 

     December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

Continuing operations current provision/(benefit):

      

Federal

   $ 437      $ 252      $ 156   

State

     38        37        (19

Foreign

                     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total continuing operations current provision/(benefit)

     475        289        137   

Continuing operations deferred provision/(benefit):

      

Federal

     (121     214        124   

State

     (26     (10     3   

Foreign

                     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total continuing operations deferred provision/(benefit)

     (147     204        127   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Continuing operations provision for income tax expense/(benefit)

     328        493        264   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Discontinued operations current provision/(benefit):

      

Federal

   $ (50   $ 30      $ (199

State

     (5     7        (13

Foreign

                     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total discontinued operations current provision/(benefit)

     (55     37        (212

Discontinued operations deferred provision/(benefit):

      

Federal

     68        (56     114   

State

     7        (5     13   

Foreign

                     
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total discontinued operations deferred provision/(benefit)

     75        (61     127   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Discontinued operations provision for income tax expense/(benefit)

     20        (24     (85
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Provision for income tax expense/(benefit)

   $ 348      $ 469      $ 179   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-78


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

15. Income Taxes (Continued)

 

The tax effect of temporary differences that give rise to deferred tax assets and liabilities include the following:

 

 

     December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010  

Deferred tax assets:

     

Loan reserves

   $ 959       $ 909   

Market value adjustments on student loans, investments and derivatives

     595         480   

Stock-based compensation plans

     78         73   

Deferred revenue

     62         71   

Accrued expenses not currently deductible

     51         53   

Operating loss and credit carryovers

     49         22   

Student loan premiums and discounts, net

     43         47   

Intangible assets

     2         80   

Other

     3         82   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets

     1,842         1,817   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Deferred tax liabilities:

     

Gains/(losses) on repurchased debt

     297         300   

Leases

     37         53   

Other

     37         26   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

     371         379   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

   $ 1,471       $ 1,438   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Included in other deferred tax assets is a valuation allowance of $31 million and $33 million as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, against a portion of the Company’s federal, state and international deferred tax assets. The valuation allowance is primarily attributable to deferred tax assets for federal and state capital loss carryovers and state and international net operating loss carryovers that management believes it is more likely than not will expire prior to being realized. The ultimate realization of the deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income of the appropriate character (i.e. capital or ordinary) during the period in which the temporary differences become deductible. Management considers, among other things, the economic slowdown, the scheduled reversals of deferred tax liabilities, and the history of positive taxable income available for net operating loss carrybacks in evaluating the realizability of the deferred tax assets.

As of December 31, 2011, we have apportioned state net operating loss carryforwards of $375 million which begin to expire in 2013, state capital loss carryovers of $7 million which begin to expire in 2014, international net operating loss carryforwards of $.5 million which begin to expire in 2032, and federal and state credit carryovers of $.3 million which begin to expire in 2020.

Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes

The following table summarizes changes in unrecognized tax benefits:

 

 

     December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011     2010     2009  

Unrecognized tax benefits at beginning of year

   $ 41.7      $ 104.4      $ 86.4   

Increases resulting from tax positions taken during a prior period

     20.5        13.1        75.2   

Decreases resulting from tax positions taken during a prior period

     (2.1     (47.5     (58.3

Increases/(decreases) resulting from tax positions taken during the current period

     (9.1     (2.5     (22.5

Decreases related to settlements with taxing authorities

            (87.6     (17.9

Increases related to settlements with taxing authorities

     0.4        69.1        44.7   

Reductions related to the lapse of statute of limitations

     (5.5     (7.3     (3.2
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Unrecognized tax benefits at end of year

   $ 45.9      $ 41.7      $ 104.4   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-79


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

15. Income Taxes (Continued)

 

As of December 31, 2011, the gross unrecognized tax benefits are $45.9 million. Included in the $45.9 million are $22.3 million of unrecognized tax benefits that, if recognized, would favorably impact the effective tax rate.

The IRS began the examination of our 2009 U.S. federal income tax returns during the fourth quarter of 2010, and we expect to resolve this audit during 2012. The resolution of the 2009 audit will not have a material impact on our unrecognized tax benefits.

The Company or one of its subsidiaries files income tax returns at the U.S. federal level, in most U.S. states, and various foreign jurisdictions. U.S. federal income tax returns filed for years 2008 and prior have been audited and are now resolved. Various combinations of subsidiaries, tax years, and jurisdictions remain open for review, subject to statute of limitations periods (typically 3 to 4 prior years).

 

16. Segment Reporting

We monitor and assess our ongoing operations and results by three primary operating segments — the Consumer Lending operating segment, the Business Services operating segment and the FFELP Loan operating segment. These three operating segments meet the quantitative thresholds for reportable segments. Accordingly, the results of operations of our Consumer Lending, Business Services and FFELP Loans segments are presented separately. We have smaller operating segments that consist of business operations that have either been discontinued or are winding down. These operating segments do not meet the quantitative thresholds to be considered reportable segments. As a result, the results of operations for these operating segments (Purchased Paper business and mortgage and other loan business) are combined with gains/losses from the repurchase of debt, the financial results of our corporate liquidity portfolio and all overhead within the Other reportable segment. The management reporting process measures the performance of our operating segments based on our management structure, as well as the methodology we used to evaluate performance and allocate resources. Management, including our chief operating decision makers, evaluates the performance of our operating segments based on their profitability. As discussed further below, we measure the profitability of our operating segments based on “Core Earnings.” Accordingly, information regarding our reportable segments is provided based on a “Core Earnings” basis.

Consumer Lending Segment

In this segment, we originate, acquire, finance and service Private Education Loans. The Private Education Loans we make are largely to bridge the gap between the cost of higher education and the amount funded through financial aid, federal loans or borrowers’ resources.

Private Education Loans bear the full credit risk of the borrower. We manage this risk by underwriting and pricing according to credit risk based upon customized credit scoring criteria and the addition of qualified cosigners. For the year ended December 31, 2011, our annual charge-off rate for Private Education Loans (as a percentage of loans in repayment) was 3.7 percent, as compared to 5.0 percent for the prior year.

In 2011, we originated $2.7 billion of Private Education Loans, an increase of 19 percent from the prior year even as borrowings under Private Education Loan programs contracted by approximately 12 percent. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, we had $36.3 billion and $35.7 billion of Private Education Loans outstanding, respectively. At December 31, 2011, 56 percent of our Private Education Loans were funded with non-recourse, long-term debt; 51 percent of our Private Education Loans being funded to term by securitization trusts.

 

F-80


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

In this segment, we also earn net interest income on the Private Education Loan portfolio (after provision for loan losses) as well as servicing fees, primarily late payment and forbearance fees. Operating expenses for this segment include costs incurred to acquire and to service our loans.

Since the beginning of 2006, all of our Private Education Loans have been originated and funded by the Bank, a Utah industrial bank subsidiary regulated by the Utah Department of Financial Institutions and the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”). At December 31, 2011, the Bank had total assets of $7.6 billion including $5.0 billion in Private Education Loans. As of the same date, the Bank had total deposits of $6.3 billion. The Bank relies on both retail and brokered deposits to fund its assets. The Bank is also a key component of our Campus Solutions and college savings products businesses. Deposits and refunds from our Campus Solutions business are held at the Bank. In addition, Upromise rewards earned by members are held at the Bank.

We face competition for Private Education Loans from a group of the nation’s larger banks and local credit unions.

The following table includes asset information for our Consumer Lending segment.

 

 

      December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010  

Private Education Loans, net

   $ 36,290       $ 35,656   

Cash and investments(1)

     3,113         3,372   

Other

     3,595         4,004   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 42,998       $ 43,032   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

Includes restricted cash and investments.

Business Services Segment

Our Business Services segment generates the vast majority of its revenue from servicing our FFELP Loan portfolio and from performing servicing default aversion and contingency collections work on behalf of ED, Guarantors of FFELP Loans, and other institutions. The elimination of FFELP in July 2010 will cause these FFELP-related revenue sources to continue to decline.

 

   

Servicing revenues from the FFELP Loans we own and manage represent intercompany charges to the FFELP Loans segment at rates paid to us by the trusts which own the loans. These fees are legally the first payment priority of the trusts and exceed the actual cost of servicing the loans. Intercompany loan servicing revenues grew to $739 million in 2011 from $648 million in 2010. The increase in loan servicing revenues was the result of the acquisition of a large portfolio of loans on December 31, 2010. Intercompany loan servicing revenues will decline as the FFELP portfolio amortizes.

 

   

In 2011, we earned account maintenance fees on FFELP Loans serviced for Guarantors of $46 million, down from $56 million in 2010. These fees will continue to decline as the portfolio amortizes.

 

   

In 2011, contingency collection revenue from Guarantor clients totaled $246 million, unchanged compared with the prior year. We anticipate these revenues will begin to steadily decline in 2013.

The scale, diversification and performance of our Business Services segment have been, and we expect them to remain, a competitive advantage for us. As FFELP-related service revenue streams decline, we will strive to replace them over the coming years by exploring both complementary and

 

F-81


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

diversified strategies to expand demand for our services in and beyond the student loan market. For example, in 2011 we launched Sallie Mae Insurance Services to offer tuition, renters’ and student health insurance to college students and higher education institutions. We also acquired SC Services & Associates to enhance our ability to provide collections services to local governments and courts.

Our primary Business Services activities that are not directly related to the FFELP include:

Upromise

Upromise generates revenue by providing program management services for 529 college-savings plans with assets of $37.5 billion in 31 college-savings plans in 16 states. We also generate transaction fees through our Upromise consumer savings network, through which members have earned $660 million in rewards by purchasing products at hundreds of online retailers, booking travel, purchasing a home, dining out, buying gas and groceries, using the Upromise World MasterCard, or completing other qualified transactions. We earn a fee for the marketing and administrative services we provide to companies that participate in the Upromise savings network. We compete for 529 college-savings plan business with a large array of banks, financial services and other processing companies. We also compete with other loyalty shopping services and companies.

ED Servicing and Collection Contracts

In the second quarter of 2009, ED named Sallie Mae as one of four servicers awarded a servicing contract (the “ED Servicing Contract”) to service all newly disbursed federal loans owned by ED. The contract spans five years with one, five-year renewal at the option of ED. We compete for Direct Loan servicing volume from ED with the three other servicing companies with whom we share the contract. Account allocations are awarded annually based on each company’s performance on five different metrics: defaulted borrower count, defaulted borrower dollar amount, a survey of borrowers, a survey of schools and a survey of ED personnel. Pursuant to the contract terms related to annual volume allocation of new loans, the maximum any servicer could be awarded is 40 percent of net new borrowers in that contract year. We are focused on our performance to increase our allocation of new accounts under the ED Servicing Contract. Our share of new loans serviced for ED under the ED Servicing Contract increased to 26 percent in 2012 from 22 percent in the prior contract year as a result of an improvement of our performance on the ED scorecard.

Since 1997, we have provided collection services on defaulted student loans to ED customers. The current contract runs through December 31, 2012, with two one-year renewal options by ED. There are 21 other collection providers, of which we compete with 16 providers for account allocation based on quarterly performance metrics. As a consistent top performer, our share of allocated accounts has ranged from six percent to eight percent for this contract period.

Other

Our Campus Solutions business offers a suite of solutions designed to help campus business offices increase their services to students and families. The product suite includes electronic billing, collection, payment and refund services plus full tuition payment plan administration. In 2011, we generated servicing revenue from over 1,100 schools.

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Business Services segment had total assets of $912 million and $930 million, respectively.

 

 

F-82


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

FFELP Loans Segment

Our FFELP Loans segment consists of our FFELP Loan portfolio and the underlying debt, related derivatives and capital funding the loans. FFELP Loans are insured or guaranteed by state or not-for-profit agencies and are also protected by contractual rights to recovery from the United States pursuant to guaranty agreements among ED and these agencies. These guarantees generally cover at least 97 percent of a FFELP Loan’s principal and accrued interest for loans disbursed before and after July 1, 2006, respectively. In the case of death, disability or bankruptcy of the borrower, these guarantees cover 100 percent of the loan’s principal and accrued interest.

At December 31, 2011, we held $138 billion of FFELP Loans, of which 94 percent were funded with nonrecourse, long-term debt; 76 percent of our FFELP Loans being funded to term by securitization trusts, 15 percent funded through the ED Conduit Program which terminates on January 19, 2014, and 3 percent funded through our multiyear asset-backed commercial paper (“ABCP”) facility. As a result of the long-term funding used in the FFELP Loan portfolio and the insurance and guarantees provided on these loans, the net interest margin recorded in the FFELP Loans segment is relatively stable and the capital requirements with respect to the segment are modest. In addition to the net interest margin, we earn fee income largely from late fees on the loans.

Our FFELP Loan portfolio will amortize over approximately 20 years. Our goal is to maximize the cash flow generated by the portfolio. We will seek to acquire other third-party FFELP Loan portfolios to add net interest income and servicing revenue.

The Higher Education Act (the “HEA”) regulates every aspect of the FFELP, including communications with borrowers and default aversion requirements. Failure to service a FFELP Loan properly could jeopardize the insurance and guarantees and federal support on these loans. The insurance and guarantees on our existing loans were not affected by HCERA.

The following table includes asset information for our FFELP Loans segment.

 

 

     December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010  

FFELP Loans, net

   $ 138,130       $ 148,649   

Cash and investments(1)

     6,067         5,963   

Other

     4,415         3,911   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total assets

   $ 148,612       $ 158,523   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

 

  (1) 

Includes restricted cash and investments.

Other Segment

The Other segment consists primarily of the financial results related to activities of our holding company, including the repurchase of debt, the corporate liquidity portfolio and all overhead. We also include results from smaller wind-down and discontinued operations within this segment. Overhead expenses include costs related to executive management, the board of directors, accounting, finance, legal, human resources, stock-based compensation expense and information technology costs related to infrastructure and operations.

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Other segment had total assets of $823 million and $2.8 billion, respectively.

 

F-83


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

Measure of Profitability

The tables below include the condensed operating results for each of our reportable segments. Management, including the chief operating decision makers, evaluates the Company on certain performance measures that we refer to as “Core Earnings” performance measures for each operating segment. We use “Core Earnings” to manage each business segment because “Core Earnings” reflect adjustments to GAAP financial results for three items, discussed below, that create significant volatility mostly due to timing factors generally beyond the control of management. Accordingly, we believe that “Core Earnings” provide management with a useful basis from which to better evaluate results from ongoing operations against the business plan or against results from prior periods. Consequently, we disclose this information as we believe it provides investors with additional information regarding the operational and performance indicators that are most closely assessed by management. The three items adjusted for in our “Core Earnings” presentations are (1) our use of derivatives instruments to hedge our economic risks that do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment or do qualify for hedge accounting treatment but result in ineffectiveness and (2) the accounting for goodwill and acquired intangible assets and (3) the off-balance sheet treatment of certain securitization transactions. The tables presented below reflect “Core Earnings” operating measures reviewed and utilized by management to manage the business. Reconciliation of the “Core Earnings” segment totals to our consolidated operating results in accordance with GAAP is also included in the tables below.

Our “Core Earnings” performance measures are not defined terms within GAAP and may not be comparable to similarly titled measures reported by other companies. Unlike financial accounting, there is no comprehensive, authoritative guidance for management reporting. The management reporting process measures the performance of the operating segments based on the management structure of the Company and is not necessarily comparable with similar information for any other financial institution. Our operating segments are defined by the products and services they offer or the types of customers they serve, and they reflect the manner in which financial information is currently evaluated by management. Intersegment revenues and expenses are netted within the appropriate financial statement line items consistent with the income statement presentation provided to management. Changes in management structure or allocation methodologies and procedures may result in changes in reported segment financial information.

 

F-84


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

Segment Results and Reconciliations to GAAP

 

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

  Consumer
Lending
    Business
Services
    FFELP
Loans
    Other     Eliminations(1)     Total  “Core
Earnings”
    Adjustments(2)     Total
GAAP
 

Interest income:

               

Student loans

  $ 2,429      $      $ 2,914      $      $      $ 5,343      $ 547      $ 5,890   

Other loans

                         21               21               21   

Cash and investments

    9        11        5        5        (11     19               19   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

    2,438        11        2,919        26        (11     5,383        547        5,930   

Total interest expense

    804               1,472        54        (11     2,319        82        2,401   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss)

    1,634        11        1,447        (28            3,064        465        3,529   

Less: provisions for loan losses

    1,179               86        30               1,295               1,295   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

    455        11        1,361        (58            1,769        465        2,234   

Servicing revenue

    64        970        85        1        (739     381               381   

Contingency revenue

           333                             333               333   

Gains on debt repurchases

                         64               64        (26     38   

Other income (loss)

    (9     70        1        (9            53        (979     (926
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income (loss)

    55        1,373        86        56        (739     831        (1,005     (174

Expenses:

               

Direct operating expenses

    304        482        760        12        (739     819               819   

Overhead expenses

                         281               281               281   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

    304        482        760        293        (739     1,100               1,100   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

                                              24        24   

Restructuring expenses

    3        3        1        2               9               9   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

    307        485        761        295        (739     1,109        24        1,133   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations, before income tax expense (benefit)

    203        899        686        (297            1,491        (564     927   

Income tax expense (benefit)(3)

    75        330        252        (109            548        (220     328   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

    128        569        434        (188            943        (344     599   

Income from discontinued operations, net of taxes

                         33               33               33   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

    128        569        434        (155            976        (344     632   

Less: loss attributable to noncontrolling interest

           (1                          (1            (1
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to SLM Corporation

  $ 128      $ 570      $ 434      $ (155   $      $ 977      $ (344   $ 633   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The eliminations in servicing revenue and direct operating expense represent the elimination of intercompany servicing revenue where the Business Services segment performs the loan servicing function for the FFELP Loans segment.

 

(2) 

“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2011  

(Dollars in millions)

   Net Impact  of
Derivative
Accounting
     Net Impact of
Goodwill and
Acquired
Intangibles
     Total  

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

   $ 465       $       $ 465   

Total other loss

     (1,005              (1,005

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

             24         24   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

   $ (540    $ (24      (564
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Income tax benefit

           (220
        

 

 

 

Net loss

         $ (344
        

 

 

 

 

(3) 

Income taxes are based on a percentage of net income before tax for the individual reportable segment.

 

F-85


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

  Consumer
Lending
    Business
Services
    FFELP
Loans
    Other     Eliminations(1)     Total  “Core
Earnings”
    Adjustments(2)     Total
GAAP
 

Interest income:

               

Student loans

  $ 2,353      $      $ 2,766      $      $      $ 5,119      $ 579      $ 5,698   

Other loans

                         30               30               30   

Cash and investments

    14        17        9        3        (17     26               26   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

    2,367        17        2,775        33        (17     5,175        579        5,754   

Total interest expense

    758               1,407        45        (17     2,193        82        2,275   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss)

    1,609        17        1,368        (12            2,982        497        3,479   

Less: provisions for loan losses

    1,298               98        23               1,419               1,419   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss) after provisions for loan losses

    311        17        1,270        (35            1,563        497        2,060   

Servicing revenue

    72        912        68        1        (648     405               405   

Contingency revenue

           330                             330               330   

Gains on debt repurchases

                         317               317               317   

Other income (loss)

           51        320        13               384        (414     (30
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income

    72        1,293        388        331        (648     1,436        (414     1,022   

Expenses:

               

Direct operating expenses

    350        500        736        12        (648     950               950   

Overhead expenses

                         258               258               258   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

    350        500        736        270        (648     1,208               1,208   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

                                              699        699   

Restructuring expenses

    12        7        54        12               85               85   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

    362        507        790        282        (648     1,293        699        1,992   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income from continuing operations, before income tax expense

    21        803        868        14               1,706        (616     1,090   

Income tax expense(3)

    8        288        311        4               611        (118     493   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income from continuing operations

    13        515        557        10               1,095        (498     597   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of taxes

                         (67            (67            (67
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ 13      $ 515      $ 557      $ (57   $      $ 1,028      $ (498   $ 530   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The eliminations in servicing revenue and direct operating expense represent the elimination of intercompany servicing revenue where the Business Services segment performs the loan servicing function for the FFELP Loans segment.

 

(2) 

“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2010  

(Dollars in millions)

   Net Impact
of
Derivative
Accounting
     Net Impact of
Goodwill and
Acquired
Intangibles
     Total  

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

   $ 497       $       $ 497   

Total other loss

     (414              (414

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

             699         699   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

   $ 83       $ (699      (616
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

Income tax benefit

           (118
        

 

 

 

Net loss

         $ (498
        

 

 

 

 

(3) 

Income taxes are based on a percentage of net income before tax for the individual reportable segment.

 

 

F-86


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

    Year Ended December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

  Consumer
Lending
    Business
Services
    FFELP
Loans
    Other     Eliminations(1)     Total  “Core
Earnings”
    Adjustments(2)     Total
GAAP
 

Interest income:

               

Student loans

  $ 2,254      $      $ 3,252      $      $      $ 5,506      $ (830   $ 4,676   

Other loans

                         56               56               56   

Cash and investments

    13        20        26        (10     (20     29        (3     26   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total interest income

    2,267        20        3,278        46        (20     5,591        (833     4,758   

Total interest expense

    721               2,238        66        (20     3,005        30        3,035   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss)

    1,546        20        1,040        (20            2,586        (863     1,723   

Less: provisions for loan losses

    1,399               119        46               1,564        (445     1,119   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss) after provisions for loan losses

    147        20        921        (66            1,022        (418     604   

Servicing revenue

    70        954        75               (659     440               440   

Contingency revenue

           294                             294               294   

Gains on debt repurchases

                         536               536               536   

Other income

           55        292        1               348        (285     63   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total other income

    70        1,303        367        537        (659     1,618        (285     1,333   

Expenses:

               

Direct operating expenses

    265        440        754        6        (659     806               806   

Overhead expenses

                         237               237               237   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Operating expenses

    265        440        754        243        (659     1,043               1,043   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

                                              76        76   

Restructuring expenses

    2        2        8        (2            10               10   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total expenses

    267        442        762        241        (659     1,053        76        1,129   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from continuing operations, before income tax expense (benefit)

    (50     881        526        230               1,587        (779     808   

Income tax expense (benefit)(3)

    (18     311        186        81               560        (296     264   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

    (32     570        340        149               1,027        (483     544   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of taxes

                         (220            (220            (220
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

  $ (32   $ 570      $ 340      $ (71   $      $ 807      $ (483   $ 324   
 

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

(1) 

The eliminations in servicing revenue and direct operating expense represent the elimination of intercompany servicing revenue where the Business Services segment performs the loan servicing function for the FFELP Loans segment.

 

(2) 

“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:

 

     Year Ended December 31, 2009  

(Dollars in millions)

   Net Impact  of
Derivative
Accounting
     Net Impact of
Goodwill and
Acquired
Intangibles
     Net Impact  of
Securitization
Accounting
     Total  

Net interest income (loss)

   $ 78       $       $ (941    $ (863

Less: provisions for loan losses

                     (445      (445
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Net interest income (loss) after provisions for loan losses

     78                 (496      (418

Total other loss

     (580              295         (285

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization

             76                 76   
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

   $ (502    $ (76    $ (201      (779
  

 

 

    

 

 

    

 

 

    

Income tax benefit

              (296
           

 

 

 

Net loss

            $ (483
           

 

 

 
(3) 

Income taxes are based on a percentage of net income before tax for the individual reportable segment.

 

F-87


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

16. Segment Reporting (Continued)

 

Summary of “Core Earnings” Adjustments to GAAP

The adjustments required to reconcile from our “Core Earnings” results to our GAAP results of operations relate to differing treatments for securitization transactions, derivatives, Floor Income, and certain other items that management does not consider in evaluating our operating results. The following table reflects aggregate adjustments associated with these areas.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

       2011             2010             2009      

“Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP:

      

Net impact of derivative accounting(1)

   $ (540   $ 83      $ (502

Net impact of acquired intangibles(2)

     (24     (699     (76

Net impact of securitization accounting(3)

                   (201

Net tax effect(4)

     220        118        296   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total “Core Earnings” adjustments to GAAP

   $ (344   $ (498   $ (483
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

      

(1)      Derivative accounting: “Core Earnings” exclude periodic unrealized gains and losses that are caused primarily by the mark-to-market valuations on derivatives that do not qualify for hedge accounting treatment under GAAP. To a lesser extent, these periodic unrealized gains and losses are also a result of ineffectiveness recognized related to effective hedges. These unrealized gains and losses occur in our Consumer Lending, FFELP Loans and Other business segments. Under GAAP, for our derivatives that are held to maturity, the cumulative net unrealized gain or loss over the life of the contract will equal $0 except for Floor Income Contracts where the cumulative unrealized gain will equal the amount for which we sold the contract. In our “Core Earnings” presentation, we recognize the economic effect of these hedges, which generally results in any net settlement cash paid or received being recognized ratably as an interest expense or revenue over the hedged item’s life.

 

                  

(2)      Goodwill and Acquired Intangibles: We exclude goodwill and intangible impairment and amortization of acquired intangibles.

 

          

(3)      Securitization accounting: On January 1, 2010, we adopted the new consolidation accounting guidance which Consolidated our off-balance sheet securitization trusts. As a result, from 2010 forward, there is no longer a difference between our GAAP and “Core Earnings” presentation for securitization accounting. (See “Note 2 — Significant Accounting Policies” for further details). Prior to the adoption of the new consolidation accounting guidance on January 1, 2010, certain securitization transactions in our FFELP Loans and Consumer Lending business segments were accounted for as sales of assets. Under “Core Earnings” for the FFELP Loans and Consumer Lending business segments, we present all securitization transactions as long-term non-recourse financings. The upfront “gains” on sale from securitization transactions, as well as ongoing “securitization servicing and Residual Interest revenue (loss)” presented in accordance with GAAP, were excluded from “Core Earnings” and were replaced by interest income, provisions for loan losses, and interest expense as earned or incurred on the securitization loans. The additional net interest margin included in “Core Earnings” contained any related fees or costs such as Consolidation Loan Rebate Fees, premium and discount amortization as well as any Repayment Borrower Benefit yield adjustments. We also excluded transactions with our off-balance sheet trusts from “Core Earnings” as they were considered intercompany transactions on a “Core Earnings” basis. While we believe that our “Core Earnings” presentation presents the economic substance of results from our loan portfolios, when compared to GAAP results, it understates earnings volatility from securitization gains, securitization servicing income and Residual Interest income.

 

                         

(4)      Net Tax Effect: Such tax effect is based upon our “Core Earnings” effective tax rate for the year.

 

         

 

 

F-88


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

17. Discontinued Operations

Our Purchased Paper businesses are presented in discontinued operations for the current and prior periods. In the fourth quarter of 2009, we sold our Purchased Paper — Mortgage/Properties business for $280 million which resulted in an after-tax loss of $95 million. As a result of this sale, the results of operations of this business were required to be presented in discontinued operations beginning in the fourth quarter of 2009.

In the fourth quarter of 2010, we began actively marketing for sale our Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business and concluded it was probable this business would be sold within one year at which time we would exit the business. The Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business comprises operations and cash flows that can be clearly distinguished operationally and for financial reporting purposes from the rest of the Company. As a result, we have classified the business as held-for-sale, and, as such, the results of operations of this business were required to be presented in discontinued operations beginning in the fourth quarter of 2010. In connection with this classification, we were required to carry this business at the lower of fair value or historical cost basis. This resulted in us recording an after-tax loss of $52 million from discontinued operations in the fourth quarter of 2010, primarily due to adjusting the value of this business to its estimated fair value. We sold the Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business in the third quarter of 2011 which resulted in a $23 million after-tax gain.

The Purchased Paper — Mortgage/Properties business and the Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business comprise operations and cash flows that can be clearly distinguished operationally and for financial reporting purposes, from the rest of the Company. Accordingly, this Component is presented as discontinued operations as (1) the operations and cash flows of the Component have been eliminated from our ongoing operations as of December 31, 2010, and (2) we will have no continuing involvement in the operations of this Component subsequent to the sale of the Purchased Paper-Non Mortgage business.

The following table summarizes the discontinued assets and liabilities at December 31, 2011 and 2010.

 

 

     At December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010  

Assets:

     

Cash and equivalents

   $ 3       $ 4   

Other assets

     14         177   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Assets of discontinued operations

   $ 17       $ 181   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

Liabilities:

     

Liabilities of discontinued operations

   $ 7       $ 6   
  

 

 

    

 

 

 

At December 31, 2011, other assets of our discontinued operations consist primarily of restricted cash and a deferred tax asset for wind down accruals. Liabilities of our discontinued operations consist primarily of sale related liabilities and restructuring liabilities related to severance and contract termination costs.

At December 31, 2010, other assets of our discontinued operations consist primarily of the Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage loan portfolio and a deferred tax asset for intangibles that will be realized when the tax loss for the sale of our Purchased Paper — Non-Mortgage business is utilized on our consolidated income tax return. Liabilities of our discontinued operations consist primarily of restructuring liabilities related to severance and contract termination costs.

 

F-89


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

17. Discontinued Operations (Continued)

 

The following table summarizes the discontinued operations.

 

 

     Years Ended December 31,  

(Dollars in millions)

   2011      2010     2009  

Operations:

       

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

   $ 53       $ (91   $ (305

Income tax expense (benefit)

     20         (24     (85
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of taxes

   $ 33       $ (67   $ (220
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Disposal:

       

Loss on disposal before income taxes

   $       $      $ (119

Income tax benefit

                    (23
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

Loss on disposal, net of taxes

   $       $      $ (96
  

 

 

    

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

18. Concentrations of Risk

Our business is primarily focused in providing and/or servicing to help students and their families save, plan and pay for college. We primarily originate, service and/or collect loans made to students and/or their parents to finance the cost of their education. We provide funding, delivery and servicing support for education loans in the United States, through our Private Education Loan programs and as a servicer and collector of loans for ED. In addition we are the largest holder, servicer and collector of loans under FFELP, a program that was recently discontinued. Because of this concentration in one industry, we are exposed to credit, legislative, operational, regulatory, and liquidity risks associated with the student loan industry.

Concentration Risk in the Revenues Associated with Private Education Loans

We are the leader in the origination of Private Education Loans. As such, we are exposed to the risk that students and their families have greater access to federal loans or grants for education which, in turn, would reduce our opportunity to originate and service Private Education Loans. Students and their families use multiple sources of funding to pay for their college education, including savings, current income, grants, scholarships, and FFELP and Private Education Loans. Due to an increase in federal loan limits that took effect in 2007 and 2008, we have seen a substantial increase in borrowing from federal loan programs in recent years. In addition to the risk associated with reduced Private Education Loan volumes, we are exposed to credit risk from economic conditions, particularly as they relate to the ability of recent graduates to find jobs in their fields of study, thereby increasing our risk of loss.

Concentration Risk in the Revenues Associated with FFELP Loans

Effective July 1, 2010, the HCERA legislation required that all new federal loans are to be made through the DSLP and eliminated the FFELP through which we currently generate the majority of our net income. The new law did not alter or affect the terms and conditions of existing FFELP Loans. We no longer originate FFELP Loans and therefore no longer earn revenue on newly originated FFELP Loan volume after 2010. The net interest margin we earn on our FFELP Loans portfolio, which totaled $1.9 billion in 2011, will decline over time as the portfolio amortizes.

HCERA also eliminated the need for the Guarantors and the services we provided to the sector. We earned an origination fee when we processed a loan guarantee for a Guarantor client and a maintenance fee for the life of the loan for servicing the Guarantor’s portfolio of loans. FFELP Loans are no longer originated; therefore, we no

 

F-90


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

18. Concentrations of Risk (Continued)

 

longer earn the origination fee paid by the Guarantor. The portfolio that generates the maintenance fee is now in runoff, and the maintenance fees we earn will decline ratably with the portfolio. We earned maintenance fees of $45.9 million in 2011.

Our student loan contingent collection business is also affected by HCERA. We currently have 13 Guarantors as clients. We earn revenue from Guarantors for collecting defaulted loans as well as for managing their portfolios of defaulted loans. In 2011, collection revenue from Guarantor clients totaled $246 million. We anticipate that revenue from Guarantors will be relatively stable through 2012 and then begin to steadily decline as the portfolio of defaulted loans we manage is resolved and amortizes.

Concentration Risk in the Servicing of Direct Loans

The DSLP is serviced by four private sector institutions, including Sallie Mae. Defaulted Direct Loans are collected by 22 private sector companies, including Sallie Mae. Because of the concentration of our business in servicing and collecting on Direct Loans, we are exposed to risks associated with ED reducing the amount of new loan servicing and collections allocated to us or the termination of our servicing or collections contracts.

 

F-91


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

19. Quarterly Financial Information (unaudited)

 

 

     2011  

(Dollars in millions, except per share data)

   First
Quarter
    Second
Quarter
    Third
Quarter
    Fourth
Quarter
 

Net interest income

   $ 898      $ 868      $ 885      $ 879   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     303        291        409        292   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

     595        577        476        587   

Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net

     (242     (510     (480     272   

Other income

     236        182        180        187   

Operating expenses

     303        268        285        243   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets amortization expense

     6        6        6        5   

Restructuring expenses

     4        2        1        3   

Income tax expense (benefit)

     99        (10     (46     285   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

     177        (17     (70     510   

Income (loss) from discontinued operations, net of taxes

     (2     11        23        1   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     175        (6     (47     511   

Less: net income (loss) attributable to noncontrolling interest

                            
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to SLM Corporation

     175        (6     (47     511   

Preferred stock dividends

     4        4        5        5   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to SLM Corporation common stock

   $ 171      $ (10   $ (52   $ 506   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

        

Continuing operations

   $ .32      $ (.04   $ (.14   $ 1.00   

Discontinued operations

            .02        .04          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ .32      $ (.02   $ (.10   $ 1.00   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings (loss) per common share attributable to SLM Corporation:

        

Continuing operations

   $ .32      $ (.04   $ (.14   $ .99   

Discontinued operations

            .02        .04          
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ .32      $ (.02   $ (.10   $ .99   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

F-92


Table of Contents

SLM CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

 

19. Quarterly Financial Information (unaudited) (Continued)

 

 

     2010  

(Dollars in millions, except per share data)

   First
Quarter
    Second
Quarter
    Third
Quarter
    Fourth
Quarter
 

Net interest income

   $ 854      $ 896      $ 872      $ 857   

Less: provisions for loan losses

     359        382        358        320   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net interest income after provisions for loan losses

     495        514        514        537   

Gains (losses) on derivative and hedging activities, net

     (82     95        (344     (29

Other income

     315        272        192        603   

Operating expenses

     287        309        302        308   

Goodwill and acquired intangible assets impairment and amortization expense

     10        10        670        10   

Restructuring expenses

     25        18        10        33   

Income tax expense (benefit)

     159        199        (126     261   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) from continuing operations

     247        345        (494     499   

Loss from discontinued operations, net of taxes

     (7     (7     (1     (52
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss)

     240        338        (495     447   

Preferred stock dividends

     19        19        19        16   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Net income (loss) attributable to common stock

   $ 221      $ 319      $ (514   $ 431   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Basic earnings (loss) per common share:

        

Continuing operations

   $ .47      $ .67      $ (1.06   $ .99   

Discontinued operations

     (.01     (.01            (.11
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ .46      $ .66      $ (1.06   $ .88   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Diluted earnings (loss) per common share:

        

Continuing operations

   $ .46      $ .64      $ (1.06   $ .94   

Discontinued operations

     (.01     (.01            (.10
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

Total

   $ .45      $ .63      $ (1.06   $ .84   
  

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

   

 

 

 

 

 

F-93


Table of Contents

APPENDIX A

FEDERAL FAMILY EDUCATION LOAN PROGRAM (“FFELP”)

Note: On March 30, 2010, the President signed into law the Health Care and Education Reconciliation Act of 2010 (“HCERA”) which terminated the FFELP as of July 1, 2010. This appendix presents an abbreviated summary of the program prior to the termination date. The new law does not alter or affect the terms and conditions of existing FFELP Loans made before July 1, 2010 or the credit support related thereto. For a more fulsome discussion and history of some of the topics described herein, see Appendix A to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2010 (the “2010 Form 10-K”).

This appendix describes or summarizes the material provisions of Title IV of the Higher Education Act (“HEA”), the FFELP and related statutes and regulations. It, however, is not complete and is qualified in its entirety by reference to each actual statute and regulation. Both the HEA and the related regulations has been the subject of extensive amendments over the years. We cannot predict whether future amendments or modifications might materially change any of the programs described in this appendix or the statutes and regulations that implement them.

General

The FFELP, under Title IV of HEA, provided for loans to students who were enrolled in eligible institutions, or to parents of dependent students who were enrolled in eligible institutions, to finance their educational costs. Payment of principal and interest on the student loans to the holders of the loans is insured by a state or not-for-profit guaranty agency against:

 

   

default of the borrower;

 

   

the death, bankruptcy or permanent, total disability of the borrower;

 

   

closing of the student’s school prior to the end of the academic period;

 

   

false certification of the borrower’s eligibility for the loan by the school; and

 

   

an unpaid school refund.

Claims are paid from federal assets, known as “federal student loan reserve funds,” which are maintained and administered by state and not-for-profit guaranty agencies. In addition the holders of student loans are entitled to receive interest subsidy payments and Special Allowance Payments from ED on eligible student loans. Special Allowance Payments raise the yield to student loan lenders when the statutory borrower interest rate is below an indexed market value.

Four types of FFELP Loans were authorized under the HEA:

 

   

Subsidized Federal Stafford Loans to students who demonstrated requisite financial need;

 

   

Unsubsidized Federal Stafford Loans to students who either did not demonstrate financial need or require additional loans to supplement their Subsidized Stafford Loans;

 

   

Federal PLUS Loans to graduate or professional students (effective July 1, 2006) or parents of dependent students whose estimated costs of attending school exceed other available financial aid; and

 

   

FFELP Consolidation Loans, which consolidate into a single loan a borrower’s obligations under various federally authorized student loan programs.

Legislative Matters

The federal student loan programs are subject to frequent statutory and regulatory changes. The most significant change to FFELP was with the enactment of the HCERA, which terminated FFELP as of July 1, 2010.

 

A-1


Table of Contents

On December 23, 2011, the President signed the Consolidated Appropriations Act of 2012 into law. This law includes changes that permit FFELP lenders or beneficial holders to change the index on which the Special Allowance Payments are calculated for FFELP Loans first disbursed on or after January 1, 2000. The law allows holders to elect to move the index from the Commercial Paper (“CP”) Rate to the one-month London Inter Bank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”). Such elections must be made by April 1, 2012.

Eligible Lenders, Students and Educational Institutions

Lenders who were eligible to make loans under the FFELP generally included banks, savings and loan associations, credit unions, pension funds and, under some conditions, schools and guaranty agencies. A federal student loan may be made to, or on behalf of, a “qualified student.” A “qualified student” is an individual who

 

   

is a United States citizen, national or permanent resident;

 

   

has been accepted for enrollment or is enrolled and maintaining satisfactory academic progress at a participating educational institution; and

 

   

is carrying at least one-half of the normal full-time academic workload for the course of study the student is pursuing.

A student qualified for a subsidized Stafford Loan if his family met the financial need requirements for the particular loan program. Only PLUS Loan borrowers have to meet credit standards.

Eligible schools included institutions of higher education, including proprietary institutions, meeting the standards provided in the HEA. For a school to participate in the program, the U.S. Department of Education (“ED”) had to approve its eligibility under standards established by regulation.

Financial Need Analysis

Subject to program limits and conditions, student loans generally were made in amounts sufficient to cover the student’s estimated costs of attending school, including tuition and fees, books, supplies, room and board, transportation and miscellaneous personal expenses as determined by the institution. Generally, each loan applicant (and parents in the case of a dependent child) underwent a financial need analysis.

Special Allowance Payments (“SAP”)

The HEA provides for quarterly Special Allowance Payments to be made by ED to holders of student loans to the extent necessary to ensure that they receive at least specified market interest rates of return. The rates for Special Allowance Payments depend on formulas that vary according to the type of loan, the date the loan was made and the type of funds, tax-exempt or taxable, used to finance the loan. ED makes a Special Allowance Payment for each calendar quarter.

The Special Allowance Payment equals the average unpaid principal balance, including interest which has been capitalized, of all eligible loans held by a holder during the quarterly period multiplied by the special allowance percentage.

For a discussion on the computation of the special allowance percentage and special allowance margin, see Appendix A to our 2010 Form 10-K.

Fees

Loan Rebate Fee. A loan rebate fee of 1.05% is paid annually on the unpaid principal and interest of each Consolidation Loan disbursed on or after October 1, 1993. This fee was reduced to .62% for loans made from October 1, 1998 to January 31, 1999.

 

A-2


Table of Contents

Stafford Loan Program

For Stafford Loans, the HEA provided for:

 

   

federal reimbursement of Stafford Loans made by eligible lenders to qualified students;

 

   

federal interest subsidy payments on Subsidized Stafford Loans paid by ED to holders of the loans in lieu of the borrowers’ making interest payments during in-school, grace and deferment periods; and

 

   

Special Allowance Payments representing an additional subsidy paid by ED to the holders of eligible Stafford Loans.

We refer to all three types of assistance as “federal assistance.”

The HEA also permits, and in some cases requires, “forbearance” periods from loan collection in some circumstances. Interest that accrues during forbearance is never subsidized. Interest that accrues during deferment periods may be subsidized.

PLUS and SLS Loan Programs

The HEA authorizes PLUS Loans to be made to graduate or professional students (effective July 1, 2006) and parents of eligible dependent students and previously authorized SLS Loans to be made to the categories of students now served by the Unsubsidized Stafford Loan program. Borrowers who have no adverse credit history or who are able to secure an endorser without an adverse credit history are eligible for PLUS Loans, as well as some borrowers with extenuating circumstances. The federal assistance applicable to PLUS and SLS Loans are similar to those of Stafford Loans. However, interest subsidy payments are not available under the PLUS and SLS programs and, in some instances, Special Allowance Payments are more restricted.

The annual and aggregate amounts of PLUS Loans were limited only to the difference between the cost of the student’s education and other financial aid received, including scholarship, grants and other student loans.

Consolidation Loan Program

The enactment of HCERA ended new originations under the FFELP consolidation program, effective July 1, 2010. Previously, the HEA authorized a program under which borrowers may consolidate one or more of their student loans into a single FFELP Consolidation Loan that was insured and reinsured on a basis similar to Stafford and PLUS Loans. FFELP Consolidation Loans were made in an amount sufficient to pay outstanding principal, unpaid interest, late charges and collection costs on all federally reinsured student loans incurred under the FFELP that the borrower selects for consolidation, as well as loans made under various other federal student loan programs and loans made by different lenders. In general, a borrower’s eligibility to consolidate their federal student loans ends upon receipt of a Consolidation Loan. With the end of new FFELP originations, borrowers with multiple loans, including FFELP loans, may only consolidate their loans in the DSLP. For additional information regarding the Consolidation Loan Program, see Appendix A to our 2010 Form 10-K.

Guaranty Agencies under the FFELP

Under the FFELP, guaranty agencies insured FFELP loans made by eligible lending institutions, paying claims from “federal student loan reserve funds.” These loans are insured as to 100 percent of principal and accrued interest against death or discharge. FFELP loans are also insured against default, with the percent insured dependent on the date of the loans disbursement. For loans that were made before October 1, 1993, lenders are insured for 100 percent of the principal and unpaid accrued interest. From October 1, 1993 to June 30, 2006, lenders are insured for 98 percent of principal and all unpaid accrued interest. Insurance for loans made on or after July 1, 2006 was reduced from 98 percent to 97 percent.

 

A-3


Table of Contents

ED guarantees to the guaranty agencies reimbursement of amounts paid to lenders on FFELP Loans. Under the HEA, the guaranty agencies by way of guaranty agreements entered into with ED are, subject to conditions, deemed to have a contractual right against the United States during the life of the loan to receive reimbursement for these amounts.

 

After ED reimburses a guaranty agency for a default claim, the guaranty agency attempts to collect the loan from the borrower. However, ED requires that the defaulted loans be assigned to it when the guaranty agency is not successful. A guaranty agency also refers defaulted loans to ED to “offset” any federal income tax refunds or other federal reimbursement which may be due the borrowers. Some states have similar offset programs.

To be eligible, FFELP loans must meet the requirements of the HEA and regulations issued under the HEA. Generally, these regulations require that lenders determine whether the applicant is an eligible borrower attending an eligible institution, explain to borrowers their responsibilities under the loan, ensure that the promissory notes evidencing the loan are executed by the borrower; and disburse the loan proceeds as required. After the loan is made, the lender must establish repayment terms with the borrower, properly administer deferrals and forbearances, credit the borrower for payments made, and report the loan’s status to credit reporting agencies. If a borrower becomes delinquent in repaying a loan, a lender must perform collection procedures that vary depending upon the length of time a loan is delinquent. The collection procedures consist of telephone calls, demand letters, skiptracing procedures and requesting assistance from the guaranty agency.

A lender may submit a default claim to the guaranty agency after a student loan has been delinquent for at least 270 days. The guaranty agency must review and pay the claim within 90 days after the lender filed it. The guaranty agency will pay the lender interest accrued on the loan for up to 450 days after delinquency. The guaranty agency must file a reimbursement claim with ED within 45 days (reduced to 30 days July 1, 2006) after the guaranty agency paid the lender for the default claim. Following payment of claims, the guaranty agency endeavors to collect the loan. Guaranty agencies also must meet statutory and regulatory requirements for collecting loans.

If ED determines that a guaranty agency is unable to meet its insurance obligations, the holders of loans insured by that guaranty agency may submit claims directly to ED and ED is required to pay the full reimbursements amounts due, in accordance with claim processing standards no more stringent than those applied by the affected guaranty agency. However, ED’s obligation to pay reimbursement amounts directly in this fashion is contingent upon ED determining a guaranty agency is unable to meet its obligations. While there have been situations where ED has made such determinations regarding affected guaranty agencies, there can be no assurances as to whether ED must make such determinations in the future or whether payments of reimbursement amounts would be made in a timely manner.

Student Loan Discharges

FFELP Loans are not generally dischargeable in bankruptcy. Under the United States Bankruptcy Code, before a student loan may be discharged, the borrower must demonstrate that repaying it would cause the borrower or his family undue hardship. When a FFELP borrower files for bankruptcy, collection of the loan is suspended during the time of the proceeding. If the borrower files under the “wage earner” provisions of the Bankruptcy Code or files a petition for discharge on the ground of undue hardship, then the lender transfers the loan to the guaranty agency which then participates in the bankruptcy proceeding. When the proceeding is complete, unless there was a finding of undue hardship, the loan is transferred back to the lender and collection resumes.

Student loans are discharged if the borrower died or becomes totally and permanently disabled. A physician must certify eligibility for a total and permanent disability discharge. Effective January 29, 2007, discharge eligibility was extended to survivors of eligible public servants and certain other eligible victims of the terrorist attacks on the United States on September 11, 2001.

 

A-4


Table of Contents

If a school closes while a student is enrolled, or within 90 days after the student withdrew, loans made for that enrollment period are discharged. If a school falsely certifies that a borrower is eligible for the loan, the loan may be discharged. And if a school fails to make a refund to which a student is entitled, the loan is discharged to the extent of the unpaid refund.

Rehabilitation of Defaulted Loans

ED is authorized to enter into agreements with the guaranty agency under which the guaranty agency may sell defaulted loans that are eligible for rehabilitation to an eligible lender. For a loan to be eligible for rehabilitation the guaranty agency must have received reasonable and affordable payments for 12 months (reduced to 9 payments in 10 months effective July 1, 2006), then the borrower may request that the loan be rehabilitated. Because monthly payments are usually greater after rehabilitation, not all borrowers opt for rehabilitation. Upon rehabilitation, a borrower is again eligible for all the benefits under the HEA for which he or she is not eligible as a borrower on a defaulted loan, such as new federal aid, and the negative credit record is expunged. No student loan may be rehabilitated more than once.

The July 1, 2009 technical corrections made to the HEA under H.R. 1777, Public Law 111-39, provide authority between July 1, 2009 through September 30, 2011, for a guaranty agency to assign a defaulted loan to ED depending on market conditions.

 

A-5


Table of Contents

GLOSSARY

Listed below are definitions of key terms that are used throughout this document. See also Appendix A “Federal Family Education Loan Program” for a further discussion of the FFELP.

Consolidation Loan Rebate Fee — All holders of FFELP Consolidation Loans are required to pay to the U.S. Department of Education (“ED”) an annual 105 basis point Consolidation Loan Rebate Fee on all outstanding principal and accrued interest balances of FFELP Consolidation Loans purchased or originated after October 1, 1993, except for loans for which consolidation applications were received between October 1, 1998 and January 31, 1999, where the Consolidation Loan Rebate Fee is 62 basis points.

Constant Prepayment Rate (“CPR”) — A variable in life-of-loan estimates that measures the rate at which loans in the portfolio prepay before their stated maturity. The CPR is directly correlated to the average life of the portfolio. CPR equals the percentage of loans that prepay annually as a percentage of the beginning of period balance.

“Core Earnings” — We prepare financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles in the United States of America (“GAAP”). In addition to evaluating our GAAP-based financial information, management evaluates the business segments on a basis that, as allowed under the Financial Accounting Standards Board’s (“FASB”) Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) 280, “Segment Reporting,” differs from GAAP. We refer to management’s basis of evaluating its segment results as “Core Earnings” presentations for each business segment and refer to these performance measures in its presentations with credit rating agencies and lenders. While “Core Earnings” results are not a substitute for reported results under GAAP, we rely on “Core Earnings” performance measures in operating each business segment because we believes these measures provide additional information regarding the operational and performance indicators that are most closely assessed by management.

“Core Earnings” performance measures are the primary financial performance measures used by management to evaluate performance and to allocate resources. Accordingly, financial information is reported to management on a “Core Earnings” basis by reportable segment, as these are the measures used regularly by our chief operating decision makers. “Core Earnings” performance measures are used in developing our financial plans, tracking results, and establishing corporate performance targets and incentive compensation. Management believes this information provides additional insight into the financial performance of our core business activities. “Core Earnings” performance measures are not defined terms within GAAP and may not be comparable to similarly titled measures reported by other companies. Our “Core Earnings” presentation does not represent another comprehensive basis of accounting.

See “Note 16 — Segment Reporting” and Item 7 “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — ‘Core Earnings’ — Definition and Limitations — Differences between ‘Core Earnings’ and GAAP” for further discussion of the differences between “Core Earnings” and GAAP, as well as reconciliations between “Core Earnings” and GAAP.

In prior filings with the SEC of SLM Corporation’s annual reports on Form 10-K and quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, “Core Earnings” has been labeled as “‘Core’ net income” or “Managed net income” in certain instances.

Direct Loans — Educational loans provided by the DSLP (see definition below) to students and parent borrowers directly through ED (see definition below) rather than through a bank or other lender.

DSLP — The William D. Ford Federal Direct Loan Program.

ED — The U.S. Department of Education.

 

G-1


Table of Contents

Embedded Floor Income — Embedded Floor Income is Floor Income (see definition below) that is earned on off-balance sheet student loans that are in securitization trusts we sponsor. At the time of the securitization, the value of Embedded Fixed Rate Floor Income is included in the initial valuation of the Residual Interest (see definition below) and the gain or loss on sale of the student loans. Embedded Floor Income is also included in the quarterly fair value adjustments of the Residual Interest.

FFELP — The Federal Family Education Loan Program, formerly the Guaranteed Student Loan Program, a program that was discontinued in 2010.

FFELP Consolidation Loans — Under the FFELP, borrowers with multiple eligible student loans may have consolidated them into a single student loan with one lender at a fixed rate for the life of the loan. The new loan is considered a FFELP Consolidation Loan. The borrower rate on a FFELP Consolidation Loan is fixed for the term of the loan and was set by the weighted average interest rate of the loans being consolidated, rounded up to the nearest 1/8th of a percent, not to exceed 8.25 percent. Holders of FFELP Consolidation Loans are eligible to earn interest under the Special Allowance Payment (“SAP”) formula. In April 2008, we suspended originating new FFELP Consolidation Loans.

FFELP Stafford and Other Student Loans — Education loans to students or parents of students that are guaranteed or reinsured under the FFELP. The loans are primarily Stafford loans but also include PLUS and HEAL loans. The FFELP was discontinued in 2010.

Fixed Rate Floor Income — Fixed Rate Floor Income is Floor Income associated with student loans with borrower rates that are fixed to term (primarily FFELP Consolidation Loans and Stafford Loans originated on or after July 1, 2006).

Floor Income — For loans disbursed before April 1, 2006, FFELP Loans generally earn interest at the higher of either the borrower rate, which is fixed over a period of time, or a floating rate based on the SAP formula. We generally finance our student loan portfolio with floating rate debt whose interest is matched closely to the floating nature of the applicable SAP formula. If interest rates decline to a level at which the borrower rate exceeds the SAP formula rate, we continue to earn interest on the loan at the fixed borrower rate while the floating rate interest on our debt continues to decline. In these interest rate environments, we refer to the additional spread it earns between the fixed borrower rate and the SAP formula rate as Floor Income. Depending on the type of student loan and when it was originated, the borrower rate is either fixed to term or is reset to a market rate each July 1. As a result, for loans where the borrower rate is fixed to term, we may earn Floor Income for an extended period of time, and for those loans where the borrower interest rate is reset annually on July 1, we may earn Floor Income to the next reset date. In accordance with legislation enacted in 2006, lenders are required to rebate Floor Income to ED for all FFELP Loans disbursed on or after April 1, 2006.

The following example shows the mechanics of Floor Income for a typical fixed rate FFELP Consolidation Loan (with a commercial paper-based SAP spread of 2.64 percent):

 

Fixed Borrower Rate

     4.25

SAP Spread over Commercial Paper Rate

     (2.64
  

 

 

 

Floor Strike Rate(1)

     1.61
  

 

 

 

 

  

(1)     The interest rate at which the underlying index (Treasury bill or commercial paper) plus the fixed SAP spread equals the fixed borrower rate. Floor Income is earned anytime the interest rate of the underlying index declines below this rate.

           

Based on this example, if the quarterly average commercial paper rate is over 1.61 percent, the holder of the student loan will earn at a floating rate based on the SAP formula, which in this example is a fixed spread to commercial paper of 2.64 percent. On the other hand, if the quarterly average commercial paper rate is below 1.61 percent, the SAP formula will produce a rate below the fixed borrower rate of 4.25 percent and the loan holder earns at the borrower rate of 4.25 percent.

 

G-2


Table of Contents

Graphic Depiction of Floor Income:

 

 

LOGO

Floor Income Contracts — We enter into contracts with counterparties under which, in exchange for an upfront fee representing the present value of the Floor Income that we expect to earn on a notional amount of underlying student loans being economically hedged, we will pay the counterparties the Floor Income earned on that notional amount over the life of the Floor Income Contract. Specifically, we agree to pay the counterparty the difference, if positive, between the fixed borrower rate less the SAP (see definition below) spread and the average of the applicable interest rate index on that notional amount, regardless of the actual balance of underlying student loans, over the life of the contract. The contracts generally do not extend over the life of the underlying student loans. This contract effectively locks in the amount of Floor Income we will earn over the period of the contract. Floor Income Contracts are not considered effective hedges under ASC 815, “Derivatives and Hedging,” and each quarter we must record the change in fair value of these contracts through income.

Guarantor(s) — State agencies or non-profit companies that guarantee (or insure) FFELP Loans made by eligible lenders under The Higher Education Act of 1965 (“HEA”), as amended.

Private Education Loans — Education loans to students or parents of students that are non-federal loans and loans not insured or guaranteed under the FFELP. The Private Education Loans we make are largely to bridge the gap between the cost of higher education and the amount funded through financial aid, federal loans or borrowers’ resources. Private Education Loans include loans for higher education (undergraduate and graduate degrees) and for alternative education, such as career training, private kindergarten through secondary education schools and tutorial schools. Certain higher education loans have repayment terms similar to FFELP Loans, whereby repayments begin after the borrower leaves school while others require repayment of interest or a fixed pay amount while the borrower is still in school. Our higher education Private Education Loans are not dischargeable in bankruptcy, except in certain limited circumstances.

In the context of our Private Education Loan business, we use the term “non-traditional loans” to describe education loans made to certain borrowers that have or are expected to have a high default rate as a result of a number of factors, including having a lower tier credit rating, low program completion and graduation rates or,

 

G-3


Table of Contents

where the borrower is expected to graduate, a low expected income relative to the borrower’s cost of attendance. Non-traditional loans are loans to borrowers attending for-profit schools with an original FICO score of less than 670 and borrowers attending not-for-profit schools with an original FICO score of less than 640. The FICO score used in determining whether a loan is non-traditional is the greater of the borrower or co-borrower FICO score at origination.

Repayment Borrower Benefits — Financial incentives offered to borrowers based on pre-determined qualifying factors, which are generally tied directly to making on-time monthly payments. The impact of Repayment Borrower Benefits is dependent on the estimate of the number of borrowers who will eventually qualify for these benefits and the amount of the financial benefit offered to the borrower. We occasionally change Repayment Borrower Benefits programs in both amount and qualification factors. These programmatic changes must be reflected in the estimate of the Repayment Borrower Benefits discount when made.

Residual Interest — When we securitize student loans, we retain the right to receive cash flows from the student loans sold to trusts that we sponsor in excess of amounts needed to pay servicing, derivative costs (if any), other fees, and the principal and interest on the bonds backed by the student loans. The Residual Interest, which may also include reserve and other cash accounts, is the present value of these future expected cash flows, which includes the present value of any Embedded Fixed Rate Floor Income described above. We value the Residual Interest at the time of sale of the student loans to the trust and as of the end of each subsequent quarter.

Retained Interest — The Retained Interest includes the Residual Interest and servicing rights (as we retain the servicing responsibilities) for our securitization transactions accounted for as sales.

Risk Sharing — When a FFELP loan first disbursed on and after July 1, 2006 defaults, the federal government guarantees 97 percent of the principal balance plus accrued interest (98 percent on loans disbursed before July 1, 2006) and the holder of the loan is at risk for the remaining amount not guaranteed as a Risk Sharing loss on the loan. FFELP Loans originated after October 1, 1993 are subject to Risk Sharing on loan default claim payments unless the default results from the borrower’s death, disability or bankruptcy.

Special Allowance Payment (“SAP”) — FFELP Loans disbursed prior to April 1, 2006 (with the exception of certain PLUS and SLS loans discussed below) generally earn interest at the greater of the borrower rate or a floating rate determined by reference to the average of the applicable floating rates (91-day Treasury bill rate or commercial paper) in a calendar quarter, plus a fixed spread that is dependent upon when the loan was originated and the loan’s repayment status. If the resulting floating rate exceeds the borrower rate, ED pays the difference directly to us. This payment is referred to as the Special Allowance Payment or SAP and the formula used to determine the floating rate is the SAP formula. We refer to the fixed spread to the underlying index as the SAP spread. For loans disbursed after April 1, 2006, FFELP Loans effectively only earn at the SAP rate, as the excess interest earned when the borrower rate exceeds the SAP rate (Floor Income) must be refunded to ED.

Variable rate PLUS Loans and SLS Loans earn SAP only if the variable rate, which is reset annually, exceeds the applicable maximum borrower rate. For PLUS loans disbursed on or after January 1, 2000, this limitation on SAP was repealed effective April 1, 2006.

Variable Rate Floor Income — Variable Rate Floor Income is Floor Income that is earned only through the next date at which the borrower interest rate is reset to a market rate. For FFELP Stafford loans whose borrower interest rate resets annually on July 1, we may earn Floor Income or Embedded Floor Income based on a calculation of the difference between the borrower rate and the then current interest rate.

 

G-4


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

Exhibit No.

  

Description

    3.1    Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-159447) filed on May 22, 2009).
    3.2    Certificate of Designation of 7.25% Mandatory Convertible Preferred Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on January 3, 2008).
    3.3    By-Laws of the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on November 21, 2011).
    4.1    Indenture, dated as of October 1, 2000, between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon, as successor to J.P. Morgan Chase Bank, National Association, formerly Chase Manhattan Bank (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on October 5, 2000).
    4.2    Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of January 16, 2003, between the registrant and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on January 17, 2003).
    4.3    Amended Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of December 17, 2004, between the Company and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on December 17, 2004).
    4.4    Second Amended Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of July 22, 2008, between the Company and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on July 25, 2008).
    4.5    Sixth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of October 15, 2008, between the Company and The Bank of New York Mellon (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on October 15, 2008).
    4.6    Medium Term Note Master Note, Series A (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on November 7, 2001).
    4.7
   Medium Term Note Master Note, Series B (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (File No. 1-13251) filed on January 28, 2003).
  10.1    Note Purchase and Security Agreement between Bluemont Funding 1; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A.; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.; Banc of America Securities LLC; J.P. Morgan Securities Inc.; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, “National Association; and Sallie Mae, Inc., dated January 15, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.40 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.2    Schedule of Contracts Substantially Identical to Exhibit 10.10 in all Material Respects: between Town Center Funding 1 LLC and Town Hall Funding I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.41 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.3*    Amendment No. 1 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Bluemont Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce Fenner Smith Incorporated, as Lead Arrangers; the Conduit Lenders, the Alternate Lenders and the LIBOR Lenders party thereto; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of January 14, 2011.


Table of Contents
  10.4*    Amendment No. 1 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Center Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce Fenner Smith Incorporated, as Lead Arrangers; the Conduit Lenders, the Alternate Lenders and the LIBOR Lenders party thereto; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of January 14, 2011.
  10.5*    Amendment No. 1 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Hall Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; J.P. Morgan Securities LLC and Merrill Lynch, Pierce Fenner Smith Incorporated, as Lead Arrangers; the Conduit Lenders, the Alternate Lenders and the LIBOR Lenders party thereto; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of January 14, 2011.
  10.6*    Amendment No. 2 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Bluemont Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A, Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of August 2, 2011.
  10.7*    Amendment No. 2 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Center Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A, Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of August 2, 2011.
  10.8*    Amendment No. 2 to Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Hall Funding I, as the Trust; Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A, Bank of America, N.A., Barclays Bank PLC, The Royal Bank of Scotland PLC, Deutsche Bank AG, New York Branch, Alpine Securitization Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada, as Managing Agents; and Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, dated as of August 2, 2011.
  10.9*    Amended and Restated Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Bluemont Funding I, as the Trust; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR Lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, as Lead Arrangers; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; and Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator, dated as of January 13, 2012.
  10.10*    Amended and Restated Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Center Funding I, as the Trust; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, as Lead Arrangers; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; and Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator, dated as of January 13, 2012.


Table of Contents
  10.11*    Amended and Restated Note Purchase and Security Agreement by and among Town Hall Funding I, as the Trust; the Conduit Lenders; the Alternate Lenders; the LIBOR lenders; the Managing Agents; Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent; JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Syndication Agent; Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated and J.P. Morgan Securities LLC, as Lead Arrangers; The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, National Association, as Eligible Lender Trustee; and Sallie Mae, Inc., as Administrator, dated as of January 13, 2012.
  10.12    Affiliate Collateral Pledge and Security Agreement between SLM Education Credit Finance Corporation, HICA Education Loan Corporation and the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, dated January 15, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.13    Advances, Pledge and Security Agreement between HICA Education Loan Corporation and the Federal Home Loan Bank of Des Moines, dated January 15, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.14    Asset Purchase Agreement between The Student Loan Corporation; Citibank, N.A.; Citibank (South Dakota) National Association; SLC Student Loan Receivables I, Inc., SLM Corporation, Bull Run 1 LLC, SLM Education Credit Finance Corporation and Sallie Mae, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 8, 2010).
  10.15†    Retainer Agreement between Anthony P. Terracciano and the Company, dated January 7, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 9, 2008).
  10.16†    Amendment to Retainer Agreement Anthony Terracciano and the Company, dated December 24, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 26, 2010).
  10.17†    Second Amendment to Retainer Agreement between Anthony P. Terracciano and the Company, dated September 23, 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.44 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.18†    Employment Agreement between John F. Remondi and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 7, 2008).
  10.19†    Employment Agreement between Joseph DePaulo and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 6, 2010).
  10.20†    Employment Agreement between Laurent C. Lutz and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.47 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.21†    Confidential Agreement and Release of John (Jack) Hewes (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.48 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.22†    Form of SLM Corporation Executive Severance Plan for Senior Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 4, 2011).
  10.23†    Form of SLM Corporation Change in Control Severance Plan for Senior Officers (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 4, 2011).
  10.24†*    Form of Director’s Indemnification Agreement.
  10.25†*    Sallie Mae 401(k) Savings Plan.
  10.26†*    Amendment Number One to the Sallie Mae 401(k) Savings Plan.
  10.27†*    Amendment Number Two to the Sallie Mae 401(k) Savings Plan.
  10.28†    Sallie Mae Supplemental 401(k) Savings Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).


Table of Contents
  10.29†    Sallie Mae Deferred Compensation Plan for Key Employees Restatement Effective January 1, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.30†*    SLM Corporation Deferred Compensation Plan for Directors.
  10.31†    Sallie Mae Supplemental Cash Account Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.32†    Sallie Mae Employee Stock Purchase Plan, Amended and Restated as of February 15, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on August 5, 2011).
  10.33†    SLM Holding Corporation Directors Stock Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit A of the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (file no. 001-13251), as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 10, 1998).
  10.34†    SLM Holding Corporation Management Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit B of the Company’s Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (file no. 001-13251), as filed on April 10, 1998).
  10.35†    Form of Stock Option Agreement, SLM Corporation Incentive Plan, ISO, Price-Vested with Replacements 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q (file no. 001-13251) filed on November 9, 2004).
  10.36†    Form of Stock Option Agreement, SLM Corporation Incentive Plan, Non-Qualified, Price-Vested Options-2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q (file no. 001-13251) filed on November 9, 2004).
  10.37†    Amended and Restated SLM Corporation Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (file no. 001-13251) filed on May 25, 2005).
  10.38†    Director’s Stock Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 of the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K (file no. 001-13251) filed on May 25, 2005).
  10.39†    Form of Stock Option Agreement SLM Corporation Incentive Plan Net-Settled, Price-Vested Options — 1 year minimum — 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K (file no. 001-13251) filed on March 9, 2006).
  10.40†    Form of SLM Corporation Incentive Stock Plan Stock Option Agreement, Net-Settled, Performance Vested Options, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.41†    Form of SLM Corporation Incentive Plan Performance Stock Term Sheet, “Core Earnings” Net Income Target-Sustained Performance, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on March 2, 2009).
  10.42†    SLM Corporation Directors Equity Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-159447) filed on May 22, 2009).
  10.43†    SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (File No. 333-159447) filed on May 22, 2009).
  10.44†    Form of SLM Corporation Directors Equity Plan Non-Employee Director Restricted Stock Agreement 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 5, 2009).
  10.45†    Form of SLM Corporation Directors Equity Plan Non-Employee Director Stock Option Agreement 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on November 5, 2009).


Table of Contents
  10.46†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Stock Option Agreement, Net Settled, Time Vested Options – 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10. 7 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 6, 2010).
  10.47†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Performance Stock Award Term Sheet, Time Vested – 2010 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 of the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q filed on May 6, 2010).
  10.48†    Amendment to Stock Option and Restricted/Performance Stock Terms (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.49 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.49†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Stock Option Agreement, Net Settled, Time Vested Options – 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.50 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  10.50†    Form of SLM Corporation 2009-2012 Incentive Plan Restricted Stock and Restricted Stock Unit Term Sheet, Time Vested – 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.51 of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K filed on February 28, 2011).
  12.1*    Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
  16.1    Letter from PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP to the Securities and Exchange Commission, dated December 6, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 16.1 to the Company’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on December 6, 2011).
  21.1*    List of Subsidiaries.
  23*    Consent of PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP.
  31.1*    Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
  31.2*    Certification Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
  32.1*    Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
  32.2*    Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2003.
101.INS    XBRL Instance Document.
101.SCH    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document.
101.CAL    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.
101.DEF    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document.
101.LAB    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document.
101.PRE    XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document.

 

Management Contract or Compensatory Plan or Arrangement

 

*

Filed herewith